Toshiba Projection Television 52HMX95 User Manual

OWNER’S MANUAL  
Integrated High Definition  
DLP Projection Television  
Compatible with Toshiba’s new  
TM  
Audio/Video Hard Drive Recorder!  
See pages 26 and 55 for details.  
HIGH-DEFINITION TELEVISION  
For an overview of steps for setting up your new TV, see page 9.  
Note: To display a High Definition picture, the TV must be receiving a  
High Definition signal (such as an over-the-air High Definition TV  
broadcast, a High Definition digital cable program, or a High Definition  
digital satellite program). For details, please contact your TV antenna  
installer, cable provider, or satellite provider.  
Note: If the TV is powered off and then quickly on again when the  
lamp unit is hot, it may take several minutes for the picture to appear  
on-screen. This is a property of DLP TV lamp technology and is NOT  
a sign of malfunction. For details, see IMPORTANT NOTICE ABOUT  
HOT LAMP RESTARTon page 5.  
I
Owner’s Record  
The model number and serial number are on the back  
of your TV. Record these numbers in the spaces below.  
Refer to these numbers whenever you communicate  
with your Toshiba dealer about this TV.  
52HMX95  
62HMX95  
Model number:  
Serial number:  
© 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION  
All Rights Reserved  
23566726A  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
16) WARNING: This product contains a lamp to project  
Important Safety Instructions  
the picture, and requires special safety precautions:  
1) Read these instructions.  
2) Keep these instructions.  
3) Heed all warnings.  
See pages 129131 for instructions on lamp unit  
replacement and care.  
DO NOT attempt to service this product except  
as specified on pages 129–131. The only user-  
serviceable item in this product is the lamp unit.  
4) Follow all instructions.  
5) Do not use this apparatus near water.  
6) Clean only with a dry cloth.  
Installation, Care, and Service  
Installation  
7) Do not block any ventilation openings. Install in  
accordance with the manufacturers instructions.  
Follow these recommendations and precautions and heed all  
warnings when installing your TV:  
8) Do not install near any heat sources such as radiators,  
heat registers, stoves, or other apparatus (including  
amplifiers) that produce heat.  
17) Never modify this equipment. Changes or modifications  
may void: a) the warranty, and b) the users authority to  
operate this equipment under the rules of the Federal  
Communications Commission.  
9) Do not defeat the safety purpose of the polarized or  
grounding type plug. A polarized plug has two blades  
with one wider than the other. A grounding type plug has  
two blades and a third grounding  
Wide blade  
18)  
DANGER: RISK OF SERIOUS PERSONAL  
INJURY, DEATH, OR EQUIPMENT  
DAMAGE! Never place the TV on  
prong. The wide blade or the third  
prong are provided for your safety.  
If the provided plug does not fit into  
your outlet, consult an electrician  
for replacement of the obsolete outlet.  
an unstable cart, stand, or table. The TV  
may fall, causing serious personal injury,  
death, or serious damage to the TV.  
10) Protect the power cord from being  
walked on or pinched, particularly at  
plugs, convenience receptacles, and  
the point where it exits the apparatus.  
19) Never place or store the TV in direct sunlight; hot, humid  
areas; areas subject to excessive dust or vibration; or  
locations with temperatures at or below 41°F (5°C).  
20) Always place the TV on the applicable optional TV  
stand(s) listed in the Specificationssection (if available  
for this TV model) or on a sturdy, level, stable surface that  
can safely support the size and weight of the unit. See  
Notice of possible TV stand instabilityand Child Safety”  
on page 2.  
11) Only use attachments/accessories specified by the  
manufacturer.  
12) Use only with the cart, stand, tripod,  
bracket, or table specified by the  
manufacturer, or sold with the  
apparatus. When a cart is used, use  
caution when moving the cart/apparatus  
combination to avoid injury from tip-over.  
21) Never expose the apparatus to dripping or splashing or  
place items such as vases, aquariums, any other item filled  
with liquid, or candles on top of the TV.  
13) Unplug this apparatus during lightning storms or  
when unused for long periods of time.  
22) Always place the back of the television at least one (1)  
inch away from any vertical surface (such as a wall) to  
allow proper ventilation.  
14) Refer all servicing to qualified service personnel.  
Servicing is required when the apparatus has been  
damaged in any way, such as power-supply cord or plug  
is damaged, liquid has been spilled or objects have fallen  
into the apparatus, the apparatus has been exposed to  
rain or moisture, does not operate normally, or has been  
dropped.  
23) Never block or cover the slots or openings in the TV  
cabinet back, bottom, and sides. Never place the TV:  
on a bed, sofa, rug, or similar surface;  
14a) Item 14 does not apply to Lamp unit replacement and  
too close to drapes, curtains, or walls; or  
in a confined space such as a bookcase, built-in cabinet,  
or any other place with poor ventilation.  
The slots and openings are provided to protect the TV  
from overheating and to help maintain reliable operation  
of the TV.  
careon pages 129-131 of this manual.  
14b) CAUTION: If the TV is dropped and the cabinet or  
enclosure surface has been damaged or the TV does  
not operate normally, take the following precautions:  
ALWAYS turn off the TV and unplug the power cord to  
avoid possible electric shock or fire.  
24) Never allow anything to rest on or roll over the power  
cord, and never place the TV where the power cord is  
subject to wear or abuse.  
To prevent personal injury, never handle the damaged  
television.  
ALWAYS contact a service technician to inspect the TV  
any time it has been damaged or dropped.  
25) Never overload wall outlets and extension cords.  
15) CAUTION: To reduce the risk of electric shock, do not  
use the polarized plug with an extension cord, receptacle,  
or other outlet unless the blades can be inserted completely  
to prevent blade exposure.  
26) Always operate this equipment from a 120 VAC, 60 Hz  
power source only.  
(continued on next page)  
3
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Installation (continued from previous page)  
Care (continued from previous column)  
33) For added protection of your TV from lightning and power  
surges, always unplug the power cord and disconnect the  
antenna from the TV if you leave the TV unattended or  
unused for long periods of time.  
27) Always make sure the antenna system is properly  
grounded to provide adequate protection against voltage  
surges and built-up static charges (see Section 810 of the  
National Electric Code).  
Antenna lead-in wire  
34) During normal use, the TV may make occasional snapping  
or popping sounds. This is normal, especially when the  
unit is being turned on or off. If these sounds become  
frequent or continuous, unplug the power cord  
Antenna discharge unit  
(NEC Section 810-20)  
Ground clamp  
and contact a Toshiba Authorized Service Center.  
Grounding conductors  
(NEC Section 810-21)  
35) Special care for DLP™ (Digital Light Processing) units:  
Electric service equipment  
The lamp unit in this product has a limited service life. The  
length of service life varies depending on product use or  
user settings. If you use the lamp beyond its service life:  
Power service grounding  
electrode system  
(NEC Art 250 Part H)  
Ground clamps  
you may notice a reduction in the colors and/or  
brightness of the picture, at which time you should  
replace the lamp unit; and  
28)  
DANGER: RISK OF SERIOUS PERSONAL  
INJURY OR DEATH!  
the strength of the quartz glass in the lamp will be  
reduced and the lamp may rupture. If the lamp  
ruptures, the TV will not operate until the lamp unit is  
replaced.  
Use extreme care to make sure you are never in  
a position where your body (or any item you are in contact  
with, such as a ladder or screwdriver) can accidentally  
touch overhead power lines. Never locate the antenna  
near overhead power lines or other electrical circuits.  
Never attempt to install any of the following during  
lightning activity: a) an antenna system; or b) cables,  
wires, or any home theater component connected to an  
antenna or phone system.  
See Lamp unit replacement and careon pages 129131.  
Dispose of the used lamp unit by the approved method for  
your area.  
The lamp unit contains mercury. Disposal of  
mercury may be regulated due to environmental  
considerations. For disposal or recycling  
information, please contact your local authorities or  
the Electronic Industries Alliance (www.eiae.org).  
Care  
For better performance and safer operation of your TOSHIBA  
TV, follow these recommendations and precautions:  
Service  
36  
)
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK!  
Never attempt to service the TV yourself,  
29) Always sit approximately 1025 feet away from the TV and  
as directly in front of it as possible. The picture can appear  
dull if you sit too far to the left or right of the TV, or if  
sunlight or room lights reflect on the screen. Turn the TV  
off to check for reflections on the screen, and then remove  
the source of reflections while viewing the TV.  
except as specified on pages 129131.  
Opening and removing the covers may expose you to  
dangerous voltage or other hazards. Failure to follow this  
WARNING may result in death or serious injury. Refer all  
servicing not specified in this manual to a Toshiba Authorized  
Service Center.  
37) If you have the TV serviced:  
30) Always unplug the TV before cleaning. Never use liquid or  
aerosol cleaners. Clean only with a soft, dry cloth.  
Ask the service technician to use only replacement parts  
specified by the manufacturer.  
Do not spray volatile compounds, such as insecticide, on  
the cabinet. This may discolor or damage the cabinet.  
Upon completion of service, ask the service technician to  
perform routine safety checks to determine that the TV is  
in safe operating condition.  
31)  
WARNING: RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK!  
Never spill liquids or push objects of any  
kind into the TV cabinet slots.  
38) When the TV reaches the end of its useful life, ask a  
qualified service technician to properly dispose of the TV.  
Note: The lamp unit contains mercury. Disposal of mercury may  
be regulated due to environmental considerations. Dispose of  
the used lamp unit by the approved method for your area.  
For disposal or recycling information, please contact your local  
authorities or the Electronic Industries Alliance (www.eiae.org).  
32) If the air temperature rises suddenly (for example, when  
the TV is first delivered), condensation may form on the  
lenses. This can make the picture appear distorted or the  
color appear faded. If this happens, turn off the TV for 6 to  
7 hours to allow the condensation to evaporate.  
Digital Light Processing, DLP and the DLP medallion are trademarks of Texas  
Instruments.  
4
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
FCC Declaration of Conformity Compliance Statement (Part 15):  
interference to radio communications. However, there is no  
guarantee that interference will not occur in a particular  
installation. If this equipment does cause harmful  
interference to radio or television reception, which can be  
determined by removing and applying power to the  
equipment, the user is encouraged to try to correct the  
interference by one or more of the following measures:  
The Toshiba 52HMX95 and 62HMX95 DLP™ projection  
TVs comply with Part 15 of the FCC rules.  
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this  
device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) this  
device must accept any interference that may cause  
undesired operation.  
The party responsible for compliance to these rules is:  
Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C.  
82 Totowa Rd. Wayne, NJ 07470.  
• Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna.  
• Increase the separation between the equipment and the  
receiver.  
Ph: (973) 628-8000  
• Connect the equipment into an outlet on a circuit different  
from that to which the receiver is connected.  
Note: This equipment has been tested and found to comply  
with the limits for a Class B digital device, pursuant to Part 15  
of the FCC rules. These limits are designed to provide  
reasonable protection against harmful interference in a  
residential installation. This equipment generates, uses, and  
can radiate radio frequency energy and, if not installed and  
used in accordance with the instructions, may cause harmful  
• Consult the dealer or an experienced radio/TV technician  
for help.  
CAUTION: Changes or modifications to this equipment not  
expressly approved by Toshiba could void the user’s authority  
to operate this equipment.  
Important notes about your DLPTM projection TV  
6) Depending on the media you are viewing, it is possible, although  
1) The light source for this TV is a projection lamp unit with a  
limited service life. When the lamp wears out, the picture may  
become dark or black or the lamp may fail, at which time you  
must replace the lamp unit. See “Lamp unit replacement and  
care” on pages 129–131.  
unlikely, that a limited number of viewers may see a “rainbow  
effect” on the screen, which can, in rare instances, result in eye  
fatigue. This is a rare occurrence related to DLP technology and  
is not a sign of TV malfunction.  
7)  
The TV contains several cooling fans to moderate the  
internal temperature. You may be able to hear the fans  
for several minutes after the TV is powered off. This is  
a normal function of the Quick Restart™ feature and is not a sign  
of TV malfunction. You can set the Quick Restart™ feature to  
stop the fans as soon as the TV is powered off. See “Setting the  
Quick Restart™ feature” on page 56.  
2) When the lamp mode is set to Low Power, every time the TV is  
powered on, the lamp will initially be in High Bright mode but  
will switch to Low Power mode in approximately 1 minute. You  
will notice a change in screen brightness when this happens.  
This is normal and is not a sign of malfunction. (See page 80  
for details.)  
8) The green and red LED lights on the TV’s front control touchpad  
indicate the TV’s current status. If either light flashes, see “LED  
indications” on page 125 for details.  
3) Every time the TV is powered on, it may take several minutes for  
the picture to obtain full brightness.  
4) The TV’s display is manufactured using an extremely high level  
of precision technology; however, an occasional pixel (dot of  
light) may show constantly on the screen. This is a structural  
property of DLP™ (Digital Light Processing™) technology and is  
not a sign of malfunction. Such pixels are not visible when the  
picture is viewed from a normal viewing distance (see item 5,  
below).  
9) Every time the TV power cord is plugged in, either the message  
“Now Booting . . .” will display on-screen until the picture  
appears, or the green LED will blink until the TV enters standby  
mode (plugged in but not powered on). This is normal and is not  
a sign of malfunction.  
10) When connecting an external A/V device, if you connect the  
device’s video output to the TV and the device’s audio output to  
a separate audio system, the picture and sound may not  
synchronize completely.  
5) Always sit approximately 10–25 feet away from the TV and as  
directly in front of it as possible. The picture quality may be  
affected by your viewing position and length of viewing time.  
If you sit too closely to the TV for too long, you may suffer from  
eye fatigue. See item 29 on page 4.  
11) When playing a video game on the TV, there may be a slight  
delay between your command (e.g., joystick, keyboard) and the  
picture movement on the screen.  
IMPORTANT NOTICE ABOUT “HOT LAMP RESTART”  
When the TV has been powered on long enough for the lamp unit to get hot, it may take several minutes for the picture to appear on-screen  
in the following situations:  
• when the Quick Restart™ feature is set to OFF and you turn the TV off and then on again within a few minutes; or  
• if the TV is on when a short-term power failure, power surge, or other similar power failure occurs, such that the TV loses and regains  
power within a few minutes.  
This is a property of DLP TV lamp technology and is NOT a sign of malfunction.  
If this occurs, the green LED on the TV front panel will blink (and the red LED will be lit solid) until the TV is finished restarting the lamp and  
the normal picture appears. If both LEDs are blinking, you will need to turn the TV off and then on again to restart the lamp.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
5
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Contents  
Important safety, care, and service information ........... 2–4  
Chapter 4: Menu layout and navigation ........................... 40  
Main menu layout .............................................................. 40  
Setup/Installation menu layout ........................................... 41  
Navigating the menu system............................................... 41  
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen® setup ............................ 42  
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system ..................... 42  
TV Guide On Screen® Reminder ....................................... 45  
Turning off the TV Guide On Screen®  
FCC Declaration of Conformity Compliance  
Statement (Part 15): ............................................................ 5  
Important notes about your DLP™ projection TV............... 5  
Chapter 1: Introduction .......................................................... 8  
Welcome to Toshiba ...........................................................  
Features of your new TV ....................................................  
8
8
Overview of steps for installing, setting up, and  
using your new TV .......................................................... 9  
automatic display feature ................................................ 45  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV ............................................. 46  
Selecting the menu language............................................... 46  
Configuring the antenna input sources for the ANT 1  
and ANT 2 terminals ..................................................... 46  
Programming channels into the TV’s channel memory....... 47  
Programming channels automatically .......................... 47  
Manually adding and deleting channels in the  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV ......................................... 10  
TV front panel touchpad and side panel controls  
and connections ........................................................... 10  
TV back panel connections ................................................ 11  
Overview of cable types ...................................................... 13  
About the connection illustrations ...................................... 14  
Connecting a digital CableCARD.................................... 14  
Connecting a VCR and antenna or Cable TV  
(no Cable box) ............................................................... 15  
Connecting a camcorder..................................................... 15  
Connecting a VCR and Cable box ..................................... 16  
Connecting a VCR and satellite receiver ............................. 17  
Connecting a DVD player with S-video, a VCR,  
channel memory ..................................................... 48  
Programming your favorite channels .................................. 49  
Setting up and using TheaterNeton-screen  
device control ................................................................. 50  
Setting up TheaterNet................................................. 50  
Using the TheaterNet control icons............................. 51  
TheaterNet IR device codes ........................................ 52  
Setting the AVHD device skip time .................................... 55  
Setting the HDMIaudio mode........................................ 55  
Setting the time and date .................................................... 55  
Viewing the CableCARDmenu ...................................... 56  
Setting the Quick Restartfeature ..................................... 56  
Viewing the digital signal meter ......................................... 57  
Viewing the system status ................................................... 57  
and a Cable box.............................................................. 18  
Connecting a DVD player with ColorStream®  
(component video) and a VCR ....................................... 19  
Connecting two VCRs ....................................................... 20  
Connecting an HDMIor DVI device to the  
HDMI input .................................................................. 21  
Connecting a device to the TheaterNet OUT infrared  
terminal using the IR blaster cable for IR pass-through  
device control ................................................................. 22  
Connecting an IR receiver/repeater or home theater  
control system to the TheaterNet IN infrared terminal ... 23  
Connecting a digital audio system ...................................... 24  
Connecting an analog audio system.................................... 24  
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices .................................. 25  
Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices ................... 25  
Supported signals ........................................................... 25  
Using TheaterNeton-screen device control .................. 25  
Connecting an AVHD  
(external hard drive) or D-VHS recorder .................... 26  
IEEE1394 device initialization ....................................... 26  
IEEE1394 device management ....................................... 27  
G-LINK® connection ......................................................... 28  
Connecting a personal computer (PC) ............................... 29  
Connecting a home network .............................................. 30  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen®  
interactive program guide ............................................... 58  
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system ..................... 58  
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen® system..................... 59  
TV Guide On Screen® remote control functions ......... 59  
Video Window ........................................................... 60  
Panel Menus ............................................................... 60  
Info Box...................................................................... 61  
TV Guide On Screen® Icons ....................................... 61  
TV Guide On Screen® Services .......................................... 62  
LISTINGS screen ....................................................... 62  
SEARCH screen.......................................................... 63  
RECORDINGS screen ............................................... 65  
SCHEDULE screen .................................................... 66  
Recording features....................................................... 66  
Reminder features ....................................................... 68  
SETUP screen ............................................................. 70  
Change system settings .......................................... 70  
Change channel display ......................................... 70  
Change default options .......................................... 71  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control ................................. 31  
Learning about the remote control ..................................... 31  
Installing the remote control batteries................................. 33  
Using the remote control MODE button to control  
your other devices........................................................... 33  
Remote Control functional key chart ................................. 34  
Programming the remote control to operate  
your other devices........................................................... 36  
Multi-brand remote control device codes............................ 38  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
6
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Contents  
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu....................................... 97  
Entering the PIN code ....................................................... 97  
If you cannot remember your PIN code ............................. 97  
Changing your PIN code ................................................... 97  
Blocking TV programs and movies by rating (V-Chip) ......... 98  
Blocking channels............................................................... 99  
Unlocking programs temporarily ........................................ 99  
Using the input lock feature ............................................... 99  
Using the GameTimer................................................... 100  
Using the front panel lock feature ..................................... 100  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features .....................................72  
Selecting the video input source to view ............................. 72  
Labeling the video input sources......................................... 73  
Tuning channels ................................................................. 74  
Using the Channel Browser...................................... 74  
Tuning your favorite channels ..................................... 76  
Tuning to the next programmed channel .................... 76  
Tuning to a specific channel (programmed or  
unprogrammed) ...................................................... 76  
Switching between two channels using  
Chapter 10: Using the Picture Viewer and  
Channel Return ...................................................... 76  
Switching between two channels using  
Audio Player.......................................................................... 101  
Media specifications ......................................................... 101  
File/folder name specifications .................................. 101  
Picture Viewer/JPEG file specifications ..................... 101  
Audio Player/MP3 file specifications ......................... 102  
Networked PC specifications .................................... 102  
Memory card specifications ....................................... 102  
Using the Picture Viewer .................................................. 103  
Accessing JPEG files stored on a networked PC ........ 103  
Accessing JPEG files stored on a memory card .......... 103  
Viewing JPEG files on the TV .................................. 104  
Using the Audio Player ..................................................... 105  
Accessing MP3 files stored on a networked PC ......... 105  
Accessing MP3 files stored on a memory card ........... 105  
Playing MP3 audio files on the TV ........................... 106  
Memory card care and handling ....................................... 106  
SurfLock............................................................... 76  
Selecting the picture size ..................................................... 77  
Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture  
(TheaterWide 2 and 3 only) ........................................... 79  
Using the auto aspect ratio feature ...................................... 79  
Selecting the cinema mode (480i signals only) .................... 80  
Selecting the lamp mode .................................................... 80  
Using the POP features ...................................................... 81  
Using the POP double-window feature ....................... 81  
Switching the speaker audio (main or POP) ................ 82  
POP double-window aspect ratio ................................ 82  
Using the FREEZE feature ................................................. 83  
Using the favorite channel scan feature ............................... 83  
Adjusting the picture .......................................................... 84  
Selecting the picture mode .......................................... 84  
Adjusting the picture quality ....................................... 84  
Using the Color Management feature ......................... 85  
Using CableClear®/DNR (digital noise reduction) ...... 86  
Selecting the color temperature ................................... 86  
Using MPEG noise reduction ..................................... 87  
Using dynamic contrast............................................... 87  
Using the closed caption mode ........................................... 88  
Advanced closed captions ............................................ 88  
Digital closed captions ................................................ 89  
Adjusting the audio ............................................................ 90  
Muting the sound ....................................................... 90  
Using the digital audio selector ................................... 90  
Selecting stereo/SAP broadcasts................................... 90  
Adjusting the audio quality ......................................... 91  
Using the sub-bass system (SBS) ................................. 91  
Using the StableSound® feature ................................... 91  
Using the SRS WOWsurround sound feature .......... 92  
Using the virtual surround sound feature (Dolby  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature .... 107  
A. Connect the TV to your home network ....................... 107  
B. Set up the network address ........................................... 107  
Automatically setting up the network address............ 107  
Manually setting up the network address .................. 108  
Resetting the network address ................................... 109  
C. Set up file sharing on your PC ..................................... 110  
Compatible operating systems................................... 110  
Setting up file sharing on a PC with Microsoft®  
Windows® XP Service Pack 1 or Service Pack 2 ..... 110  
Setting up file sharing on a PC with Microsoft®  
Windows® 2000 .................................................... 111  
D. Set up file sharing on the TV....................................... 112  
E. Viewing/playing shared files on the TV ........................ 112  
F. Set up e-mail scheduling ............................................... 113  
Required information and services ............................ 113  
Setting up e-mail scheduling ..................................... 113  
Description of fields in the “E-mail Scheduling  
Setup” window .............................................. 115–116  
G. Using e-mail scheduling .............................................. 117  
E-mail parameters ..................................................... 117  
Sending a request e-mail to the TV ........................... 117  
Formatting a request e-mail....................................... 117  
Receiving an e-mail from the TV .............................. 119  
Modifying an existing recording or reminder ............ 119  
Virtual/TruSurround) ............................................. 92  
Turning off the built-in speakers ................................. 93  
Selecting the optical audio output format ................... 93  
Setting the On/Off Timer .................................................. 94  
Setting the sleep timer ........................................................ 94  
Using the PC settings feature.............................................. 95  
Displaying TV setting information on-screen  
using RECALL ............................................................... 96  
Understanding the auto power off feature........................... 96  
Understanding the last mode memory feature .................... 96  
Using the Gray Level feature .............................................. 96  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting ............................................. 120  
General troubleshooting ........................................... 120–124  
LED indications ............................................................... 125  
TV Guide On Screen® FAQ ..................................... 126–128  
Chapter 13: Appendix ......................................................... 129  
Lamp unit replacement ............................................ 129–131  
Specifications ................................................................... 132  
Limited United States Warranty ....................................... 133  
Index ....................................................................................... 135  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
7
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Introduction  
1
Welcome to Toshiba  
Thank you for purchasing this Toshiba TV, one of the most innovative DLPprojection  
TVs on the market. The goal of this manual is to guide you through setting up and  
operating your TV as quickly as possible.  
See “Important notes about your  
DLPprojection TV” on page 5.  
• This manual applies to models 52HMX95 and 62HMX95. Before you start reading, check the model number on the back of  
your TV.  
• Instructions in this manual are based on using the remote control. You also can use the controls on the TV front touchpad if they  
have the same name as those referred to on the remote control. (MENU on the front touchpad functions as ENTER when a  
menu is on-screen or when the TV Guide On Screen® system is open.)  
• The side panel and back panel provide terminals for connecting other equipment to your TV. See page 10 for front touchpad and  
side panel details. See page 11 for back panel details. See pages 14–30 for instructions on connecting other devices to your TV.  
Please read all safety and operating instructions in this manual carefully and keep this manual for future reference.  
Features of your new TV  
The following are just a few of the many exciting features of your new Toshiba widescreen, integrated HD, DLPprojection TV:  
Integrated digital tuning (8VSB ATSC and QAM) eliminates the need for a separate digital converter set-top box (in most cases).  
TV Guide On Screen® no-fee interactive program guide (Chapters 5 and 7).  
Digital CableCARD™ slot for viewing encrypted digital Cable TV programs (page 14).  
Digital recording by connecting a Toshiba Symbio  
Audio/Video Hard Drive Recorder or a D-VHS digital recording device  
to one of the IEEE1394 jacks. You can record high definition and standard definition material from either tuner (page 26).  
Memory card slots [SD Memory Card, MultiMediaCard, Memory Stick, CompactFlash, xD-Picture Card]  
for viewing JPEG picture files as a “slide show” (page 103) and playing MP3 audio files (page 104).  
TheaterNet™ icons for on-screen control of external IR and IEEE1394 devices (page 50).  
Note: After you set up the TV Guide  
Two IEEE1394 ports for multi-device connection and control (page 25).  
Two HDMI (DVI) digital, high-definition multimedia interfaces (page 21).  
Two sets of ColorStream® HD high-resolution component video inputs (pages 17 and 19).  
On Screen® system (Chapter 5),  
the program guide opens  
automatically by default when  
you turn on the TV. You can turn off  
the automatic program guide (page  
45) and instead press the TV GUIDE  
button on the remote control to  
manually open the program guide.  
Dolby Digital (page 24), SRS WOW™ (page 92), and Dolby Virtual TruSurround (page 92),  
audio technologies.  
Digital Audio Out optical audio connection (page 24).  
CableClear® DNR digital picture noise reduction (page 86).  
• Double-window POP (page 81) and multi-window Favorites (page 83) features.  
PC IN (Analog RGB) terminal for using the TV screen as the display for a PC (pages 11 and 29).  
RJ-45 (Ethernet) port for connecting to a home network to allow file sharing (JPEG picture files and MP3 audio fiiles)  
and e-mail scheduling of recordings and reminders (page 30).  
______________  
In the United States, TV Guide and other related marks are registered marks of Gemstar-TV Guide International, Inc. and/or one of its affiliates. The TV Guide On Screen system is  
manufactured under license from Gemstar-TV Guide International, Inc. and/or one of its affiliates. The TV Guide On Screen system is protected by one or more of the following issued  
United States patents 6,498,895; 6,418,556; 6,331,877; 6,239,794; 6,154,203; 5,940,073; 4,908,713; 4,751,578; 4,706,121.  
GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL INC. AND/OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES ARE NOT IN ANY WAY LIABLE FOR THE ACCURACY OR  
AVAILABILITY OF THE PROGRAM SCHEDULE INFORMATION OR OTHER DATA IN THE TV GUIDE ON SCREEN® SYSTEM AND CANNOT GUARANTEE  
SERVICE AVAILABILITY IN YOUR AREA. IN NO EVENT SHALL GEMSTAR-TV GUIDE INTERNATIONAL, INC. AND/OR ITS RELATED AFFILIATES BE  
LIABLE FOR ANY DAMAGES IN CONNECTION WITH THE ACCURACY OR AVAILABILITY OF THE PROGRAM SCHEDULE INFORMATION OR OTHER  
DATA IN THE TV GUIDE ON SCREEN® SYSTEM.  
This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is protected by U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights. Use of this copyright protection technology must be  
authorized by Macrovision and is intended for home and other limited pay-per-view uses only, unless otherwise authorized by Macrovision. Reverse engineering or disassembly is  
prohibited.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
8
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 1: Introduction  
Overview of steps for installing, setting up, and using your new TV  
Follow these steps to set up your TV and begin using its many exciting features.  
1. Carefully read the important safety, installation, care,  
and service information on pages 2–5. Keep this  
manual for future reference.  
9. Program the remote control to operate your other  
device(s) (pages 33–39).  
10. AFTER connecting all cables and devices, plug in the  
2. Observe the following when choosing a location for  
power cords for your TV and other devices.  
the TV:  
11. After you plug in the TV power cord, the green LED (on  
the TV front touchpad, to the left of the POWER button) will  
blink while the TV is booting until the remote control is usable.  
When the green LED stops blinking, press POWER to turn on  
the TV.  
• Read “Installation” on pages 3–4.  
• Read “Important notes about your DLP™ projection TV” on  
page 5.  
Place the TV on the applicable optional TV stand listed in the  
“Specifications” section (if available for this TV model) or on  
a sturdy, level, stable surface that can safely support the size  
and weight of the unit.  
See “LED indications” on page 125.  
12. See “Menu layout and navigation” for a quick overview  
of navigating the TV’s menu system (pages 40–41).  
NOTICE OF POSSIBLE TV STAND INSTABILITY  
DANGER: RISK OF SERIOUS PERSONAL INJURY  
OR DEATH! Use this TV only with the TOSHIBA TV  
13. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system (if available in your area).  
stand listed in the “Specifications” section of this manual. Use with  
other stands may result in instability, causing possible injury or death.  
14. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide  
On Screen® program guide (if available in your area).  
• Place the TV in a location where light does not reflect on the  
screen.  
15. Program channels into the TV’s channel memory  
(page 47).  
• Place the TV far enough from walls and other objects to  
allow proper ventilation. Inadequate ventilation may cause  
overheating, which will damage the TV. THIS TYPE OF  
DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED UNDER THE TOSHIBA  
WARRANTY.  
16. Set up the TheaterNet™ on-screen device control  
feature (if applicable to your particular home theater system  
components) (page 50).  
17. For details on using the TV’s features, see Chapters 8  
3. Do not plug in any power cords until AFTER you have  
and 9.  
connected all cables and devices to your TV.  
18. For details on using the JPEG Picture Viewer and MP3  
Audio Player to view/play files saved on either a memory card  
or networked PC, see Chapter 10.  
4. BEFORE connecting cables or devices to the TV, learn  
the functions of the TV’s connections and controls (pages 10-  
12).  
19. For details on connecting the TV to a home network  
to allow file sharing and e-mail scheduling of recordings and  
reminders, see Chapter 11.  
5. Connect your other electronic device(s) to the TV  
(pages 14–30).  
6. Connect the G-LINK® cable (either one of the enclosed IR  
blaster cables) from your VCR and/or Cable box (if applicable) to  
the G-LINK® terminal so you can use the TV Guide On Screen®  
features (applies to VCRs and cable boxes only). See page 28.  
20. For help, refer to the Troubleshooting Guide (Chapter 12).  
21. For lamp unit replacement instructions, see Chapter 13.  
22. For technical specifications and warranty information,  
7. Install the batteries in the remote control (page 33).  
see Chapter 13.  
8. See “Learning about the remote control” (page 31) for  
23. Enjoy your new TV!  
an overview of the buttons on the remote control.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
9
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Connecting your TV  
2
TV front panel touchpad and side panel controls and connections  
Front of TV  
Side panel  
TV/VIDEO  
EXIT  
CHANNEL  
VOLUME  
MENU  
POWER  
Remote sensor  
1
Front panel touchpad*  
zyx •  
EXIT  
MENU (ENTER)**  
4
3a  
5
GUIDE  
2
POWER  
6
Right side of TV  
VIDEO-3 IN Memory card  
0
slots  
!¡  
Green/Red LEDs  
9
TV/VIDEO Channel zy  
3b  
Volume x •  
7
8
*Gently touch the printed keys on the touchpad.  
**The MENU button on the TV front panel touchpad functions as the  
ENTER button when a menu is on-screen.  
1
2
Remote sensor (behind the screen) — Point the remote  
control toward this area of the TV screen. See “Remote  
control effective range” on page 32.  
GUIDE — Press to access the TV Guide On Screen®  
interactive program guide. (See Chapters 5 and 7.)  
7
8
9
CHANNEL yz — When no menu is on-screen, these  
buttons change the channel (programmed channels only; see  
page 47). When a menu is on-screen, these buttons function  
as up/down menu navigation buttons.  
VOLUME x • — When no menu is on-screen, these  
buttons adjust the volume level. When a menu is on-screen,  
these buttons function as left/right menu navigation  
buttons.  
3a EXIT — When a menu is on-screen, this button functions  
as the EXIT button. Press to instantly close an on-screen  
menu.  
Green and Red LEDs  
3b TV/VIDEO — When no menu is on-screen, this button  
functions as the TV/VIDEO button (page 72). Repeatedly  
press to change the input source you are viewing (ANT 1,  
ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3, HDMI 1,  
HDMI 2, ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2, PC).  
When the red LED lights solid (not blinking), it indicates  
that the TV power cord is plugged in.  
When the green LED lights solid (not blinking), it indicates  
that recording is in progress.  
4
ARROWS yzx • — When a menu is on-screen, these  
buttons function as up/down/left/right menu navigation  
buttons.  
See “LED indications” on page 125 for additional  
information.  
0
VIDEO-3 — The side panel A/V connections are referred to  
as “VIDEO 3” and include standard A/V connections plus  
optional S-video. (The VIDEO 1 and VIDEO 2 A/V  
connections are on the TV’s back panel; see page 11.)  
5
MENU (ENTER) — Press to access the menu system (see  
pages 40–41). When a menu is on-screen or the TV Guide  
On Screen® program guide is open, the MENU button on  
the front touchpad functions as the ENTER button.  
Memory card slots — Insert a memory card into one of  
the memory card slots to view JPEG files (such as photos) as  
a “slide show” on your TV or listen to MP3 audio files (see  
Chapter 10).  
6
POWER — Press to turn the TV on and off.  
If the TV stops responding to the controls on the remote  
control or TV front panel and you cannot turn off the TV,  
press and hold the POWER button on the TV front panel  
for 5 or more seconds to reset the TV.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
10  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
TV back panel connections  
For an explanation of cable types, see page 13.  
1
2
3 4 5  
6
7
8
9
0
1 VIDEO 1 IN and VIDEO 2 IN Two sets of standard  
(composite) video and standard audio inputs plus optional  
S-video inputs for connecting devices with composite video  
or S-video output.  
6 PC IN/AUDIO — For connecting audio from a personal  
computer when using the TV screen as the display for the  
connected PC. See page 29.  
7 PC IN/VIDEO— For connecting video from a personal  
computer when using the TV screen as the display for the  
connected PC. See page 29.  
Note: Standard (composite) video and S-video cables carry  
only video information; separate audio cables are required for a  
complete connection.  
8
TheaterNet(IR) OUT 1 and OUT 2 — For controlling  
infrared remote-controlled devices through the TV. You can  
connect up to two devices with either one of the enclosed  
IR blaster cables, and then control the devices using the  
TVs IR pass-through or TheaterNeton-screen device  
control features. See pages 22 and 50.  
TheaterNet(IR) IN — For connecting an infrared  
remote-controlled receiver/repeater or home theater control  
system. See page 23.  
2 ColorStream® HD-1 and ColorStream® HD-2 Two sets  
of ColorStream® high-definition component video inputs  
(with standard stereo audio inputs) for connecting devices  
with component video output, such as a Toshiba DVD  
player with ColorStream®. See pages 17 and 19.  
Note: Component video cables carry only video information;  
separate audio cables are required for a complete connection.  
3
Variable Audio OUT — Standard analog audio outputs for  
connecting an analog amplifier with external speakers. See  
page 24.  
9 Digital Audio OUT — Optical audio output in Dolby  
Digital or PCM (pulse-code modulation) format for  
connecting an external Dolby Digital decoder, amplifier,  
A/V receiver, or home theater system with optical audio  
input. See page 24.  
4 A/V OUT — Standard composite video and analog audio  
outputs for connecting a VCR for editing and dubbing. See  
page 20 for details.  
0 CableCARDslot — For use with a digital security card  
and digital cable TV service (provided by your local cable  
operator) to view encrypted digital programming. See pages  
14 and 56.  
5 HDMI Audio IN 1 and 2 Two sets of analog audio IN  
terminals for use when connecting a DVI device with analog  
audio output to one of the HDMI inputs. See page 21. Also  
see item 2 on the next page.  
(Continued on next page)  
___________  
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface are trademarks or  
registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.  
CableCARD is a trademark of Cable Television Laboratories, Inc.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
11  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
TV back panel connections (continued)  
1
2
3
4
5
1 ANT-1 (cable) IN and ANT-2 IN Two RF inputs that  
support analog (NTSC) and digital (ATSC) off-air antenna  
signals and analog and digital Cable TV (QAM) signals.  
4 TheaterNet IEEE1394 1 and 2 Two bi-directional  
digital IEEE1394 ports for connecting multiple devices  
with compressed digital video. Because these ports are  
bi-directional, they can be used for playback and recording.  
You can control your IEEE1394 devices using the TV’s  
TheaterNet on-screen device control icons. See pages 25–27  
and 50.  
Note: If you have an antenna only, connect it to ANT-1. If you have  
both cable TV and an antenna, connect the cable TV to ANT-1 and  
the antenna to ANT-2.  
2 HDMIIN 1 and 2 Two High-Definition Multimedia  
Interface inputs receive digital audio and uncompressed  
digital video from an HDMI device or uncompressed digital  
video from a DVI device. See page 21. Also see item 5 on  
the previous page.  
Note: IEEE1394 cable carries both audio and video information;  
therefore, separate audio cables are not required.  
5 RJ-45 (Ethernet)* — For connecting the TV to a home  
network. See page 30.  
3 G-LINK® — For use with one of the enclosed IR blaster/  
G-LINK® cables to enable the TV Guide On Screen®  
recording features. See page 28.  
*THINC™ system  
(Toshiba Home Interactive Network Connection)  
The RJ-45 (Ethernet) port allows your Toshiba Cinema  
Series TV to connect to your home network. This  
revolutionary home entertainment networking system lets  
you access MP3 audio files and JPEG picture files stored on  
a networked PC (as shared files) and play/display them on  
your TV.  
You also can play your shared MP3 audio files through a  
connected audio system.  
See pages 24 and 30 and Chapters 10 and 11 for details.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
12  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Overview of cable types  
Note: Two dual-wand IR blaster/G-LINK® cables are included with your TV. All other required  
cables, if not provided with your other devices, can be purchased at many electronics accessory  
suppliers.  
Coaxial (F-type) cable  
Coaxial (F-type) cable is used for connecting your antenna, cable TV service, and/or  
cable converter box to the ANT-1 and/or ANT-2 RF inputs on your TV.  
Standard A/V cables (composite video) usually come in sets of three, and are for use  
with video devices with analog audio and composite video output. These cables (and  
the related inputs on your TV) are typically color-coded according to use: yellow for  
video, red for stereo right audio, and white for stereo left (or mono) audio.  
Standard A/V cables (red/white/yellow)  
S-video cable  
S-video cable is for use with video devices with S-video output. Separate audio cables  
are required for a complete connection.  
Note: An S-video cable provides better picture performance than a composite video cable. If  
you connect an S-video cable, be sure to disconnect the standard (composite) video cable or  
the picture performance will be unacceptable.  
Component video cables (red/green/blue)  
Component video cables come in sets of three and are for use with video devices with  
component video output. (ColorStream® is Toshiba’s brand of component video.)  
These cables are typically color-coded red, green, and blue. Separate audio cables are  
required for a complete connection.  
HDMI cable  
Note: Component video cables provide better picture performance than a standard (composite)  
video or S-video cable.  
HDMI cable is for use with devices with HDMI (High-Definition Multimedia  
Interface) output. HDMI cable delivers digital audio and video in its native format.  
This cable carries both video and audio information; therefore, separate audio cables are  
not required for a complete HDMI device connection. See page 21 for further details.  
IEEE1394 cable (4-pin)  
Note: HDMI cable provides better picture performance than a standard (composite) video or  
S-video cable.  
Dual-wand IR blaster/G-LINK® cable  
(2 included)  
IEEE1394 cable is for use with video devices with compressed digital video output  
that meet CEA specifications for IEEE1394. This cable carries both video and audio  
information; therefore, no separate audio cables are required for a complete connection.  
See pages 25–27.  
Note:  
Optical audio cable  
• The transmission capability of any IEEE1394 cable used with this TV must be S400  
(400 Mbps maximum).  
• IEEE1394 cable provides better picture performance than a standard (composite)  
video or S-video cable.  
®
Dual-wand IR blaster/G-LINK cable is for use with video devices with IR (infrared)  
Ethernet (RJ-45) cable  
remote control. Two of these cables are included with your TV. One is for connection  
to the G-LINK® terminal (page 28) to enable TV Guide On Screen® recording features  
(Chapters 5 and 7). The other can be used with the TV’s IR pass-through feature (page  
22) and TheaterNeton-screen device control feature (page 50).  
Note: Although your TV includes both HDMI  
and IEEE1394 connections, it may not  
operate with another device you have that  
includes such a connection. For example, the  
IEEE1394 ports are not intended to operate  
with current model Mini DV camcorders, and  
the HDMI input is not intended for  
Note: The two IR blaster/G-LINK® cables included with your TV have specific characteristics that  
allow them to work properly with this TV’s IR OUT and G-LINK® terminals. Never use other  
aftermarket IR blaster or G-LINK® cables with this TV. Other cables may not function  
properly and can cause damage. THIS TYPE OF DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED BY YOUR  
TOSHIBA WARRANTY.  
Optical audio cable is for connecting receivers with Dolby Digital or PCM  
(pulse-code modulation) optical audio input to the TV’s DIGITAL AUDIO OUT  
terminal. See page 24.  
connection to a computer. Copyright  
protection requirements may also prohibit or  
limit connectivity. See page 21 for details  
about the HDMI input. See pages 25–27 for  
details about the IEEE1394 ports.  
Ethernet (RJ-45) cable is used to connect the TV to your home network. See page 30  
and Chapter 11.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
13  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
About the connection illustrations  
You can connect different types and brands of devices to your TV in several different configurations. The connection illustrations in  
this manual are representative of typical device connections only. The input/output terminals on your devices may differ from those  
illustrated herein. For details on connecting and using your specific devices, refer to each device’s owner’s manual.  
Connecting a digital CableCARD™  
This digital television is capable of receiving analog basic, digital  
basic, and digital premium cable television programming by  
direct connection to a cable system providing such  
programming.  
A security card (such as a digital CableCARD), provided by  
your cable operator, is required to view encrypted digital  
programming.  
To view encrypted digital channels:  
1. Connect your digital Cable TV cable to ANT-1.  
2. With the front of the CableCARDfacing up, insert it into  
the CableCARDslot on the back of the TV (see  
illustration below left).  
3. After the CableCARDis inserted, a CableCARDoption  
appears in the Applications menu, with informational  
screens provided by your digital CableCARDservice. See  
page 56 for additional information.  
Certain advanced and interactive digital cable services (such as  
video-on-demand, a cable operator’s enhanced program guide,  
and data-enhanced television services) will not work with the  
use of a CableCARDand may require the use of a separate  
set-top box from your cable operator.  
CableCard Connected -- Acquiring  
channel information.  
Applications  
For more information, contact your local cable operator.  
You will need:  
one digital CableCARD(contact your cable operator)  
CableCard services will only operate  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
IP Service  
with cable signal connected to Antenna 1.  
Conditional Access  
CableCARD(tm) Status  
Network Setup  
Picture Viewer  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
CableCARD(tm) Pairing  
digital cable subscription service (contact your cable  
operator)  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
TV back panel  
Note:  
Connect the cable from your digital cable TV service  
directly to ANT 1 only. If you connect the digital cable through  
a VCR first and/or to ANT 2, the TV may not receive the signals  
correctly.  
Always use the EJECT button to remove the  
CableCARD. Removing the CableCARDwithout pressing  
EJECT can damage the CableCARD and/or TV. Such damage  
is NOT covered under your Toshiba warranty.  
Never insert any object or card other than a CableCARD™  
(including, without limitation, a PCMCIA card) into the  
CableCARDslot.  
Always make sure the CableCARDis facing the correct direction.  
When using a CableCARD, you do not need to program  
channels into the TV memory. The CableCARDautomatically  
loads the cable channel list into the TVs channel memory  
(page 47).  
The CableCARDmay take up to 5 minutes to pairwith the TV  
and download channel information. CableCARDinformation and  
channels will not be available until this process is completed.  
From digital Cable service  
Note: Connect the digital cable directly to ANT 1 only.  
If you connect the cable through a VCR first and/or to  
ANT 2, the TV may not receive the signals correctly.  
CableCARDtechnology, like all new and emerging technology, may  
from time to time experience compatibility issues due to the different  
ways in which television manufacturers and cable system operators  
implement the CableCARDspecifications. Most issues can be easily  
resolved. If you experience any performance-related CableCARD™  
issues with your Toshiba television, please contact Toshiba  
________  
Consumer Solutions by calling (800) 631-3811 or by visiting  
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp.  
CableCARD is a trademark of Cable Television Laboratories, Inc.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
14  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a VCR and antenna or Cable TV (no Cable box)  
You will need:  
one signal splitter  
From Cable TV or antenna  
IN  
three coaxial cables  
two sets of standard A/V cables  
Signal splitter  
OUT  
OUT  
For better picture performance, if your VCR has S-video, use an  
Stereo VCR  
S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead of the standard  
video cable. Do not connect both types of video cables to  
VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time or the picture  
performance will be unacceptable.  
VIDEO  
AUDI
L
R
IN from ANT  
OUT to TV  
CH 3  
CH 4  
IN  
OUT  
If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV to your  
L
R
VCRs audio OUT terminal using the white audio cable only.  
TV  
To view the antenna or Cable signal:  
Select the ANT 1 video input source on the TV.*  
To view the VCR:  
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source  
on the TV.*  
To use the TV Guide On Screen® recording features:  
1. Connect the G-LINK® cable according to the instructions  
on page 28.  
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT  
terminals on the TV (see illustration).  
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your  
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the  
VCR.  
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the  
ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the  
applicable input mode is selected.  
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
Connecting a camcorder  
You will need:  
Camcorder  
one set of standard A/V cables  
For better picture performance, if your camcorder has S-video, use an  
S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead of the standard video cable.  
Do not connect both an S-video cable and a standard video cable to VIDEO  
3 at the same time or the picture performance will be unacceptable.  
VIDEO AUDIO  
OUT  
L
R
To view the camcorder video:  
Select the VIDEO 3 video input source on the TV.*  
______________  
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control (see page 72).  
To program the TV remote control to operate other devices, see Chapter 3.  
VIDEO 3 inputs  
on TV right side panel  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
15  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a VCR and Cable box  
You will need:  
From Cable TV  
one signal splitter  
five coaxial cables  
two sets of standard A/V cables  
IN  
Cable box  
OUT  
Signal splitter  
OUT  
IN  
CH 3  
CH 4  
OUT  
Stereo VCR  
For better picture performance from your VCR: If your VCR has  
S-video, connect an S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead  
of the standard video cable. Do not connect an S-video cable and  
a standard video cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time  
or the picture performance will be unacceptable.  
VIDEO  
AUDI
L
IN from ANT  
CH 3  
CH 4  
IN  
OUT to TV  
OUT  
L
R
If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV to your  
VCRs audio out terminal using the white audio cable only.  
TV  
When you use a Cable box, you may not be able to use the remote  
control to program or access certain features on the TV.  
To view basic Cable channels and use the TV’s features:  
Select the ANT 1 video input source on the TV.* Use the  
TV controls (front panel or remote control) to change  
channels and access the TV’s features.  
To view basic and premium Cable channels:  
Turn OFF the VCR. Select the ANT 2 video input source  
on the TV.* Tune the TV to channel 3 or 4 (whichever  
channel the Cable box output is set to). Use the Cable box  
controls to change channels.  
To view the VCR:  
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source  
on the TV.*  
Note: A VIDEO 1 connection with an S-Video cable (instead  
of a standard video cable) will provide better picture  
performance (as mentioned in the first bulleted item at the  
top of this page).  
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the  
ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the  
appropriate input mode is selected.*  
To enable the TV Guide On Screen® system to work  
_____________  
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control  
(see page 72). To program the TV remote control to operate other  
devices, see Chapter 3.  
with your cable box and to use the TV Guide  
On Screen® recording features:  
1. Connect the G-LINK® cable according to the instructions  
on page 28.  
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT  
terminals on the TV (see illustration).  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your  
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the  
VCR.  
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
16  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a VCR and satellite receiver  
From antenna  
You will need:  
one signal splitter  
four coaxial cables  
IN  
Signal splitter  
OUT  
OUT  
one set of component video cables (if your  
satellite receiver does not have component  
video, connect the standard A/V cables only)  
Stereo VCR  
VIDEO  
AUDI
L
IN from ANT  
OUT to TV  
one pair of standard audio cables  
CH 3  
CH 4  
IN  
three sets of standard A/V cables  
OUT  
L
R
For better picture performance, if your satellite  
receiver and VCR have S-video, connect S-video  
cables (plus audio cables) instead of the standard  
video cables. Do not connect both types of video  
cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time or  
the picture performance will be unacceptable.  
TV  
If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the  
TV (VIDEO 1) to your VCRs AUDIO OUT terminal  
using the white audio cable only.  
To view satellite programs using the component video  
connections:  
Select the ColorStream HD-1 video input source on the  
TV.*  
From satellite dish  
To view satellite programs using the standard  
video connections or to record satellite programs:  
Satellite receiver  
AUDIO  
OUT  
Turn on all three devices. Set the VCR to the appropriate  
line input (refer to your VCR owner’s manual for details).  
Select the VIDEO 2 video input source on the TV.*  
L
L
Y
P
B
PR  
Satellite  
IN  
R
R
S-VIDEO COMPONENT VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
To view the VCR or view and record antenna channels:  
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the ANT 1,  
ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the appropriate  
input mode is selected.*  
Turn ON the VCR. Tune the VCR to the channel you want  
to watch. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source on the  
TV.*  
To use the TV Guide On Screen® recording features:  
1. Connect the G-LINK® cable according to the instructions  
on page 28.  
_____________  
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control  
(see page 72). To program the TV remote control to operate other  
devices, see Chapter 3.  
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT  
terminals on the TV (see illustration).  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your  
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the  
VCR.  
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
Note: The TV Guide On Screen® system does not receive  
program listings from or for any satellite service.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
17  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a DVD player with S-video, a VCR, and a Cable box  
From antenna or Cable TV  
You will need:  
one signal splitter  
five coaxial cables  
two sets of standard A/V cables  
IN  
Cable box  
OUT  
Signal splitter  
OUT  
IN  
CH 3  
CH 4  
OUT  
Stereo VCR  
Note: If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV  
(VIDEO 1) to your VCRs audio out terminal using the white  
audio cable only.  
VIDEO  
AUDI
L
R
IN from ANT  
CH 3  
CH 4  
IN  
OUT to TV  
OUT  
one S-video cable  
one pair of standard audio cables  
Note:  
L
R
TV  
If your DVD player does not have S-video, use a standard  
video cable instead. Do not connect an S-video cable and a  
standard video cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same  
time or the picture performance will be unacceptable.  
Do not connect the DVD player and VCR to the same set of  
A/V inputs on the TV. (See the illustration, which shows the  
VCR connected to VIDEO 1 on the TV, and the DVD player  
connected to VIDEO 2.)  
If your DVD player has component video, see page 19.  
To view basic channels and access the TVs features:  
Select the ANT 1 video input source.* Use the TV  
controls to change channels and access the TV’s features.  
AUDIO  
OUT  
L
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
VIDEO  
OUT  
R
To view premium Cable channels:  
Turn OFF the VCR. Select the ANT 2 video input  
source on the TV.* Tune the TV to channel 3 or 4  
(whichever channel the Cable box output is set to).  
Use the Cable box controls to change channels.  
DVD player with S-video  
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the ANT 1,  
ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the appropriate input  
mode is selected.*  
Note: When you use a Cable box, you may not be able to  
use the remote control to program or access certain  
features on the TV.  
To view the DVD player:  
To enable the TV Guide On Screen® system to work with  
Turn ON the DVD player. Select the VIDEO 2 video  
input source on the TV.*  
your cable box and to use the TV Guide On Screen®  
recording features:  
To view the VCR:  
1. Connect the G-LINK® cable according to the instructions on  
page 28.  
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input  
source on the TV.*  
_____________  
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control  
(see page 72). To program the TV remote control to operate other  
devices, see Chapter 3.  
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT terminals  
on the TV (see illustration).  
*
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your VCR  
owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the VCR.  
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of  
television programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is  
prohibited under the Copyright Laws of the United States and other  
countries, and may subject you to civil and criminal liability.  
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide On Screen®  
system.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
18  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a DVD player with ColorStream® (component video) and a VCR  
Your TV has ColorStream® (component video) inputs.  
From antenna or Cable  
You will need:  
IN  
Signal splitter  
OUT  
one signal splitter  
OUT  
three coaxial cables  
Stereo VCR  
two sets of standard A/V cables  
VIDEO  
AUDI
For better picture performance, if your VCR has S-video, use an  
S-video cable (plus audio cables) instead of the standard video  
cable. However, do not connect both types of video cable to  
VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time or the picture  
performance will be unacceptable.  
L
R
IN from ANT  
CH 3  
CH 4  
IN  
OUT to TV  
OUT  
L
R
TV  
If you have a mono VCR, connect L/MONO on the TV  
(VIDEO 1) to your VCRs audio out terminal using the white  
audio cable only.  
one pair of standard audio cables  
one set of component video cables  
You can connect the component video cables (plus audio  
cables) from the DVD player to either set of ColorStream  
terminals on the TV (HD-1 or HD-2). The ColorStream HD-1  
and HD-2 terminals can be used with Progressive (480p,  
720p) and Interlaced (480i, 1080i) scan systems. A 1080i  
signal will provide the best picture performance.  
If your DVD player does not have component video, see page  
18. If your DVD player has HDMI video, see page 21.  
AUDIO  
OUT  
To view antenna or Cable channels:  
Y
P
B
PR  
L
Select the ANT 1 video input source on the TV.*  
S-VIDEO  
OUT  
COMPONENT VIDEO  
VIDEO  
OUT  
R
To view the DVD player:  
DVD player with component video  
Turn ON the DVD player. Select the ColorStream HD-1  
video input source on the TV.*  
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the ANT 1,  
ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when the appropriate  
input mode is selected.*  
To view the VCR:  
Turn ON the VCR. Select the VIDEO 1 video input  
source on the TV.*  
To record a TV program while watching a DVD:  
To use the TV Guide On Screen® recording features:  
1. Connect the G-LINK® cable according to the instructions  
on page 28.  
Turn ON the VCR. Tune the VCR to the channel to  
record. Select the ColorStream HD-1 video input source  
on the TV* to view the DVD.  
_____________  
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT  
terminals on the TV (see illustration).  
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control  
(see page 72). To program the TV remote control to operate other  
devices, see Chapter 3.  
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your  
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the  
VCR.  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
19  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting two VCRs  
From antenna or Cable  
You will need:  
one signal splitter  
three coaxial cables  
two sets of standard A/V cables  
IN  
Signal splitter  
OUT  
**  
OUT  
For better picture performance, if VCR 1 has S-video, use  
an S-video cable (plus the audio cables) instead of the  
standard video cable. However, do not connect both types  
of video cable to VIDEO 1 (or VIDEO 2) at the same time  
or the picture performance will be unacceptable.  
VCR1 (plays)  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
L
R
IN from ANT  
OUT to TV  
CH 3  
CH 4  
IN  
OUT  
L
R
If VCR 1 has mono audio, connect L/MONO on the TV (VIDEO 1)  
to the audio out terminal on VCR 1 using the white audio cable  
only.  
TV  
a
Do not connect the same VCR to the output and input terminals on  
the TV at the same time.  
To view the antenna or Cable signal:  
Select the ANT-1 video input source on the TV.*  
b
To view VCR 1:  
Turn ON VCR 1. Select the VIDEO 1 video input source  
on the TV.*  
To dub or edit from VCR 1 to VCR 2:  
Turn ON both VCRs. Set VCR 2 to the appropriate line  
input (refer to your VCR owner’s manual for details). Select  
the VIDEO 1 video input source on the TV.*  
VCR2 (records)  
VIDEO  
AUDI
R
IN from ANT  
CH 3  
CH 4  
IN  
L
Note:  
OUT  
OUT to TV  
L
R
If you have a Cable box, connect the Cable box and splitter to VCR1  
L
R
as shown on page 16.  
The VIDEO OUT signal incorporates Macrovision® copyright  
protection technology, which may prevent you from recording certain  
copy-restricted video materials.***  
a
The VIDEO OUT terminal does not output the POP picture.  
b
When POP mode is active, the AUDIO OUT terminals output the  
sound of the active window (main or POP). For additional  
information, see Notes about recordingon page 81.  
_________________________________________________________________  
Note: The VIDEO/AUDIO OUT terminals output signals from the  
ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, and VIDEO 3 terminals when  
the appropriate input mode is selected.*  
*
To select the video input source, press INPUT on the remote control  
(see page 72). To program the TV remote control to operate other  
devices, see Chapter 3.  
** Do not connect the TV through a VCR. Video signals fed through VCRs may be  
affected by copyright protection systems and the picture will be distorted on the TV.  
To use the TV Guide On Screen® recording features:  
1. Connect the G-LINK® cable according to the instructions  
on page 28.  
*** This product incorporates copyright protection technology that is protected by  
U.S. patents and other intellectual property rights. Use of this copyright protection  
technology must be authorized by Macrovision and is intended for home and other  
limited pay-per-view uses only, unless otherwise authorized by Macrovision.  
Reverse engineering or disassembly is prohibited. Macrovision is a registered  
trademark of Macrovision Corporation.  
2. Make sure the VCR is connected to the A/V OUT  
terminals on the TV (see illustration).  
3. Set the VCR to the appropriate line input (refer to your  
VCR owner’s manual for details), and then turn OFF the  
VCR.  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
4. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
5. See Chapter 7 for details on using the TV Guide  
On Screen® system.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
20  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting an HDMIor DVI device to the HDMI input  
The HDMI[1] input on your TV receives digital audio and  
uncompressed digital video from an HDMI device, or  
uncompressed digital video from a DVI[2] device.  
This input is designed to accept HDCP[3] program material in  
digital form from EIA/CEA-861/861B–compliant[4] consumer  
electronic devices (such as a set-top box or DVD player with  
HDMI or DVI output).  
__________________________________________________________________  
[1]  
[2]  
[3]  
[4]  
HDMI = High-Definition Multimedia Interface.  
DVI = Digital Video Interface.  
HDCP = High-bandwidth Digital Content Protection.  
EIA/CEA-861/861B compliance covers the transmission of  
uncompressed digital video with high-bandwidth digital content  
protection, which is being standardized for reception of high-definition  
video signals. Because this is an evolving technology, it is possible that  
some devices may not operate properly with the TV.  
The HDMI input is designed for best performance with 720p  
signals but will also accept and display 1080i, 480i, and 480p  
signals.  
Note: To ensure that the HDMI or DVI device is reset  
properly, it is recommended that you follow these  
procedures:  
NOTE: DO NOT CONNECT A PC USING THE  
HDMI PORT. ALWAYS use the TV’S PC IN (VGA)  
port to connect a PC.  
When turning on your electronic components, turn on  
the TV first, and then the HDMI or DVI device.  
When turning off your electronic components, turn off  
the HDMI or DVI device first, and then the TV.  
To connect an HDMI device, you will need:  
• one HDMI cable (type A connector) per HDMI  
device  
To connect a DVI device, you will need:  
For proper operation, it is recommended that you use  
as short an HDMI cable as possible. You should not  
encounter difficulty if you use an HDMI cable shorter than  
16.4 ft (5m).  
• one HDMI-to-DVI adapter cable (HDMI type A  
connector) per DVI device  
For proper operation, the length of an HDMI-to-DVI adapter  
cable should not exceed 9.8 ft (3m). The recommended length is  
6.6 ft (2m).  
HDMI cable transfers both video and audio. Separate  
analog audio cables are not required (see illustration  
below). Some CDVs (video CDs) may not output digital  
audio signals. In that case, you may hear sound by  
connecting analog audio cables.  
• one pair of standard analog audio cables per DVI  
device  
An HDMI-to-DVI adapter cable transfers video only.  
Separate analog audio cables are required (see illustration  
below).  
See Setting the HDMIaudio modeon page 55.  
See Setting the HDMIaudio modeon page 55.  
HDMI device  
DVI device  
DVI/HDCP  
OUT  
HDMI OUT  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
VIDEO  
AUDIO  
R
IN  
L
L
R
IN  
L
L
OUT  
R
OUT  
R
TV  
TV  
___________  
HDMI, the HDMI logo and High-Definition Multimedia Interface  
are trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing LLC.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
21  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a device to the TheaterNet OUT infrared terminal  
using the IR blaster cable for IR pass-through device control  
Front of IR-controlled DVD player (for example)  
You can use the TV’s TheaterNet OUT* infrared terminal  
(IR pass-through) to remotely operate—through the TV—many  
infrared remote-controlled devices (such as Toshiba infrared  
remote-controlled VCRs or DVD players) enclosed within an  
entertainment center or similar cabinet. Without the  
TheaterNet OUT connection, the device typically would need  
to be visible to operate it remotely.  
Front of IR-controlled audio device (for example)  
You will need:  
one dual-wand IR blaster cable (included with your TV)  
Infrared  
sensor  
other audio/video cables as required to connect the device(s)  
to the TV (see pages 15–21)  
IR blaster cable wand  
(approx. 1 inch from device)  
To connect the IR blaster cable:  
1. Locate the infrared sensor on the front of your device. This  
sensor is marked on some devices.**  
Back of TV  
2. Align one of the IR blaster cable’s wands about 1 inch away  
from the infrared sensor on the front of the device and  
attach it using double-sided mounting tape. If you have a  
second device, attach the second wand in a similar manner.  
(See illustration at right.)  
Note: If you do not have a second device, coil the second wand  
with a rubber band and leave it behind the TV.  
3. Plug the IR blaster cable’s plug into one of the TV’s  
TheaterNet OUT terminals.  
To control the device(s):  
Point the TV remote control (that  
you previously programmed to  
operate the device; see Chapter 3)  
or the device’s remote control at  
the front of the TV and press the  
button for the desired function.  
The signal passes from the remote  
control through the TV to the  
device via the IR blaster cable.  
**If you cannot locate the devices infrared sensor:  
1. Turn OFF the device.  
2. Starting at the lower left corner of the device, place the end of the  
devices remote control (with the infrared emitter) so it touches the  
front of the device and press POWER. (Do not use the TVs remote  
control for this step.)  
TV/VIDEO  
EXIT  
CHANNEL  
VOLUME  
MENU  
POWER  
3. If the device turns on, the point at which the remote control touched  
the device is the location of the sensor.  
Note:  
If you use the devices remote  
4. If the device does not turn on, move the remote control slightly to the  
right and press POWER again.  
5. Repeat step 4 until you locate the devices infrared sensor.  
control to operate the device, you  
also will need to use the TVs remote control to operate the TV.  
For additional control options, see TheaterNet on-screen device  
controlon the next page.  
___________  
*
The TheaterNet OUT function has been verified for use with Toshiba infrared-controlled devices.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
22  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting an IR receiver/repeater or home theater control system  
to the TheaterNet IN infrared terminal  
For additional control options for your home theater system,  
you can connect an IR receiver/repeater (not included) or a  
home theater control system (not included) to the TV’s  
TheaterNet IN infrared terminal.*  
for your home theater system,  
See the Specifications section in the back of this manual for  
TheaterNet IN terminal requirements.  
TheaterNeton-screen device control  
For additional control options  
set up the TheaterNet  
Toshiba  
Video 3  
on-screen device control  
feature. You can use this  
feature to control many IR  
remote-controlled devices and  
IEEE1394 devices using the  
on-screen control icons.  
ENTER  
Contact your home theater electronics dealer for details about  
IR receivers/repeaters and home theater control systems.  
TOP MENU  
EXIT  
TV/VIDEO  
EXIT  
CHANNEL  
VOLUME  
MENU  
POWER  
You will need:  
one IR cable  
See pages 5054 for details on  
setting up and using TheaterNet.  
TV back panel  
See pages 2527 for details on  
connecting IEEE1394 devices.  
Note: The TheaterNet on-screen icons are the only device functions  
available when the icons are on-screen. To access other device  
functions, close the TheaterNet icon window.  
OUT  
IN  
Back of IR receiver/repeater or home  
theater control system* (not included)  
To operate the TV with this  
connection, point the Toshiba  
TV remote control toward the  
front of the IR receiver/  
repeater or home theater  
control system.  
TV/VIDEO  
EXIT  
CHANNEL  
VOLUME  
MENU  
POWER  
IR receiver/repeater  
or home theater  
control system  
___________  
*
The TheaterNet IN function has been verified for use with  
SmarTouchSTS/STS-C wireless RF control systems. Due to the wide  
variation in remote control operation among manufacturers, these functions may or may not operate with other brands.  
SmarTouch is a trademark of Crestron Electronics, Inc. (www.crestron.com).  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
23  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a digital audio system  
Dolby Digital decoder or  
other digital audio system  
The TV’s DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal outputs a Dolby*  
Digital or 2-channel down-mixed PCM (pulse-code  
modulation) signal for use with an external Dolby Digital  
decoder or other external audio system with optical audio input.  
Optical  
Audio IN  
LINE IN  
L
R
You will need:  
TV  
one optical audio cable (Use an optical audio cable that has  
the larger “TosLink” connector and not the smaller  
“mini-optical” connector.)  
To control the audio:  
1. Turn on the TV and the digital audio device.  
2. Press MENU on the  
TVs remote control  
Audio  
and open the AUDIO  
Audio Settings  
menu.  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Audio Setup  
3. Highlight Audio Setup  
and press ENTER.  
4. In the Optical Output Format field, select either Dolby  
Digital or PCM, depending on your device (see “Selecting  
the optical audio output format” on page 93).  
Note:  
Some audio systems may not be compatible with Dolby Digital bitstream  
signals. Older audio systems that are not compatible with standard  
optical out signals may not work properly, creating a high noise level  
that may damage speakers or headphones. THIS DAMAGE IS NOT  
COVERED BY YOUR WARRANTY.  
Audio Setup  
MTS  
Stereo  
English  
Language  
The DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal outputs signals only when receiving  
digital broadcasts with the TV in single-window mode.  
Speakers  
On  
Optical Output Format  
Dolby Digital  
The DIGITAL AUDIO OUT terminal may not output some digital audio  
sources because of copy restrictions.  
Reset  
Done  
___________  
*Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories.  
Dolby and the double-D symbol are registered trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.  
5. Turn off the TV’s built-in speakers in the same Audio Setup  
menu (above). Also see “Turning off the built-in speakers”  
on page 93.  
Connecting an analog audio system  
This connection allows you to use external speakers with an  
external analog audio amplifier to adjust the sound level.  
Analog audio amplifier  
LINE IN  
You will need:  
L
R
one pair of standard audio cables  
To control the audio:  
TV  
1. Turn on the TV and the stereo amplifier.  
2. Turn off the TV’s built-in speakers (see “Turning off the  
built-in speakers” on page 93).  
Note: To hear sound when using an external audio amplifier,  
the volume of both the TV and the amplifier must be set to a  
reasonable listening level.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
24  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices  
You can use the two bi-directional IEEE1394 ports on the back  
of your TV to connect digital video devices that meet CEA  
specifications for IEEE1394.  
Supported signals  
The IEEE1394 ports support only the signals listed below. Even  
though incompatible video, audio, and digital control signals  
cannot be decoded by the TV, these signals may be passed  
through the IEEE1394 cable to other compatible devices.  
Incompatible devices may not appear in the TheaterNetmenu.  
Because these ports are bi-directional, they can be used for both  
playback and recording.  
Because IEEE1394 is an evolving technology, it is possible that some  
or all of the connectivity features of a device you connect to the TV  
through the IEEE1394 ports may not operate. You should confirm  
that the devices you want to use with the IEEE1394 ports will operate  
with those ports.  
This TV does not support all possible IEEE1394 signal types. For  
information on signals supported by the IEEE1394 ports, see  
Supported signalsat right.  
• MPEG-2 digital video signals  
Other digital video signalssuch as DV videoare  
incompatible and must be decoded by the source device and  
sent to the TV as analog video (composite or S-video).  
• Dolby Digital and MPEG digital audio signals  
Other digital audio signals (such as DPM, MP3, and DTS) are  
incompatible and cannot be decoded by the TV.  
IEEE1394 cable carries both audio and video information;  
separate audio cables are not required.  
• EIA-775 and AV/C digital control  
You will need:  
one (or two) IEEE1394 cables  
Your TV can serve as the control center for many devices  
that are compatible with EIA-775 or AV/C IEEE1394  
control standards (described below).  
Note: The transmission capability of IEEE1394 cable used with this  
TV must be S400 (400 Mbps maximum).  
The TV cannot control IEEE1394 devices that use any other  
control standards.  
additional A/V cables if your device is analog-compatible  
(see “Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices” below).  
EIA-775 digital control allows tuning devices (such as  
Cable boxes) to send simple graphics; however, this  
standard does not allow the TV to control the Cable box  
through IEEE1394.  
TV back panel  
AV/C (audio/video control) provides basic control (such  
as power, play, stop, rewind, fast-forward, pause, and  
record), as applicable to the specific device.  
Using TheaterNeton-screen device  
control  
You can use the TheaterNet feature to control some IEEE1394  
devices using on-screen control icons. See page 50 for details on  
setting up and using the TheaterNet feature.  
}
Two bi-directional  
IEEE1394 ports  
From IEEE1394  
Note: If the TheaterNet feature does not control your  
IEEE1394 device, you can either use the devices remote  
control or try using IR pass-through with the TVs remote  
control (page 22).  
devices (such as  
AVHD or D-VHS)  
Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices  
Some digital IEEE1394 devices are compatible with analog  
signals. For example, some D-VHS VCRs can record and play  
VHS or S-VHS format videos. Such devices allow you to play  
analog tapes that you rented or recorded, or record analog  
programs from antenna or Cable TV systems. To use the  
IEEE1394 device’s analog features, you need to connect the  
device to the TV using standard A/V cables (or S-video plus  
audio cables) in addition to connecting the IEEE1394 cable.  
Note: If you have an IEEE1394 device connected to both digital  
and analog inputs on the TV, the TV automatically switches  
between digital and analog modes, as needed, when the initial  
device access is initiated using the TheaterNet button.  
See page 50 for details on using the TheaterNet feature.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
25  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices (continued)  
Connecting an AVHD (external hard  
drive) or D-VHS digital recorder  
IEEE1394 device initialization  
When you connect a new IEEE1394 device to the TV and turn  
it on, the device immediately announces its presence to the TV  
(and other networked IEEE1394 devices, if any), and the “New  
IEEE1394 Device Initialization” screen (shown in step 2, below)  
automatically appears.  
You can connect an IEEE1394-compatible D-VHS or AVHD  
(audio/video hard drive) digital recorder (such as Toshiba’s  
SymbioAVHD Recorder) to record high definition and  
standard definition material from either tuner and control live  
TV (pause, rewind, etc.).  
Note: With some devices, it may take up to one minute for the  
IEEE1394 Device Initialization screen to appear.  
When you connect an AVHD or D-VHS device to the TV:  
1. If you also connected your IEEE1394 device to an analog  
input, use the yzx • buttons to select the input in the  
ANALOG INPUT USED field; otherwise, leave it set to  
“None.” (See “Using analog-compatible IEEE1394 devices”  
on page 25.)  
• The remote control keys (LIVE, REW, PAUSE, PLAY, etc.) are  
automatically activated to allow control of live TV.  
• The TV Guide On Screen® system is automatically configured to  
allow recording to the device.* See Chapters 5 and 7 for details.  
Also see page 55 for details on setting the AVHD device skip time.  
2. To label the device, highlight Edit Label and press ENTER.  
• Some programs may not be recorded due to copy protection  
restrictions.  
New IEEE1394 Device Initilization  
Manufacturer  
Device Type  
Custom Label  
TOSHIBA  
AVHD  
This TV is compatible with the new Toshiba  
TM  
Edit Label  
Done  
3. Press the yzx • buttons to select a character for the first  
Audio/Video Hard Drive Recorder!  
Toshibas SymbioAVHD Recorder is designed specifically for  
high definition television (HDTV) and offers control over digital  
video recording and playback.  
space and then press ENTER.  
4. Repeat step 3 to enter the rest of the characters.  
5. Highlight Done and press ENTER to save the information.  
Think of it as a tapeless VCRfor digital television. You can pause,  
rewind, or use instant replay, so youll never miss a thing!  
IEEE1394 Device Label Edit  
M Y D E V I C E _  
Symbio also offers one-touch recording* of both standard and  
High Definition programs through the no-fee TV Guide  
On Screen® interactive program guide built in to this TV.  
A
H
O
V
2
B
I
C
J
D
K
R
Y
5
E
L
S
Z
6
F
M
T
0
G
N
U
1
P
W
3
Q
X
4
7
8
9
SPC  
CLR  
BS  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
Cancel  
Done  
Note:  
The TV may not recognize incompatible or non-A/V IEEE1394  
devices; however, these devices may still be available to other  
compatible IEEE1394 devices on the network.  
*
To enjoy the full benefits of your Symbio AVHD Recorder, you must first set  
up the TV Guide On Screen® system (see Chapter 5). Full Symbio AVHD  
Recorder benefits, including Intelligent One Touch recording, will not be  
available unless the TV Guide On Screen® system is fully operational.  
However, even if the TV Guide On Screen® system is not fully operational,  
manual recording is available as long as the TV Guide On Screen® system  
has acquired the necessary date and time data. If you experience any  
issues with your Symbio AVHD Recorder, please contact Toshiba  
Consumer Solutions by calling (800) 631-3811 or visiting  
You may be able to use the TVs remote control to operate some  
compatible IEEE1394 devices. You must first program the  
remote control to recognize the device (see Chapter 3). If you  
have an IEEE1394 Cable box or satellite receiver, you may need  
to use the remote control that came with the device.  
Toshiba is not liable for the operation of any IEEE1394 device  
other than the Toshiba Symbio AVHD recorder.  
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
26  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting IEEE1394 video devices (continued)  
IEEE1394 device management  
Important information regarding  
IEEE1394 device interconnection  
The IEEE1394 device information is saved in the TV’s memory.  
You can edit this device information (for example, edit the  
device name, change the analog input information, or delete the  
device information from the TV’s memory if you no longer use  
that device).  
Never loop the last device in the chain back to the TV.  
If the device chain is looped, the TV may not work properly with the  
other devices in the chain.  
Always place devices with the slowest communication  
speed at the end of each chain. If a device with a slower  
communication speed is placed ahead of a faster device in the  
chain, the signal from the slower device will interfere with the signal  
from the faster device. To determine the communication speed of  
an IEEE1394 device, look for an Snumber near the devices  
IEEE1394 connector. The higher the Snumber, the faster the  
device. If your device is not marked with an Snumber, look in the  
devices user manual or call the device manufacturers technical  
support number.  
To edit the IEEE1394 device information:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of  
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in  
step 3 below).  
Setup  
If your IEEE1394 device has a two-position power  
switch, always place the device at the end of the chain  
and turn ON the power switch when any device is used.  
If the power switch is OFF, it will interfere with signals from devices  
behind it in the chain.  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
The maximum length for an IEEE1394 cable between  
each device is 15 feet.  
3. Open the Devices menu, highlight IEEE1394 Devices, and  
press ENTER.  
This TV is an IEEE1394A device. The IEEE1394B protocol is faster  
and intended to allow for longer distances between devices and  
multi-room systems. IEEE1394AtoIEEE1394B converters  
(available at some electronics suppliers) may allow compatibility of  
IEEE1394B devices with your existing IEEE1394A devices.  
Devices  
IEEE1394 Devices  
The transmission capability of IEEE1394 cable used with this TV  
TheaterNet Devices  
must be S400 (400 Mbps maximum).  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
4. Highlight the device you want to edit and press ENTER.  
IEEE1394 Device Management  
Brand  
Type  
Label  
Analog Input Used Connected  
No  
TOSHIBA  
AVHD MY DEVICE None  
Reset  
Done  
5. Follow the on-screen prompts to modify the device  
information.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
27  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
G-LINK® connection  
This connection is necessary for the TV Guide On Screen® system to work with your cable box to receive program listings  
and to enable the TV Guide On Screen® recording features with your VCR.  
This connection is not necessary for AVHD or D-VHS recording devices. See pages 26 and 55 for further details.  
After you connect your devices to the TV, you will need to connect the G-LINK® cable (either of the dual-wand IR blaster cables  
included with your TV) from your VCR and Cable box (if applicable) to the G-LINK® terminal on the TV.  
Note: TV Guide On Screen® program data is available through the ANT-1 and ANT-2 antenna inputs and also through the VIDEO 1 inputs if you  
have a cable box connected to VIDEO 1. TV Guide On Screen® program data is not available through any other inputs on this TV. See the  
connection information on pages 1527.  
The G-LINK® connection is necessary to enable the following features of your TV Guide On Screen® system:  
• If you have a Cable box, you must connect the G-LINK® cable from the Cable box to the G-LINK® terminal to receive the  
TV Guide On Screen® program listings for your Cable service.  
• If you have a VCR, you must connect the G-LINK® cable from the VCR to the G-LINK® terminal to use the TV Guide  
On Screen® recording features.  
To connect to the G-LINK® terminal:  
Front of Cable box  
1. Locate the infrared sensor on the front of your VCR or  
Cable box. The sensor is marked on some devices.*  
2. Align one of the G-LINK® (IR blaster) cable’s wands about  
1 inch away from the infrared sensor on the front of the  
VCR and attach it using double-sided mounting tape.  
Front of VCR  
If you have a Cable box, attach the other wand in a similar  
manner. (See illustration at right.)  
Note: If you do not have a Cable box, coil the second wand  
with a rubber band and leave it behind the TV.  
Infrared  
3. Plug the G-LINK® (IR blaster) cable’s plug into the TV’s  
sensor  
G-LINK® terminal.  
G-LINK® (IR blaster) cable wand  
(approx. 1 inch from device)  
For details on setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system:  
Back of TV  
See Chapter 5.  
For details on using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive  
program guide:  
See Chapter 7.  
*
If you cannot locate the devices infrared sensor:  
1. Turn OFF the device.  
2. Starting at the lower left corner of the device, place the end of the  
devices remote control (with the infrared emitter) so it touches the  
front of the device and press POWER. (Do not use the TVs remote  
control for this step.)  
3. If the device turns on, the point at which the remote control touched  
the device is the location of the sensor.  
4. If the device does not turn on, move the remote control slightly to the  
right and press POWER again.  
5. Repeat step 4 until you locate the devices infrared sensor.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
28  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a personal computer (PC)  
TV  
This connection allows you to view the image from a PC  
on the TV screen. When connecting a PC to the TV, use an  
analog RGB (15-pin) computer cable and a PC audio cable.  
To use a PC, set the monitor output resolution on the  
PC before connecting it to the TV. The following signals  
can be displayed:  
• VGA: 640 × 480 @ 60Hz  
• SVGA: 800 × 600 @ 60Hz  
• XGA: 1024 × 768 @ 60Hz  
Other formats or non-standard signals may not be  
displayed correctly.  
PC audio  
cable  
To display the optimum picture, use the PC setting  
feature (see “Using the PC setting feature” on page 95).  
Computer  
PC audio  
output  
Signal names for mini D-sub 15-pin  
connector  
Pin assignment for RGB/PC  
terminal  
Conversion  
adapter  
(if necessary)  
5
10  
15  
1
6
11  
Note:  
Some PC models cannot be connected to this TV.  
Pin No.  
Signal name  
An adapter is not needed for computers with a DOS/V compatible  
mini D-sub 15-pin terminal.  
1
2
R
G
B
Depending on the DVDs title and the specifications of the PC on which  
you are playing the DVD-Video, some scenes may be skipped or you  
may not be able to pause during multi-angle scenes.  
3
4
NC (not connected)  
NC  
5
6
Ground  
Ground  
Ground  
NC  
7
8
9
10  
11  
12  
13  
14  
15  
Ground  
NC  
NC  
H-sync  
V-sync  
NC  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
29  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 2: Connecting your TV  
Connecting a home network  
The Toshiba Home Interactive Network Connection (THINC®) feature allows you to network the TV with your home  
PC (personal computer), which will allow access to the TV’s file sharing and e-mail scheduling features.  
See Chapters 10 and 11  
File sharing  
for details on configuring  
and using e-mail scheduling,  
file sharing, the JPEG Picture  
Viewer, and the MP3 Audio Player.  
You can access JPEG and MP3 files that are stored on your networked home PC  
and view/play them on the TV.  
• Connect your TV to your PC /network according to either Example #1 or Example #2, below left.  
• Does NOT require Internet/e-mail service.  
Note:  
• The TV’s home network feature is compatible only with Microsoft®  
Windows® 2000 and the Home or Professional version of Microsoft®  
Windows® XP Service Pack 1 and Service Pack 2. See Chapter 11  
for details.  
E-mail scheduling of recordings and reminders  
You can schedule recordings and reminders by sending an e-  
mail to the TV from any PC. (This connection also allows access  
to file sharing.)  
• The TV’s home network connection allows access to e-mail  
scheduling and file sharing only. You will NOT be able to use  
the TV to access the Internet.  
• Connect your TV to your home network according to Example #3,  
below right.  
• Requires the following:  
– Home Internet service.  
– A dedicated POP3 e-mail address for the TV (different from  
your personal e-mail address).  
– A compatible recording device.  
• If you use an Ethernet crossover cable to connect your PC directly to  
the TV, you will not be able to use the automatic setup and must  
manually set up the network address.  
• If you use a hub or switch to connect the TV to your home network,  
you will not be able to use the automatic setup and must manually  
set up the network address.  
• Contact your ISP (Internet Service Provider) to obtain and set up  
Internet/e-mail service.  
• If you use a router with built-in DHCP functionality, use the  
automatic setup. Manual setup may not work.  
• See Chapter 2 for recording device connection instructions.  
Example #1: Connecting the TV to a home network  
without an Internet connection  
Example #3: Connecting the TV to a home network  
with an Internet connection  
(for file sharing only)  
(for e-mail scheduling and file sharing)  
TV back panel  
You will need:  
You will need:  
one coaxial or telephone cable (depending on your modem)  
three standard Ethernet (RJ-45) cables  
one Ethernet router/switch[1]  
two or more standard  
Ethernet (RJ-45)  
cables (the number of  
cables depends on the  
number of PCs you  
Hub or switch  
one modem (DSL or cable)[1]  
TV back panel  
connect to your  
network)  
PC  
one hub or switch  
PC  
Modem (DSL or cable)  
Router/switch[1]  
Example #2: Connecting the TV directly to a PC  
without an Internet connection  
[3]  
TV back panel  
(for file sharing only)  
[3]  
[2]  
You will need:  
one Ethernet crossover  
cable (i.e., a PC-to-PC  
direct file transfer  
cable)  
Cable or phone jack[4]  
[3]  
Ethernet  
crossover  
cable  
PC  
_____________  
PC  
Note: Do NOT use  
standard Ethernet cable  
with this connection.  
[1] Your router/switch may be part of your DSL or cable modem. Your switch  
may be separate from your router. For assistance, contact your ISP or an IT  
professional.  
[2] Coaxial or telephone cable (depending on your modem type)  
[3] Standard Ethernet (RJ-45) cable  
[4] Do NOT connect a phone jack directly to the TV’s RJ-45 (Ethernet) port.  
Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation  
in the United States and/or other countries.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
30  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Using the remote control  
3
Learning about the remote control  
The buttons used for operating the TV only are described here. For a  
complete list of the remote control’s functions, see the remote control  
functional key chart on pages 34–35.  
For a list of the buttons that operate the TV Guide On Screen® system, see  
page 59.  
POWER turns the TV on and off. Press POWER to turn on the TV. The red  
LED indicator on the TV front touchpad will be illuminated. Press  
POWER again to turn off the TV.  
Note: The Quick Restart™ setting will affect the amount of time it takes for the  
picture to appear when you turn on the TV. See page 56 for details.  
SLEEP accesses the sleep timer (page 94).  
LIGHT The first press of the LIGHT button lights the keypad and turns on  
the Illumination mode. With the Illumination mode on, pressing any key  
lights the keypad for 5 seconds (10 seconds if you’re in programming  
mode). Subsequent presses of the LIGHT button toggle between turning  
the Illumination mode on and off.  
Channel Numbers (0–9, –/100) directly tune channels. The “–” button is used  
to tune digital channels (page 76) or to display the favorite channel list  
(page 49).  
INPUT selects the video input source (page 72).  
MODE cycles through the six remote control device modes: TV, CBL/SAT,  
VCR/PVR, DVD, AUDIO1, and AUDIO2. The mode indicator light will  
remain lit for a few seconds (page 33).  
PIC SIZE cycles through the five pictures sizes: Natural, TheaterWide 1/2/3,  
and Full (page 77).  
TheaterNet™ DEVICE displays a list of available TheaterNet devices (page 50).  
TheaterNet™ CTRL accesses the on-screen IR device control icons (page 51).  
MENU accesses the main TV menu system (pages 40 and 41) or opens a  
menu in the TV Guide On Screen® system (Chapter 7).  
TV GUIDE opens the TV Guide On Screen® system (Chapter 7).  
INFO provides detailed information on highlighted items in the TV Guide  
On Screen® system (Chapter 7).  
ENTER activates highlighted items in the main menu system and the TV  
Guide On Screen® system.  
Arrow buttons (yz x •) When a menu is on-screen, these buttons select or  
adjust programming menus. (Also see  
x /  
on the next page.)  
CH yz cycles through programmed channels when no menu is on-screen (page  
47) and functions as page up/down when a menu is on-screen or when the  
TV Guide On Screen® system is open (Chapter 7).  
Note: The message “Not Available”  
will appear if you press a key for a  
function that is not available  
(Continued on next page)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
31  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Learning about the remote control (continued)  
VOL yz adjusts the volume level.  
EXIT closes on-screen menus and the TV Guide On Screen® system.  
CH RTN returns to the last viewed channel (page 76), or stops the picture viewer slide show  
(page 104).  
Live returns viewing of the TV back to the live program, while continuing to record to the Toshiba  
Symbio™ AVHD recorder (pages 26 and 55).  
RECALL displays TV setting information on-screen (page 96).  
MUTE reduces or turns off the sound (page 90).  
TV/VCR selects TV mode to view one program while recording another.  
SKIP SS and TT jump forward and backward one day in the TV Guide On Screen®  
|
|
listings (Chapter 7).  
LIST displays the Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD recorder play list (if available) (page 26).  
FAV CH yz tunes to the next higher/lower favorite channel (page 49).  
HOME (  
)
accesses the home function of the Channel Browserfeature (page 75)  
x /  
While watching TV, these buttons open the Channel Browser banner and tune to the  
previous/next channel in the channel history (page 74). (Also see “Arrow buttons” on previous  
page.)  
SPLIT turns the POP feature on and off (page 81) or locks/unlocks the TV Guide On Screen®  
video window (page 60).  
PIC MODE selects the picture mode (page 84).  
Remote control effective range  
FAV SCAN accesses the favorite channel search function (page 83).  
For optimum performance, aim the remote  
control directly at the TV and make sure  
there is no obstruction between the  
remote control and the TV.  
FREEZE accesses the freeze feature (page 83).  
Point remote control  
toward remote sensor  
on front of TV.  
16.4 ft (5m)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
32  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Installing the remote control batteries  
To install the remote control batteries:  
Caution:  
Never throw batteries into a fire.  
Caution: Always dispose of batteries in a designated disposal location.  
Never throw batteries into a fire.  
Note:  
1. Slide the battery cover off the back of the remote control.  
Be sure to use AA size batteries.  
Dispose of batteries in a designated disposal area.  
Batteries should always be disposed of with the  
environment in mind. Always dispose of batteries in  
accordance with applicable laws and regulations.  
If the remote control does not operate correctly, or if the  
operating range becomes reduced, replace the batteries  
with new ones.  
2. Install two “AA” size alkaline batteries. Match the + and – symbols on  
the batteries to the symbols on the battery compartment.  
When necessary to replace batteries in the remote  
control, always replace both batteries with new ones.  
Never mix battery types or use new and used batteries  
in combination.  
Always remove the batteries from the remote control if  
they are dead or if the remote control will not be used  
for an extended period of time. This will prevent battery  
acid from leaking into the battery compartment.  
3. Slide the battery cover on to the remote control until the lock snaps.  
Using the remote control MODE button to control your other devices  
Your TV remote control has one dedicated TV mode and five programmable  
multi-brand modes: CBL/SAT, VCR/PVR, DVD, AUDIO 1, and AUDIO 2. The  
default device modes and programmable device modes are listed below.  
Note: The TV remote control is preprogrammed to operate most Toshiba devices.  
If you own a non-Toshiba device or a Toshiba device that the remote control is not  
preprogrammed to operate, you will need to program the remote control. See  
“Programming the remote control to operate your other devices” on page 36.  
Number (1-6)  
MODE  
MODE  
1) TV  
Default device mode control (before programming)  
Toshiba TV  
2) CBL/SAT Toshiba Satellite receiver  
3) VCR/PVR Toshiba VCR  
4) DVD  
Toshiba DVD  
5) AUDIO 1 Pioneer Audio receiver  
6) AUDIO 2 Pioneer LD  
MODE  
1) TV  
Device mode control after programming  
Toshiba TV  
Note:  
Although the TV remote control includes codes  
for many devices, it may not include codes for  
some or all of the features on certain devices  
you wish to control. If you are unable to  
program the TV remote control to operate your  
device or some of the features on that device,  
use the device’s remote control or the control  
buttons on the device.  
2) CBL/SAT  
3) VCR/PVR  
4) DVD  
Multi-brand video/audio devices  
5) AUDIO 1  
6) AUDIO 2  
You can directly select the device mode by pressing the corresponding  
number button (1–6) while pressing the MODE button.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
33  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Remote Control functional key chart  
REMOTE CONTROL DEVICE MODE  
REMOTE  
CONTROL  
KEY  
TV  
CBL/SAT  
CBL/SAT  
DVD  
(LD)  
AUDIO 1 or 2 AUDIO 1 or 2 VCR/PVR  
(Receiver) (CD Player) (VCR)  
VCR/PVR  
(PVR)  
(Toshiba TV) (Cable Box) (Satellite Box)  
MODE  
Toggles among the remote control device modes  
Lights the remote key, and toggles between enabled and disabled Illumination mode.*1  
LIGHT  
SLEEP  
Sleep timer ---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
POWER  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Digit 1  
Digit 2  
Digit 3  
Digit 4  
Digit 5  
Digit 6  
Digit 7  
Digit 8  
Digit 9  
Digit 0  
+10  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Power  
Digit 1  
Digit 2  
Digit 3  
Digit 4  
Digit 5  
Digit 6  
Digit 7  
Digit 8  
Digit 9  
Digit 0  
---  
1
Digit 1  
Digit 2  
Digit 3  
Digit 4  
Digit 5  
Digit 6  
Digit 7  
Digit 8  
Digit 9  
Digit 0  
Digit 1  
Digit 2  
Digit 3  
Digit 4  
Digit 5  
Digit 6  
Digit 7  
Digit 8  
Digit 9  
Digit 0  
---  
Digit 1  
Digit 2  
Digit 3  
Digit 4  
Digit 5  
Digit 6  
Digit 7  
Digit 8  
Digit 9  
Digit 0  
AV input 1 Digit 1  
AV input 2 Digit 2  
AV input 3 Digit 3  
AV input 4 Digit 4  
Digit 1  
Digit 2  
Digit 3  
Digit 4  
Digit 5  
Digit 6  
Digit 7  
Digit 8  
Digit 9  
2
3
4
5
CD  
Digit 5  
Digit 6  
Digit 7  
Digit 8  
Digit 9  
6
Tuner  
Phono  
Cassette  
Aux  
7
8
9
0
---  
Digit 0, 10 Digit 0  
100/–  
– (digital  
– (sub  
---  
---  
100  
- separator)  
channel)  
INPUT  
TV/Video  
select  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
PIC SIZE  
Selects the  
TV  
image shape  
MENU/  
ACTION  
Menu/  
Guide Menu  
---  
Action,  
Menu  
Menu  
---  
---  
---  
Menu  
TV GUIDE/SETUP TV Guide ---  
Guide  
INFO  
DVD setup ---  
Top menu ---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
Guide  
INFO  
INFO/  
Guide Info ---  
TOP MENU  
TheaterNet  
DEVICE/SUBTITLE Device  
TheaterNet ---  
---  
---  
Subtitle  
Audio  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
ADVANCE  
---  
TheaterNet  
CTRL/AUDIO  
TheaterNet ---  
Control  
ENTER  
Enter  
---  
Enter, Select Enter  
---  
---  
---  
---  
Enter  
y
Menu select ---  
up  
Menu select Menu select ---  
up up  
Menu select Menu select ---  
down down  
Menu select Menu select ---  
Menu select  
up  
z
Menu select ---  
down  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
Menu select  
down  
x •  
Menu select ---  
left/right  
Menu select  
left/right  
left/right  
left/right  
EXIT  
/
Exit  
---  
Exit  
DVD clear ---  
Exit  
DVD CLEAR  
CH yz  
PAGE +/–  
Channel  
Channel  
Channel  
up/down  
---  
Channel  
up/down  
Channel  
up/down  
Channel  
up/down  
up/down, up/down  
Page up/down  
VOL yz  
Volume  
Volume  
Volume  
Volume  
Volume  
Volume  
Volume  
Volume  
up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2 up/down*2  
CH RTN/  
DVD RTN  
Previous  
channel  
Previous  
channel  
Previous  
channel  
DVD  
return  
---  
---  
---  
---  
Live  
Live  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
Live TV  
---  
RECALL  
On-screen ---  
display  
On-screen  
display  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
34  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Remote Control functional key chart (continued)  
REMOTE CONTROL DEVICE MODE  
REMOTE  
CONTROL  
KEY  
TV  
CBL/SAT  
CBL/SAT  
DVD  
(LD)  
AUDIO 1 or 2 AUDIO 1 or 2 VCR/PVR  
(Receiver) (CD Player)  
VCR/PVR  
(PVR)  
(Toshiba TV) (Cable Box) (Satellite Box)  
(VCR)  
MUTE  
Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2 Sound mute*2  
SLOW  
x
Slow FWD  
Slow REW  
Slow FWD Slow FWD  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
SKIP  
x
Skip FWD  
Skip REW  
Skip FWD  
Skip REW  
Skip FWD  
Skip REW  
---  
---  
REW  
Rewind  
Pause  
Play  
---  
---  
---  
---  
Rewind  
Pause  
Play  
---  
---  
---  
Rewind  
Pause  
Play  
Rewind  
Pause  
Play  
Rewind  
Pause  
Play  
PAUSE/STEP  
PLAY  
---  
---  
FF  
Fast FWD ---  
---  
Fast FWD ---  
Fast FWD Fast FWD Fast FWD  
TV/VCR  
DISC/AM/FM  
STOP  
---  
---  
---  
---  
TV/SAT  
---  
---  
---  
---  
TV/VCR  
---  
Reverse  
Replay  
Stop  
---  
Disc shift  
Stop  
---  
AM/FM  
---  
Disc shift  
Stop  
---  
Stop  
---  
Stop  
REC  
REC Menu ---  
(Single Click)  
---  
---  
Record  
(Double Click) (Double Click)  
Record  
LIST  
LIST  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
FAV CH yz  
FAV channel ---  
up/down  
HOME  
HOME  
Split  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
SPLIT  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
PIC MODE  
FAV SCAN  
FREEZE  
PIC MODE  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
FAV SCAN ---  
Freeze  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
---  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
TV  
Notes:  
--- = key does not send a signal in that remote control device mode.  
———  
<
TV = key will affect the TV, even when the remote control is not in the “TV” device mode.  
*1 The backlight key is a toggle key and does not send an IR signal.  
*2 By default (factory setting), the remote control’s volume keys (VOL yz and MUTE) are “locked” to the “TV” device mode. The remote control will  
operate the TV’s volume, even when “TV” is not the current device mode. (This includes all remote control device modes except AUDIO 1 and AUDIO 2).  
If you unlock the remote control’s volume keys, each device mode will have its own volume (if the device ID has volume data). The remote control  
will operate the volume of the device associated with the current device mode. (This includes all remote control device modes.)  
If you lock the remote control’s volume keys to a specific device mode, the remote control will operate the volume of the device associated with  
the locked mode, even when the locked mode is not the current device mode. (This includes all device modes except AUDIO 1 and AUDIO 2).  
When the remote control is in AUDIO1 (or AUDIO 2) mode, the remote control will operate the volume of the device associated with the AUDIO 1  
(or AUDIO 2) mode, even when the volume is locked to another mode.  
See “Using the remote control MODE button to control your other devices” on page 33 and “Using the volume lock feature” on page 37.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
35  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Programming the remote control to operate your other devices  
Device code setup  
Searching and sampling the code  
1. Find the code for your device brand in the remote control  
device code table on pages 38–39.  
of a device (8500)  
If you do not know the device code for a particular device, you  
can cycle the remote control through the available codes for that  
device mode and sample the functions to find the code that  
operates the target device. The keys available to be sampled,  
provided they are applicable to that mode, are POWER, 1,  
VOL y, CH y, and PLAY. Invalid keys will be ignored while in  
program mode.  
If more than one code is listed, try each one separately until  
you find one that works.  
2. Press MODE until the mode indicator for the device  
(CBL/SAT, VCR/PVR, DVD, AUDIO 1, or AUDIO 2)  
lights up.  
3. While holding down the RECALL button, press the  
Number buttons to enter the four-digit code for your  
device.  
To cycle through each available device code and sample its  
functions:  
• If a valid code is entered, the mode indicator will blink  
two times.  
1. Press MODE to select the mode you want to set up.  
2. While holding down RECALL, press 8, 5, 0, 0. The remote  
control will enter program mode.  
• If an invalid code is entered, the mode indicator will blink  
one long blink.  
3. Point the remote control at the target device and press  
POWER (or other function buttons that are available to be  
sampled).  
4. Point the remote control at the device and press POWER  
to test the code.  
• If the device responds to the remote control, you have  
entered the correct code.  
4. If the device responds to the remote control:  
Press RECALL to store the device code. The mode  
indicator will blink two times and the remote control  
will exit the program mode.  
• If the device does not respond to the remote control,  
repeat steps 3 and 4 using another code.  
Note: After programming the remote control, make sure all  
necessary keys on the TV remote control (in addition to  
POWER) operate your device. If some keys are not  
operational, repeat the device code setup using another code  
(if other codes are listed for your device). If, after trying all  
listed codes, the necessary keys do not operate your device,  
use the device’s original remote control.  
If the device does not respond to the remote control:  
Press y, and then press POWER. Repeat this step until  
the device responds to the remote control, and then press  
RECALL.  
Note: When a search cycle is completed, the mode  
indicator will blink three times. The remote control will  
begin to cycle through the available codes again. If no key  
is pressed within 10 seconds during programming, the  
remote control will exit the program mode and return to  
the previous code.  
5. To control the TV, repeatedly press MODE to select “TV.”  
Note:  
• Although the TV remote control includes codes for many devices, it may  
not include codes for some or all of the features on certain devices you  
want to control. If you are unable to program the TV remote control to  
operate your device or some of the features on that device, use the  
device’s original remote control (or the control buttons on the device).  
POWER  
Numbers  
MODE  
• Every time you change the batteries you will need to reprogram the  
remote control.  
• Some newer VCRs respond to either of two codes. These VCRs have a  
switch labeled “VCR1/VCR2.” If your VCR has this kind of switch and  
does not respond to the codes for your VCR brand, set the switch to the  
other position (“VCR1” or “VCR2”) and reprogram the remote control.  
y
CH y  
VOL y  
RECALL  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
36  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Programming the remote control to operate your other devices (continued)  
Using the volume lock feature (8000) Operational feature reset (8900)  
This feature clears all programmed remote control features not  
related to “Device code setup” and resets the volume lock to the  
“TV” device mode.  
By default (factory setting), the remote control’s volume keys  
(VOL yz and MUTE) are locked to the “TV” device mode.  
The remote control will operate the TV’s volume, even when  
“TV” is not the current device mode. (This includes all remote  
control device modes except AUDIO 1 and AUDIO 2).  
To reset the remote control:  
While holding down the RECALL button, press 8, 9, 0, 0.  
The mode indicator will blink two times, pause, and then  
blink two more times.  
If you unlock the remote control’s volume keys, each device  
mode will have its own volume (if the device ID has volume  
data). The remote control will operate the volume of the device  
associated with the current device mode. (This includes all  
remote control device modes.)  
If you lock the remote control’s volume keys to a specific device  
mode, the remote control will operate the volume of the device  
associated with the locked mode, even when the locked mode is  
not the current device mode. (This includes all device modes  
except AUDIO 1 and AUDIO 2).  
Numbers  
MODE  
When the remote control is in AUDIO1 (or AUDIO 2) mode,  
the remote control will operate the volume of the device  
associated with the AUDIO 1 (or AUDIO 2) mode, even when  
the volume is locked to another mode.  
See “Using the remote control MODE button to control your  
other devices” on page 33.  
VOL yz  
RECALL  
To lock the remote control’s volume keys to a specific mode  
(CBL/SAT in this example):  
1. Repeatedly press MODE to select CBL/SAT mode.  
2. While holding down the RECALL button, press 8, 0, 0, 0.  
3. Press VOL y.The CBL/SAT mode indicator will blink two  
times (locked).  
The remote control’s volume keys will now operate the  
volume of the device associated with the CBL/SAT mode,  
even when CBL/SAT is not the current device mode (for all  
device modes except AUDIO 1 and AUDIO 2).  
To unlock the remote controls volume keys:  
1. While holding down RECALL, press 8, 0, 0, 0.  
2. Press VOL z. The CBL/SAT mode indicator will blink four  
times (unlocked).  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
37  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Multi-brand remote control device codes  
VCRs/PVRs  
Brand  
VCRs/PVRs (cont.)  
Brand  
Cable boxes  
Brand  
Code  
Code  
Code  
ADMIRAL  
AIWA  
AKAI  
0135  
PHILCO  
PHILIPS  
0131, 0124, 0127,  
0123, 0126, 0120,  
0143  
0131, 0123, 0124,  
0173  
ABC  
ARCHER  
CABLEVIEW  
CITIZEN  
CURTIS  
DIAMOND  
EAGLE  
EASTERN  
GCBRAND  
GEMINI  
1124  
0127, 0132, 0181  
0129, 0114, 0115,  
0116  
0139, 0111  
0105, 0113  
0120, 0126, 0180  
0123, 0125  
0143  
1132, 1125  
1105, 1132  
1122, 1105  
1112, 1113  
1124, 1132, 1125  
1129  
AUDIO DYNAMIC  
BELL&HOWELL  
BROKSONIC  
CANON  
CCE  
CITIZEN  
CRAIG  
CURTIS MATHES  
DAEWOO  
PIONEER  
PROSCAN  
0123  
0145, 0100, 0123,  
0124, 0131, 0146,  
0101, 0102, 0133  
0121, 0122, 0123,  
0124  
0133, 0124, 0105,  
0136, 0109, 0140,  
0127  
0133, 0145, 0100,  
0123, 0124, 0131,  
0146, 0101, 0102,  
0170, 0172, 0174,  
0176, 0183  
0124, 0105, 0136,  
0109, 0140, 0127  
7102  
0137, 0102, 0104,  
0133  
0163  
0139, 0126, 0120,  
0152  
0105, 0109, 0113  
0101, 0102, 0104,  
0109, 0138, 0140,  
0147, 0148, 0126  
0105, 0106, 0107,  
0108, 0100  
0135, 0136, 0167,  
0162  
0117  
1134  
1132, 1105  
1122, 1143  
1119, 1124, 1125,  
1126, 1127, 1120,  
1121, 1122, 1111,  
1123, 1152  
1140, 1141, 1142,  
1145, 1118, 1112  
1103, 1124  
1119, 1124, 1125,  
1126, 1127, 1120,  
1121, 1122, 1111,  
1123, 1152  
1103, 1104, 1105,  
1108  
0106  
QUASAR  
0105, 0129, 0106  
0145, 0124, 0127  
0143, 0101, 0124,  
0175  
0139, 0110, 0111  
0145  
0143, 0126, 0119,  
0103, 0125, 0142,  
0120, 0118  
0105, 0108, 0109,  
0107, 0113, 0165  
0127, 0126, 0120,  
0134  
0133, 0145, 0124  
0137, 0151, 0163,  
0149, 0150, 0182  
0106  
0170, 0171, 0168,  
0134, 0156  
0123, 0145, 0100,  
0127, 0168  
0124, 0123  
G.I. (GENERAL  
INSTRUMENT)  
RADIO SHACK  
DBX  
DIMENSIA  
EMERSON  
RCA  
HAMLIN  
HITACHI  
JERROLD  
FISHER  
FUNAI  
REALISTIC  
Replay TV  
SAMSUNG  
MACOM  
GE  
GO VIDEO  
MAGNAVOX  
MEMOREX  
MOTOROLA  
1133  
1130  
SAMTRON  
SANSUI  
1119, 1124, 1125,  
1126, 1127, 1120,  
1121, 1122, 1111,  
1123, 1152  
1132, 1105  
1139, 1137, 1102  
1109, 1110, 1114,  
1151, 1153  
1128, 1129, 1130,  
1106, 1107, 1150,  
1131  
1101, 1116  
1105, 1132  
1132  
1115  
1132  
GOLDSTAR  
GRADIENTE  
SANYO  
SCOTT  
HITACHI  
MOVIETIME  
OAK  
PANASONIC  
INSTANT REPLAY  
JENSEN  
JVC  
SEARS  
SHARP  
0139  
0139, 0110, 0111,  
0134, 0157, 0158,  
0184, 0185, 7104  
0139, 0110, 0106,  
0111  
PHILIPS  
SHINTOM  
SIGNATURE 2000  
SINGER  
KENWOOD  
0127, 0135  
0117  
0128, 0129, 0130,  
0153, 0154, 0155,  
7101  
0127  
0131, 0123, 0124,  
0127, 0178  
PIONEER  
PULSAR  
PUSER  
RCA  
REALISTIC  
REGAL  
LG  
LXI  
0159  
SONY  
0127, 0106, 0100,  
0107, 0108, 0105,  
0109  
0131, 0123, 0124,  
0173  
SV2000  
SYLVANIA  
1112, 1118, 1140,  
1141, 1142, 1145,  
1149  
MAGNAVOX  
MARANTZ  
MARTA  
MEMOREX  
MGA  
0139, 0110, 0111  
0106  
0124, 0109  
0138, 0140, 0147,  
0148, 0141, 0142  
0100, 0145  
0138, 0140, 0147,  
0148, 0141, 0142,  
0161, 0164  
0147, 0127, 0104  
0139, 0110, 0111,  
0134  
0124, 0123  
0128, 0121, 0135,  
0106  
SYMPHONIC  
TASHIRO  
TATUNG  
TEAC  
0127, 0168, 0177  
0106  
0139, 0110, 0111  
0139, 0110, 0127,  
0111  
0121, 0122, 0123,  
0124  
0124, 0127, 0112  
0179, 0183  
REGENCY  
REMBRANT  
1134  
1137, 1132, 1105,  
1138  
1105  
1111, 1112, 1113  
SAMSUNG  
SCIENTIFIC  
AMERICAN  
SLMARK  
MINOLTA  
MITSUBISHI  
TECHNICS  
1105, 1101  
1105, 1110  
1132, 1105  
1148  
1101, 1105  
1144  
1135, 1136, 1147  
1104, 1146  
1132, 1125  
1122, 1132  
1106  
1129, 1130  
1117, 1100  
1100  
TEKNICA  
THOMSON  
Tivo  
SPRUCER  
STARGATE  
TELECAPTION  
TELEVIEW  
TEXSCAN  
TOCOM  
MULTITECH  
NEC  
7100, 7101  
0101, 0146, 0166,  
0160  
TOSHIBA  
OLYMPIC  
OPTIMUS  
VECTOR RESEARCH 0111  
WARDS  
0135, 0136, 0109,  
TOSHIBA  
UNIKA  
0144, 0106  
0105, 0139, 0110,  
0111  
0144, 0106, 0169,  
0180  
ORION  
PANASONIC  
0126, 0120, 0132  
0123, 0124, 0121,  
0122  
0124, 0100, 0145,  
0105, 0139, 0110,  
0111  
YAMAHA  
ZENITH  
UNIVERSAL  
VIDEOWAY  
VIEWSTAR  
ZENITH  
ZENITH/DRAKE  
SATELLITE  
PENNEY  
PENTAX  
0100, 0111, 0145  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
38  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 3: Using the remote control  
Multi-brand remote control device codes (continued)  
Receivers (cont.)  
Brand  
DVD players  
Brand  
CD players  
Brand  
Code  
Code  
Code  
ADMIRAL  
AIWA  
CARVER  
DENON  
EMERSON  
FISHER  
GARRARD  
HARMAN/KARDON 6120, 6121, 6123,  
6119  
6126  
6133, 6135  
6129  
6142, 6151  
6139  
6105, 6106  
6117  
PIONEER  
QUASAR  
RCA  
4105, 4107, 4150  
4119, 4118, 4121  
4103, 4105, 4127,  
4131, 4130, 4149  
4103, 4111, 4139  
4134, 4137  
4122  
4138  
4112, 4113, 4111,  
4110  
4121, 4118, 4119  
4132, 4133  
AIWA  
APEX  
DENON  
FERGUSON  
HITACHI  
JVC  
KENWOOD  
KONKA  
MITSUBISHI  
NORDMENDE  
ONKYO  
ORITRON  
PANASONIC  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
RAITE  
3123  
3120  
3100, 3117  
3101  
3111  
3109  
3115, 3129  
3119  
3105  
3101  
3121  
3124  
3100  
3103, 3116  
3102  
SANSUI  
SHARP  
SONY  
SOUNDE-SIGH  
TEAC  
HITACHI  
JENSEN  
JVC  
6107  
6134  
6140, 6141, 6145,  
6148, 6151  
6100, 6101, 6111,  
6145  
TECHNICS  
VICTOR  
YAMAHA  
4101, 4102  
KENWOOD  
Laser disks  
Brand  
Code  
LXI  
6136  
3113  
MAGNAVOX  
MARANTZ  
MACINTOSH  
NAKAMICHI  
ONKYO  
6129, 6132  
6129  
6121  
RCA  
SABA  
SAMPO  
SAMSUNG  
SHARP  
SYLVANIA  
SMC  
SONY  
3101, 3106  
3101  
3114  
3110  
3108  
3132, 3118  
3125  
3104, 3126, 3127,  
3128  
3100  
3101  
3103  
3122  
3100, 3130  
3107, 3112  
3131  
DENON  
HITACHI  
5114  
5100  
5102, 5103  
5101  
5114  
5114, 5118, 5119  
5114  
5104, 5105, 5106,  
5115  
5111  
5114  
5114  
5104, 5105, 5106,  
5115  
5114  
5112  
5114, 5117  
5113, 5116  
5107, 5108, 5109,  
5110  
5114  
5114  
KENWOOD  
MAGNAVOX  
MARANTZ  
MITSUBISHI  
NEC  
6110  
6114, 6115  
6108, 6118, 6120,  
6122  
6124, 6125, 6127,  
6150  
OPTIMUS  
PANASONIC  
PANASONIC  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
QUASAR  
RCA  
6129, 6130, 6149  
6108  
TECHNICS  
THOMSON  
TOSHIBA  
WAVE  
YAMAHA  
ZENITH  
VIALTA  
PHILIPS  
PIONEER  
PROSCAN  
QUASAR  
6125, 6127, 6124  
6147, 6137, 6138,  
6131, 6152  
6110, 6146, 6113  
6105  
6110, 6146  
6142, 6143  
6120  
6128  
6144  
6112, 6116, 6118  
6127, 6124, 6125  
6140, 6141, 6145  
6102, 6103, 6104  
SANSUI  
SANYO  
SCOTT  
SHARP  
SHERWOOD  
SONY  
SOUNDE-SIGH  
TEAC  
TECHNICS  
VICTOR  
YAMAHA  
RCA  
SAMSUNG  
SANYO  
SHARP  
SONY  
FUNAI  
3132, 3118  
Satellite receivers  
Brand  
DISH NETWORK  
(Echostar)  
ECHOSTAR  
EXPRESS VU  
G.E.  
Code  
2105, 2115, 2116,  
2117  
2105  
2105, 2115  
2106  
TEAC  
TOSHIBA  
YAMAHA  
5101  
G.I.(GENERAL  
INSTRUMENT)  
GRADIENTE  
HITACHI  
HNS(Hughes)  
MAGNAVOX  
PANASONIC  
PHILIPS  
2108  
Receivers  
Brand  
Code  
2114  
2103, 2111, 2112  
2103  
2101, 2102  
2104  
2101, 2102, 2118  
2108  
2106, 2109, 2110,  
2113  
2106, 2109, 2110,  
2113  
ADMIRAL  
AIWA  
DENON  
4120  
4125, 4126, 4146  
4134, 4135, 4136,  
4143  
4104  
4113  
FISHER  
GARRARD  
HARMAN KARDON 4115, 4123, 4145  
JENSEN  
JVC  
PRIMESTAR  
PROSCAN  
4129  
4132, 4133, 4140,  
4144  
RCA  
SONY  
STAR CHOICE  
TOSHIBA  
2107  
KENWOOD  
4100, 4108, 4141,  
4142, 4147  
4127, 4128  
4124  
4116  
4148  
4106, 4117  
4109, 4114  
4103, 4127, 4131,  
4130  
2103, 2108  
2100, 2103, 2119,  
2120, 2121, 2122,  
2123, 2124, 2125  
2101, 2102  
MAGNAVOX  
MARANTZ  
MCNTOSH  
MITSUBISHI  
NAKAMICHI  
ONKYO  
UNIDEN  
OPTIMUS  
PANASONIC  
PHILIPS  
4119, 4118, 4121  
4123  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
39  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Menu layout and navigation  
4
The illustrations below and on the next page provide a quick overview of your TV’s menu system.  
Main menu layout  
To open the main menus (illustrated below), press MENU on the remote control or TV front panel.  
TV Guide On Screen® Opens the TV Guide On Screen® system  
Audio Player Launches the MP3 Audio Player  
Applications Picture Viewer Launches the JPEG Picture Viewer  
Digital CC / Audio Selector Launches the ATSC Digital CC Selector  
CableCARD™ Dynamic list of items provided by inserted CableCARD™.  
(This option is not available if a CableCARD™ is not inserted.)  
Picture Settings [ Picture Settings edit window ]  
Video  
Advanced Picture Settings [ Advanced Picture Settings edit window ]  
Theater Settings [ Theater Settings edit window ]  
Audio Settings [ Audio Settings window ]  
Audio  
Advanced Audio Settings [ Advanced Audio Settings window ]  
Audio Setup [ Audio Setup window ]  
Favorite Channels [ Favorite Channels edit window ]  
Closed Caption Mode Off / CC1 / CC2 / CC3 / CC4 / T1 / T2 / T3 / T4  
Closed Caption Advanced [ Advanced Closed Captions window ]  
Input Labeling [ Input Labeling edit window ]  
Preferences  
Menu Language English / Français / Español  
Home CH Setup [ Home Channel Setup window ]  
Enable Rating Blocking Off / On  
Locks  
Edit Rating Limits [ Edit Rating Limits edit window ]  
Channels Block [ Channels Block edit window ]  
Input Lock Off / Video / Video+  
Front Panel Lock Off / On  
GameTimer™ Off / 30 Min / 60 Min / 90 Min / 120 Min  
New PIN Code [ New PIN Code entry window ]  
Installation [Opens the Installation menu (see page 41 for details) ]  
Sleep Timer [ Sleep Timer edit window ]  
On/Off Timer [ On/Off Timer window ]  
PC Settings [ PC Settings edit window ]  
HDMI 1 Audio Auto / Digital / Analog  
HDMI 2 Audio Auto / Digital / Analog  
Slide Show Interval 2 sec. / 5 sec. / 10 sec. / 15 sec. / 20 sec.  
AVHD Skip Time 1 min. / 3 min. / 5 min. / 15 min.  
Gray Level 1 / 2 / 3  
Setup  
Applications  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
Picture Viewer  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Note: The menu backgrounds  
may sometimes appear black,  
depending on the signal being  
received.  
Quick Restart Off / On  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
40  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 4: Menu layout and navigation  
Setup/Installation menu layout  
To open the Installation menu (illustrated below), press MENU on the remote control or TV front panel, open the Setup menu,  
select Installation, and press ENTER.  
Press MENU. Open  
the Setup menu,  
and then open the  
Installation sub-menu – –  
Input Configuration [ Input Configuration window ]  
Terrestrial  
Channel Program ANT1  
[ Scans for new channels on selected Antenna ]  
}
ANT2  
Channel Add/Delete [ Channel Add/Delete window ]  
Signal Meter [ Signal Meter window ]  
IEEE1394 Devices [ IEEE1394 Device Management window ]  
Devices  
Network  
TheaterNet Devices [ TheaterNet Setup window ]  
Basic Network Setup  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
Home File Server Setup  
TV Guide On Screen® Setup Start [ Launches the TV Guide On Screen® system setup ]  
Time and Date Start Setup [ Opens the Time and Date Setup window ]  
System Status System Information [ Opens the System Information window ]  
Navigating the menu system  
You can use the buttons on the remote  
control or TV front touchpad to access and  
navigate your TV’s on-screen menu system.  
TV front panel touchpad  
Remote control  
• Press MENU to open the menu system.  
• When a menu is open, use the  
up/down/left/right arrow buttons  
(yzx •) on the remote control  
or TV front panel to move in the  
corresponding direction in the menu.  
EXIT  
MENU  
(ENTER*)  
z
y
x
MENU  
*The MENU button on the TV front panel touchpad  
• Press ENTER to save your menu  
settings or select a highlighted item.  
(A highlighted menu item appears  
in a different color in the menu.)  
functions as the ENTER button when a menu is on-screen.  
ENTER  
y
x
z
• All menus close automatically if you  
do not make a selection within 60  
seconds, except the signal meter  
menu, which closes automatically  
after 5 minutes.  
EXIT  
To close a menu instantly, press EXIT.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
41  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
TV Guide On Screen® setup  
5
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system  
The TV Guide On Screen® system in this TV is a no-fee  
Configuring the location of your TV  
Screen 1: Select the TV location (USA or Canada), and then  
interactive program guide that uses the information you enter  
during the following setup process to provide you with a  
channel lineup and program listings for your area. The listings  
are automatically updated several times a day.  
press ENTER.  
Note:  
You must first set up your TV according to the applicable  
connection instructions in Chapter 2.  
If you connected a Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder, you must  
perform the following TV Guide On Screen® system setup in  
order to use the Symbio’s full functionality. See pages 26 and 55  
for further details about AVHD digital recorders.  
To set up the TV Guide On Screen® system:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER.  
Screen 2: Enter the ZIP code (U.S.A.) or postal code (Canada)  
for your location (use the Number buttons on the remote  
control for numbers and the yz buttons for letters), and  
then press ENTER. Screen 3 appears.  
Setup  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
3. A new set of Installation  
menu icons appears  
on-screen (see  
Screen 3: Do you have Cable service connected?  
If you select Yes (and press ENTER), screen 4 appears.  
If you select No (and press ENTER), screen 12 appears.  
TV Guide On Screen Setup  
Start  
illustration at right).  
Open the TV Guide  
On Screen® Setup  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
menu, highlight Start,  
and press ENTER.  
4. The following screen appears. Highlight Set up TV Guide  
On Screen® nowand press ENTER to continue.  
Screen 4: Do you have a Cable box connected?  
If you select Yes (and press ENTER), screen 5 appears.  
If you select No (and press ENTER), screen 13 appears.  
5. The following screen appears. Press ENTER to continue.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
42  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen® setup  
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system (continued)  
Screen 5: Which TV input is your cable box plugged into?  
If you select ANT 1, screen 6 appears.  
Screen 9: To allow the TV Guide On Screen® system to find the  
correct code for your brand of Cable box, tune your Cable  
box to channel 02, leave the Cable box and TV ON, and  
then press ENTER. Screen 10 appears.  
If you select Video 1, screen 7 appears.  
Screen 6: Select the channel your TV is tuned to when using  
Screen 10: The TV Guide On Screen® system will test the code  
for the brand of Cable box you selected. Do not press any  
keys on the TV, remote control, or Cable box until the  
testing process is completed. When testing is completed,  
screen 11 appears.  
your cable box, and then press ENTER. Screen 7 appears.  
Screen 7: The on-screen diagram shows the correct way to  
connect your Cable box to the G-LINK® terminal on the  
TV. Make sure the G-LINK® cable is installed properly.  
For additional details, see page 28.  
Screen 11: If your Cable box tuned itself to channel 09 after  
testing, select Yes and press ENTER.  
Press ENTER to display screen 8.  
If you selected ANT 1 in screen 5, screen 13 appears.  
If you selected Video 1 in screen 5, screen 12 appears.  
Screen 8: Highlight your Cable box brand, and then press  
ENTER to display screen 9.  
If your Cable box did not tune itself to channel 09 after  
testing and you want to test the same code again, select  
Test this code againand press ENTER.  
If you want to test a different code, select No and press  
ENTER. Screen 10 appears.  
Note: Many cable boxes require testing more than one code.  
(Continued on next page)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
43  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen® setup  
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system (continued)  
Screen 12: Do you have an antenna connected?  
Select either Yes or No, and then press ENTER. Screen 13  
appears.  
Screen 16: The on-screen diagram shows the correct way to  
connect your VCR to the G-LINK® terminal on the TV.  
Make sure the G-LINK® cable is installed properly. For  
additional details, see page 28.  
Note: If you selected No in screen 3, you must select Yes in  
Press ENTER to display screen 17.  
this screen to receive a channel lineup and program listings.  
Screen 13: Are the settings correct?  
If you select Yes, screen 14 appears.  
If you select No, screen 1 appears.  
Screen 17: Select your VCR brand, and then press ENTER.  
Screen 18 appears.  
Screen 18: Turn on your VCR, insert a tape (either blank or  
previously recorded), and then press PLAY. Screen 19  
appears.  
Screen 14: Congratulations! You have completed basic  
TV Guide On Screen® system setup.  
Note: Read the on-screen information regarding the amount  
of time it may take for listing information to download from  
the TV Guide On Screen® service. Also see “TV Guide On  
Screen® Reminder” on page 45.  
Press ENTER to display screen 15.  
Screen 19: The TV Guide On Screen® system will test the code  
for the brand of VCR you selected. Do not press any keys  
on the TV, remote control, or VCR until the testing process  
is completed. When testing is completed, screen 20 appears.  
Screen 15: Is a VCR connected?  
If you select Yes, screen 16 appears.  
If you select No, screen 21 appears.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
44  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 5: TV Guide On Screen® setup  
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system (continued)  
Screen 20: If your VCR stopped playing the tape after testing,  
TV Guide On Screen® Reminder  
select Yes and press ENTER. Screen 21 appears.  
If your VCR did not  
stop playing the tape  
after testing and you  
want to test the same  
code again, select  
The TV Guide On Screen® system receives program listing  
data through your Cable or over-the-air video signal. In  
order to receive regular program listing updates, remember  
to do the following:  
Did your VCR stop playing?  
1. Leave the TV in standby mode when it is not in use  
by turning it OFF but leaving the power cord  
plugged in.  
Test this code again”  
and press ENTER.  
If you want to test a  
different code, select No and press ENTER. Screen 19  
appears.  
2. If you have a Cable box connected, leave it ON.  
3. If you have a VCR connected, turn it OFF when not  
in use (but do not unplug the power cord). See pages  
1516 for VCR connection instructions.  
Note: Many VCRs require testing more than one code.  
4. If you have more than one Cable system in your area,  
you may be prompted to select which Cable systems  
program data to download. If so prompted, follow the  
on-screen instructions.  
Screen 21: Review the setup information displayed on your TV  
screen (an example is shown below).  
If the information on  
your TV screen is  
correct for your setup,  
select Yes, end setup”  
and press ENTER.  
Screen 22 appears.  
Note: If the TV power cord is unplugged for an  
extended period of time, it may take up to 24 hours with  
the TV in standby mode (power cord plugged in and  
power OFF) to download the TV Guide On Screen®  
program schedule. It may take up to 7 days before an  
entire program schedule is available.  
If the information is  
incorrect, select No,  
repeat setup processand press ENTER. Screen 1 appears.  
Turning off the TV Guide On Screen®  
automatic display feature  
Screen 22: Congratulations! You have successfully completed  
TV Guide On Screen® system setup.  
After you set up the TV Guide On Screen® system, the  
program guide will display automatically (by default) when  
you turn on the TV.  
Press ENTER to  
display screen 23.  
To turn off the automatic program guide:  
1. Press TV GUIDE on the remote control to open the  
TV Guide On Screen® system (if it is not already open).  
2. Use the x • buttons to select the Setup menu.  
3. Use the yz buttons to select Change Default  
Options,and then press ENTER.  
Screen 23: This screen provides helpful information on using  
4. Use the yz buttons to select General Defaults,and  
your TV Guide On Screen® system.  
then press ENTER.  
5. Set the Auto Guideoption to Off.  
Press ENTER to exit  
the TV Guide  
6. Use the yz buttons to select Done, and then press  
On Screen® setup and  
watch TV.  
ENTER.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
45  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Setting up your TV  
6
For menu navigation instructions, see Chapter 4.  
Selecting the menu language  
Configuring the antenna input  
sources for the ANT 1 and ANT 2  
terminals  
You can choose from three different languages (English, French  
and Spanish) for the on-screen display of menus and messages.  
Note: The TV Guide On Screen® menus are in English,  
regardless of the language selected in this menu.  
To configure the ANT 1 and ANT 2 input sources:  
To select the menu language:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of  
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in  
step 3 below.)  
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.  
2. Highlight Menu Language and press .  
3. Press y or z to select your preferred menu language and  
press ENTER.  
Setup  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
Preferences  
English  
Français  
Español  
Favorite Channels  
Closed Caption Mode  
Off  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
Closed Caption Advanced  
Input Labeling  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Menu Language  
English  
Home CH Setup  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
3. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight Input Configuration,  
and press ENTER.  
4. Press EXIT to close the Preferences menu.  
Note: The Terrestrial menu may not be accessible (items will be  
“grayed out”) in some instances (for example, if a cable box is  
connected to the ANT 1 input or if one of the VIDEO modes is the  
current input during TV Guide On Screen® setup).  
Terrestrial  
Input Configuration  
Channel Program  
Channel Add/Delete  
Signal Meter  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
4. Press x or to select the input source (Cable or Antenna)  
for the ANT 1 input on the TV.  
Note: If a cable box is connected to the ANT 1 input during TV  
Guide On Screen® setup, the entire Terrestrial menu will not be  
accessible, including the input source for ANT 1, which will  
automatically display “Cable Box.”  
5. Press z and then x or to select the input source (Cable  
or Antenna) for the ANT 2 input on the TV, if applicable.  
If you have not connected anything to the ANT 2 input,  
skip this step.  
Input Configuration  
Antenna 1 In  
Cable  
Antenna 2 In  
Antenna  
Cancel  
Done  
6. To save your new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to your original settings, highlight  
Cancel and press ENTER.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
46  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Programming channels into the TVs channel memory  
When you press CHANNEL y or z on the remote control or  
TV front panel, your TV will stop only on the channels you  
program into the TV’s channel memory.  
4. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight Channel Program,  
and press ENTER.  
5. Highlight ANT 1 or  
ANT 2, depending on  
which antenna input  
you want to program  
channels for, and then  
press ENTER to start  
automatic channel  
Follow the steps below to program channels into the TV’s  
channel memory.  
Terrestrial  
Input Configuration  
Channel Program  
Channel Add/Delete  
Signal Meter  
Programming channels automatically  
Your TV can automatically detect all active channels in your area  
and store them in its memory. After the channels are  
programmed automatically, you can manually add or erase  
individual channels.  
programming.  
Navigate  
ANT 1  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Antenna  
Scanning channels, please wait ...  
Note:  
52%  
Abort  
You must configure the antenna input sources before  
programming channels (see page 46).  
The TV will automatically cycle through all the channels  
for the antenna input you selected, and store all active  
channels in the channel memory. While the TV is cycling  
through the channels, the message “Scanning channels,  
please wait” appears (as shown above).  
• If the input signal type is set to CABLE for an antenna input, the  
automatic channel programming process erases channels that  
were previously programmed into the TV’s memory.  
• If the input signal type is set to ANTENNA, the automatic  
channel programming process does NOT erase channels that  
were previously programmed into the TV’s memory, but adds  
newly found channels to the existing set of programmed  
channels. To remove a channel from the memory, you must  
manually delete it (see next page).  
6. To cancel channel programming, either press EXIT or  
highlight Abort in the on-screen display and press ENTER.  
When channel programming is done, press CHANNEL  
y or z to view the programmed channels.  
To tune the TV to a channel not programmed in the channel  
memory, you must use the Channel Number buttons on the  
remote control.  
• Programming channels for an antenna input configured for  
CABLE will take substantially longer than for an antenna input  
configured for ANTENNA. This is normal; however, once  
channel programming is completed, you should not have to  
repeat the programming process again unless your Cable TV  
service lineup changes significantly.  
Channel  
Numbers  
• If you have a CableCARD™ inserted (page 14), channel  
programming for ANT 1 is disabled because the CableCARD™  
automatically loads the Cable channel list into the TV’s channel  
memory.  
To program channels automatically:  
1. Make sure you have configured the antenna input sources.  
See page 46 for details.  
2. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
CHANNEL yz  
3. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of  
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen).  
TV front panel touchpad  
Setup  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
CHANNEL z  
/
y
MENU  
(ENTER)  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
47  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Programming channels into the TVs channel memory (continued)  
To add a channel to the channel memory:  
Manually adding and deleting channels in  
Highlight the unchecked box next to the channel number  
you want to add, and then press ENTER to check the box.  
the channel memory  
After automatically programming channels into the channel  
memory, you can manually add or delete individual channels.  
To manually add digital subchannels on a physical channel:  
Use the Channel Numbers and the Dash (–/100) on the  
remote control to enter the channel number (for example,  
56–1).  
To add or delete channels in the channel memory:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of  
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in  
step 3).  
If the channel is found, the number will be added to the list  
and the box will be checked.  
If the channel is not found, a message will appear.  
To remove a channel from the channel memory:  
Setup  
Highlight the checked box next to the channel number you  
want to remove, and then press ENTER to uncheck the  
box.  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
To save your new settings:  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Highlight Done and press ENTER.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
To revert to your original settings:  
3. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight Channel Add/Delete,  
and then press ENTER.  
Highlight Cancel and press ENTER before saving.  
To remove all channels from the channel memory:  
Highlight Reset and press ENTER, and then highlight  
Done and press ENTER.  
Note:  
Terrestrial  
Input Configuration  
Channel Program  
Channel Add/Delete  
Signal Meter  
• This action applies to the current antenna input only. To  
delete/add channels on the other input, highlight the input  
you want (ANT1, ANT 2, or Cable Box) and press ENTER.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
• This action cannot be cancelled unless you highlight Cancel  
and press ENTER before saving your changes.  
4. The illustration below left shows channels programmed for  
the ANT 1 antenna input. To view the list of channels  
programmed for the ANT 2 or Cable box antenna input,  
press the y z buttons to highlight either “ANT 2” or  
“Cable Box” and press ENTER.  
Channel Add/Delete  
ANT 1  
ANT 1  
Analog  
Digital  
Digital  
Analog  
Analog  
Digital  
Analog  
Analog  
Digital  
Analog  
2
2 - 1  
2 - 2  
3
ANT 2  
Cable Box  
4
5
Note: “Cable Box” will appear only if you connected a cable  
box to your TV.  
6
7
Reset  
Cancel  
Done  
7 - 1  
8
Channel Add/Delete  
Channel Add/Delete  
ANT 1  
ANT 1  
Cable Box  
Analog  
Digital  
Digital  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Digital  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
Analog  
ANT 1  
2
2 - 1  
2 - 2  
3
1
2
ANT 2  
ANT 2  
Cable Box  
3
Cable Box  
4
4
5
5
6
6
7
7
Reset  
Cancel  
Done  
8
Reset  
Cancel  
Done  
7 - 1  
8
9
10  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
48  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Programming your favorite channels  
You can program up to 27 channels as favorite channels into  
three Favorite Channel sets (nine channels from the ANT 1  
input, nine from the ANT 2 input, and nine from the Cable  
box input). You can then scan through your favorite channels  
only, skipping other channels you do not normally watch.  
To clear your favorite channel lists:  
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.  
2. Highlight Favorite Channels and press ENTER.  
Edit Favorite Channels  
3. Highlight Edit and press  
ANT 2  
2
ENTER.  
2 - 1  
To add and delete channels in the Favorite Channels sets:  
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.  
2. Highlight Favorite Channels and press ENTER.  
3. Use the yz buttons to select either ANT 1, ANT 2, or  
Cable Box and press ENTER.  
2 - 2  
4. Highlight Reset and press  
4 - 1  
5
ENTER.  
17 - 1  
17 - 2  
28 - 1  
28 - 2  
28 - 3  
5. Highlight Done and press  
ENTER.  
Reset  
Cancel  
Done  
4. Highlight Edit and press ENTER.  
To tune your favorite channels for the current ANT input:  
Note: “Cable Box” will appear only if you connected a cable  
box to your TV.  
Press FAV CH yz.  
To tune your favorite channels using the favorite  
channel list:  
Favorite Channels  
ANT 1  
Preferences  
Favorite Channels  
ANT 1  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
CH 4-1  
CH 4-2  
CH 9  
Closed Caption Mode  
Off  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
1. Press 100 to display the favorite channel list.  
ANT 2  
Closed Caption Advanced  
Input Labeling  
Cable Box  
Empty  
Empty  
2. Press the corresponding number button (1–9)  
to select your desired channel.  
Menu Language  
Home CH Setup  
English  
CH 10  
CH 12  
CH 17  
CH 19  
---  
Edit  
Done  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Note: To tune your favorite channels for another  
input, press INPUT to select the other input.  
To add a channel to the selected Favorite Channel set:  
---  
To quickly scan through your favorite  
Use the yz buttons to highlight an unchecked box next to  
a channel you want to set as a favorite, and then press  
ENTER to check the box.  
channels in a nine picture multi-window (for the current  
ANT input):  
Press FAV SCAN. See page 83 for details.  
Edit Favorite Channels  
ANT 1  
2
3
4
To delete the channel from the  
selected Favorite Channel set:  
Note:  
To tune to a channel from the FAV SCAN mode, highlight a  
window and press ENTER.  
Only 9 favorite channels are allowed,  
Highlight a checked box and  
press ENTER to uncheck it.  
Note: If you try to add more  
than nine favorite channels per  
input, an error message will  
please deselect other channels first.  
9
OK  
To scan your favorite channels for another input, press INPUT to  
select the other input.  
Reset  
10  
11  
Cancel  
Done  
appear. You will need to delete (uncheck) a channel before you  
can add another.  
Channel Numbers  
100  
When done, highlight Done and press ENTER.  
To program favorite channels for another input:  
y
Either... Highlight ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable Box, which  
will change the favorite channel settings in the  
selected input. (This will not change the TV’s  
current input.)  
x
z
Or...  
Press INPUT to select ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable  
Box and then repeat steps 1–4, above.  
FAV CH yz  
Favorite Channels  
ANT 2  
FAV SCAN  
ANT 1  
CH 6  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
Empty  
ANT 2  
Cable Box  
Empty  
Empty  
Edit  
Done  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
49  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Setting up and using TheaterNet™ on-screen device control  
The TheaterNet feature allows you to control many brands of  
IEEE1394 and/or infrared remote-controlled A/V devices  
through your TV using on-screen control icons and the TV’s  
remote control.  
5. The TheaterNet Setup menu opens.  
TheaterNet Setup  
Select device  
type, brand,  
and IR code  
from owners  
manual.  
Input  
Video 1  
Cable  
Type  
Brand  
IR List  
IR Code  
General Instrum...  
0000  
Note:  
0
0
0
0
Test  
• Although the TheaterNet on-screen device control feature includes  
codes for many devices, it may not include codes for some or all of  
the features on certain devices you wish to control. If you are  
unable to program the TheaterNet feature to operate your device  
or some of the features on that device, use the device’s remote  
control or the controls on the device.  
Reset  
Done  
Using the x • buttons, select the Input the device is  
connected to.  
Note: When the input is changed, all unsaved settings will be  
lost.  
• For IR pass-through device control information, see “Connecting a  
device to the TheaterNet OUT infrared terminal” on page 22.  
6. Press z and then x • to select the device Type.  
7. Press z and then x • to select the device Brand.  
Note: When selecting a new brand, the IR code will be set to 0.  
8. Press z and then x • to select the device’s IR List.  
9. If the desired IR code is found, skip to step 10.  
Setting up TheaterNet  
All device types except IEEE1394 require the following setup  
process before you can control them using the TheaterNet  
on-screen icons.  
If the desired IR code is not in the list, press z and use the  
All compatible IEEE1394 devices are automatically recognized  
by the TheaterNet feature and do not require setup.  
Note: See page 25 for details about the IEEE1394 ports. If your  
IEEE1394 device is not recognized through the IEEE1394 port or  
through the TheaterNet feature, it may be possible to set it up for IR  
pass-through control as an infrared device (see page 22).  
Channel Number buttons to enter the device IR code.  
Note: You can find the IR code for your device in the  
on-screen list or in the TheaterNet device code table on  
pages 52–54.  
10. Highlight Test and press ENTER to test whether the device  
responds to the code. If the device does not respond to the  
code, repeat steps 8 and 9 using another code for the same  
device.  
To set up TheaterNet device control:  
1. Make sure you have properly connected your infrared  
remote-controlled device(s). See pages 22 and 25 for details.  
When done, highlight Done and press ENTER or choose  
a different Input for which to set up TheaterNet device  
control.  
2. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
3. Highlight Installation and press ENTER.  
To remove a device from TheaterNet:  
1. Follow steps 1–5 above.  
Setup  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
2. Highlight Reset and press ENTER.  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
4. A new set of Installation menu icons will appear on-screen,  
as shown below. Open the Devices menu, highlight  
TheaterNet Devices, and then press ENTER.  
Devices  
IEEE1394 Devices  
TheaterNet Devices  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
50  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Setting up and using TheaterNet™ on-screen device control (continued)  
Using the TheaterNet control icons  
1. Set up your infrared devices in TheaterNet, if you have not  
already done so (see page 50).  
The following are examples of the TheaterNet on-screen  
control icons for various devices.  
Note: IEEE1394 devices do not need to be set up in  
TheaterNet because they appear automatically in the  
TheaterNet menu.  
Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder control*  
2. Press DEVICE on the remote control to display the device  
control selection screen.  
* If you connected a Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder, you must  
set up the TV Guide On Screen® system in order to use the  
Symbio’s full functionality. See Chapter 5 for details on setting up  
the TV Guide On Screen® system. See pages 26 and 55 for further  
details about AVHD digital recorders.  
TheaterNet  
DEVICE  
0
Video 2  
Toshiba  
1
3
Video 3  
Toshiba  
CTRL  
y
2
ColorStream HD1  
Toshiba  
ColorStream HD2  
Toshiba  
x
z
ENTER  
EXIT  
Toshiba  
3. Using the yzx • buttons, highlight the device you want  
to control and press ENTER.  
TheaterNet  
Toshiba  
0
Video 2  
Toshiba  
1
3
Video 3  
Toshiba  
CH  
2
ColorStream HD1  
Toshiba  
ColorStream HD2  
Toshiba  
4. The input automatically changes to the input for the  
selected device, and the device’s control icons display  
on-screen.  
Toshiba  
ColorStream HD1  
ENTER  
TOP MENU SELECT EXIT  
Highlight the icon for the function you want to control and  
press ENTER.  
To select the devices control icons directly:  
Press CTRL.  
To close the on-screen control icons:  
Press EXIT.  
To view another source:  
Press DEVICE and select the input source you want to  
view.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
51  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
TheaterNetIR device codes  
Amplifiers  
Cable boxes (cont.)  
CD players (cont.)  
Brand  
Code  
0406  
0674  
0269  
0300  
0160  
0078  
0892  
0331  
0892  
0269  
0165  
0269  
Brand  
Code  
0015  
Brand  
Proton  
QED  
Code  
0157  
0157  
0029  
Aiwa  
Bose  
Carver  
Curtis Mathes  
Denon  
RadioShack  
Regal  
Rembrandt  
Runco  
0020, 0273, 0279  
0011  
Quasar  
RCA  
0000  
0144  
1062, 0032, 0053,  
0179, 0305, 0468,  
0764  
0179, 0180, 0420  
0157, 0420  
0157  
Samsung  
Scientific Atlanta  
GE  
0877, 0008, 0017,  
0477, 1877  
0015  
Harman/Kardon  
JVC  
Left Coast  
Linn  
Luxman  
Magnavox  
Marantz  
NEC  
Nakamichi  
Optimus  
Panasonic  
Parasound  
Philips  
Pioneer  
Polk Audio  
RCA  
Realistic  
Sansui  
Shure  
Sony  
Soundesign  
Technics  
Victor  
Realistic  
Rotel  
SAE  
Sansui  
Sanyo  
Scott  
Signal  
Signature  
Sony  
0011  
1006  
0003, 0015  
0015  
0157, 0305  
0179  
Starcom  
Stargate  
Starquest  
Supercable  
Tocom  
Torx  
Toshiba  
Tusa  
0305  
0305  
0861, 0037, 0180  
1067, 0180  
0157  
0892, 0321, 0269  
0264  
0015  
0276  
0012  
0003  
0000  
0015  
0007  
Sears  
Sharp  
0321  
Sherwood  
Sonic Frontiers  
Sony  
0395, 0300  
0308, 0521  
0246  
0892, 0269  
0013, 0300  
0892, 0269  
0300  
0490, 0000, 0100,  
0185, 0604, 1364  
0145  
United Artists  
Zenith  
Soundesign  
TDK  
0000, 0525, 0899  
1208  
0420  
0174, 0180, 0393,  
0420  
0029, 0303  
0072  
0157, 0053  
0888, 0036, 0187,  
1292  
Tascam  
Teac  
CD players  
Brand  
Aiwa  
0395  
0321  
0264  
Code  
0157, 0124  
0420  
Technics  
Victor  
Wards  
Burmester  
California Audio Labs  
Carver  
0689, 0220  
0078, 0211  
0308, 0521  
0331  
0029, 0303  
0157, 0179, 0437  
1297  
Yamaha  
Classic  
Yorx  
0461  
DKK  
DMX Electronics  
Denon  
0000  
0157  
0873, 0003  
0305  
Wards  
Yamaha  
0078, 0013, 0211  
0354, 0133  
Laser disk players  
Brand  
Aiwa  
Carver  
Denon  
Disco Vision  
Funai  
Harman/Kardon  
Hitachi  
Magnavox  
Marantz  
Mitsubishi  
NAD  
Emerson  
Fisher  
GPX  
Code  
0203  
0064, 0194, 0323  
0059, 0172  
0023  
0174, 0179, 1325  
1296  
Cable boxes  
Brand  
ABC  
Code  
0003, 0008, 0014,  
0007, 0011, 0017  
0899  
Garrard  
0393, 0420  
0032, 0305  
0157, 0173  
0032  
Genexxa  
Harman/Kardon  
Hitachi  
0203  
0194  
0023  
Americast  
Bell & Howell  
Bell South  
Contec  
Director  
Everquest  
0014  
0899  
0019  
0476  
JVC  
KLH  
Kenwood  
0072, 1294  
1318, 1372, 1373  
0681, 0826, 0626,  
0028, 0037, 0190  
1317  
0194, 0217  
0064, 0194  
0059  
0015  
Koss  
0059  
Gemini  
General Instrument  
0015  
Krell  
LXI  
Linn  
MCS  
MTC  
Magnavox  
Marantz  
0157  
0305  
0157  
0029  
Optimus  
Panasonic  
Philips  
Pioneer  
Polk Audio  
Quasar  
Realistic  
Samsung  
Sega  
0059  
0204  
0064, 0194  
0059, 0023  
0194  
0476, 0003, 0276,  
0011, 0810  
0144  
0009, 0020, 0273  
0011  
GoldStar  
Hamlin  
Hitachi  
Hytex  
Jasco  
Jerrold  
0420  
0157, 0305  
0626, 0029, 0157,  
0180  
0204  
0203  
0323  
0023  
0007  
0015  
0476, 0003, 0276,  
0012, 0014, 0015,  
0011, 0810  
0000  
0476, 1106, 0276,  
0810  
Miro  
Mission  
NSM  
Nikko  
Onkyo  
Optimus  
0000  
0157  
0157  
0174  
Sony  
0193, 0201  
0204  
Technics  
Theta Digital  
Yamaha  
Memorex  
Motorola  
0194  
0217  
0868, 0101  
1063, 0000, 0032,  
0037, 0145, 0179,  
0305, 0420, 0437,  
0468  
0029, 0303  
0420  
0626, 0157  
1063, 1062, 0032,  
0305, 0468  
0157  
Oak  
Pace  
Panasonic  
Paragon  
Philips  
Pioneer  
0019, 0007  
0237  
0000, 0107  
0000  
Miscellaneous audio devices  
Brand  
Aiwa  
Fisher  
JVC  
Jerrold  
Scientific Atlanta  
Sony  
Code  
0010, 0159, 0404  
0052  
Panasonic  
Parasound  
Philips  
0305, 0317  
0877, 0144, 0533,  
1877  
0073  
0520, 0459  
0460  
Pioneer  
Pulsar  
Quasar  
0000  
0000  
0010, 0159, 0576  
0459  
Polk Audio  
Starcom  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
52  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
TheaterNetIR device codes (continued)  
Video accessory (HDTV decoder)  
Receivers (cont.)  
VCRs  
Brand  
Panasonic  
Pioneer  
Princeton  
Samsung  
Sensory Science  
Sharp  
Code  
1120  
1010  
Brand  
Proscan  
Quasar  
RCA  
Code  
1254  
0039  
Brand  
Code  
0048, 0209  
0000  
0278  
0037, 0000  
0041  
Admiral  
Adventura  
Aiko  
Aiwa  
Akai  
America Action  
American High  
Asha  
Audiovox  
Beaumark  
Bell & Howell  
Broksonic  
0113, 0295  
1190  
1023, 1254, 0080,  
0531, 1390, 1609  
0181, 0195  
1295  
1126  
1010  
Realistic  
Samsung  
Sansui  
0278  
0035  
0240  
1089, 0189  
0801, 1251  
0186, 1286  
0491, 0502, 1653  
1058, 1258, 1158,  
0158, 0474, 1367,  
1558, 1658,1758  
0670  
Sanyo  
Sharp  
Sherwood  
Sony  
0037, 0278  
0240  
Receivers  
Brand  
ADC  
Code  
0531  
1089, 1405, 0121,  
0158, 0189, 0405,  
1388, 1641  
1390  
0104  
0184, 0121, 0209,  
0002, 0479, 1479  
0072, 0278  
0037  
Aiwa  
Soundesign  
Stereophonics  
Sunfire  
Teac  
Technics  
CCE  
Calix  
1023  
1313  
0463  
Alco  
Anam  
Canon  
Carver  
Cineral  
Citizen  
Colt  
0035  
0081  
0278  
1609  
1257  
1120  
1189  
1390  
1229  
1370  
0531  
Apex Digital  
Arcam  
Audiotronic  
Audiovox  
Bose  
Cambridge Soundworks  
Capetronic  
Carver  
1308, 1309, 1518,  
0039, 0309  
1189  
0037, 0278, 1278  
0072  
0037, 0047, 0240,  
0072  
0060, 0035, 0162,  
0041, 0760, 1035  
0240  
0045, 0278, 1278  
0042  
Thorens  
Venturer  
Victor  
1390  
0074  
Craig  
Wards  
0014, 0080, 0158,  
0189  
0176, 0186, 1176  
0195  
Curtis Mathes  
1089, 1189, 0042,  
0189  
Yamaha  
Yorx  
Zenith  
Cybernex  
Daewoo  
Denon  
Dynatech  
Electrohome  
Electrophonic  
Emerex  
Casio  
0195  
0195  
1136  
0080  
0857  
Clarinette  
Compaq  
Curtis Mathes  
Daewoo  
Denon  
0000  
0037  
0037  
0032  
Satellite receivers  
Brand  
1250  
1104, 1160, 0004,  
1360  
0042, 1801  
0463  
0110, 0189, 0891  
1181  
Code  
0772  
0216  
Emerson  
0037, 0184, 0000,  
0121, 0043, 0209,  
0002, 0278, 0479,  
1278, 1479  
0047, 0104  
0035, 0033  
0000  
AlphaStar  
Chaparral  
Crossdigital  
DishPro  
Echostar  
Expressvu  
GE  
Fisher  
Garrard  
Harman/Kardon  
Hewlett Packard  
JBL  
1109  
1005, 0775  
1005, 0775  
0775  
Fisher  
Fuji  
Funai  
GE  
0110, 1306  
0074, 1374  
1390  
JVC  
KLH  
0566  
0775  
0060, 0035, 0240,  
0760, 0807, 1035,  
1060  
0000  
0432  
0037, 0038, 1237  
0000  
GOI  
Kenwood  
1313, 1027, 1570,  
1569, 0027, 0042,  
0186  
General Instrument  
HTS  
Hitachi  
Hughes Network Systems  
JVC  
Magnavox  
Memorex  
Mitsubishi  
Motorola  
Next Level  
Panasonic  
Paysat  
0869  
0775  
0819  
Garrard  
Go Video  
GoldStar  
Gradiente  
HI-Q  
Harley Davidson  
Harman/Kardon  
Harwood  
Headquarter  
Hitachi  
Hughes Network Systems  
JVC  
Jensen  
KEC  
KLH  
Keen  
Kenwood  
Kodak  
LXI  
Lloyd’s  
Logik  
MEI  
MGA  
MGN Technology  
MTC  
Koss  
LXI  
Lasonic  
Linn  
Lloyd’s  
MCS  
1366  
0181  
1798  
0189  
0195  
0039  
1142, 0749, 1749  
0775  
0724, 0722  
0724  
0047  
0000  
0081, 0038  
0072  
0749  
0869  
0869  
Magnavox  
1089, 1189, 0189,  
0195, 0391, 0531  
1089, 1189, 0039,  
0189  
0046  
0000, 0042, 0041  
0042  
0247, 0701  
0724  
1142, 0749, 0724,  
1076, 0722, 1749  
0392  
0392, 0566, 0855,  
0143  
Marantz  
Philips  
0067, 0041  
0041  
0037, 0278  
0072  
Modulaire  
Musicmagic  
Nakamichi  
Onkyo  
0195  
1089  
0097  
Proscan  
RCA  
0135, 0842, 1298  
1023, 0042, 0080,  
0181, 0186, 0531,  
0670, 0738, 0801  
1518, 0039, 0309,  
0367  
0693  
Optimus  
RadioShack  
SKY  
Samsung  
Sony  
Star Choice  
Toshiba  
0869  
0856  
1109  
0639  
0067, 0041, 0038  
0035, 0037  
0037  
Panasonic  
0000  
0072  
0035  
0869  
Penney  
Philips  
0195  
0749, 0790, 1052,  
1053, 1054, 1285,  
1286, 1287, 1289,  
1749  
1089, 1189, 1269,  
0189, 0391, 1120  
1023, 0014, 0080,  
0150, 0244, 0531,  
0630, 1384  
0189  
0240, 0043  
0240  
0240, 0000  
1278  
Pioneer  
Uniden  
Zenith  
0724, 0722  
0856, 1856  
Magnasonic  
Polk Audio  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
53  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
TheaterNetIR device codes (continued)  
VCRs (cont.)  
VCRs (cont.)  
DVD players (cont.)  
Brand  
Magnavox  
Code  
0035, 0039, 0081,  
0000, 0149, 0563,  
1781  
Brand  
Scott  
Code  
0184, 0045, 0121,  
0043  
0035, 0037, 0047,  
0000, 0042, 0104,  
0046, 1237  
0045  
Brand  
Hitachi  
Hiteker  
JBL  
Code  
0573, 0664  
0672  
Sears  
0702  
0558, 0623, 0867  
0717  
Magnin  
Marantz  
Marta  
0240  
0035, 0081  
0037  
JVC  
KLH  
Kenwood  
Semp  
0490, 0534, 0682,  
0737  
0711, 0719, 0720,  
0721  
Matsushita  
Memorex  
0035, 0162, 0454  
0035, 0162, 0037,  
0048, 0039, 0047,  
0240, 0000, 0104,  
0209, 0046, 0454,  
0479, 1037, 1162,  
1237, 1262  
0042  
0067, 0043, 0807  
0035, 0048  
0000, 0072  
0104, 0067, 0041,  
0038  
Sharp  
0048, 0807, 0848  
0072  
Shintom  
Shogun  
Singer  
Sonic Blue  
Sony  
Konka  
0240  
0072  
Koss  
0651  
0798  
0503, 0675  
0782  
0614, 0616  
0035, 0032, 0000,  
0033, 0636, 1032,  
1232  
0035, 0081, 0000,  
0043, 1781  
0000  
Lasonic  
Magnavox  
Malata  
Marantz  
Microsoft  
Mintek  
Mitsubishi  
Nesa  
Next Base  
Norcent  
Onkyo  
Oritron  
Panasonic  
Minolta  
Mitsubishi  
Motorola  
Multitech  
NEC  
0539  
0522  
0717  
0521  
0717  
0826  
0872  
Sylvania  
Symphonic  
TMK  
Tatung  
Teac  
Technics  
Teknika  
Thomas  
Tivo  
Toshiba  
Totevision  
Unitech  
Vector  
Vector Research  
Video Concepts  
Videomagic  
Videosonic  
Villain  
0240  
0041  
Nikko  
0037  
0240  
0035  
0000, 0041  
0035, 0162  
0035, 0037, 0000  
0000  
0618, 0636  
0045, 0043, 0845  
0037, 0240  
0240  
Noblex  
Olympus  
Optimus  
0503, 0627  
0651  
0490, 0632, 1362,  
1462, 1490  
0503, 0539, 0646,  
0854  
0525, 0571, 0632  
0539  
0674  
0522  
0522, 0571, 0717,  
0822  
1062, 0162, 0037,  
0048, 0104, 0432,  
0454, 1048, 1162,  
1262  
0184, 0209, 0002,  
0479, 1479  
1062, 0035, 0162,  
0225, 0454, 0616,  
1035, 1162, 1262  
0035, 0037, 0240,  
0042, 0038, 1035,  
1237  
Philips  
Orion  
Pioneer  
Polk Audio  
Princeton  
Proscan  
RCA  
0045  
0038  
0045  
0037  
0240  
0000  
Panasonic  
Penney  
Rotel  
Rowa  
Sampo  
Samsung  
Sansui  
0623  
0823  
0698  
Wards  
0060, 0035, 0048,  
0047, 0081, 0240,  
0000, 0042, 0072,  
0149, 0760  
0209, 0072, 1278  
0035, 0000, 0072  
0038  
Pentax  
Philco  
Philips  
0042  
0035, 0209, 0479  
0035, 0081, 0618,  
1081, 1181  
0037  
0573, 0820  
0695  
White Westinghouse  
XR-1000  
Yamaha  
Sanyo  
Sharp  
0670  
0630  
0633  
0533  
Pilot  
Pioneer  
Polk Audio  
Profitronic  
Proscan  
Protec  
0067  
0081  
0240  
Sherwood  
Shinsonic  
Sony  
Sylvania  
Technics  
Techwood  
Theta Digital  
Toshiba  
Tredex  
Zenith  
0039, 0000, 0209,  
0033, 0479, 1479  
0533, 0864, 1533  
0675, 0821  
0490  
0692  
0571  
0503, 0695, 1045  
0800  
0060, 0760, 1060  
0072  
Pulsar  
0039  
0046  
0046  
DVD players  
Brand  
Aiwa  
Apex Digital  
Quarter  
Quartz  
Quasar  
Code  
0641  
0672, 0717, 0755,  
0794, 0796, 0797,  
0830, 0856, 1100  
0736  
0035, 0162, 0454,  
1035, 1162  
0060, 0240, 0042,  
0149, 0760, 0807,  
1035, 1060  
0000, 1037  
0037  
Urban Concepts  
XBox  
0503  
0522  
RCA  
Audiologic  
B & K  
0655, 0662  
0571  
RadioShack  
Radix  
Randex  
Blue Parade  
Broksonic  
DVD2000  
Daewoo  
Denon  
Emerson  
Enterprise  
Fisher  
GE  
GPX  
Go Video  
Gradiente  
Greenhill  
Harman/Kardon  
0695  
0521  
0784  
0037  
Realistic  
0035, 0037, 0048,  
0047, 0000, 0104,  
0046  
0490, 0634  
0591  
ReplayTV  
Runco  
STS  
Samsung  
Sanky  
0614, 0616  
0039  
0591  
0670  
0522, 0717  
0699, 0769  
0715  
0651  
0717  
0582, 0702  
0042  
0240, 0045  
0048, 0039  
0000, 0067, 0209,  
0041, 0479, 1479  
0047, 0240, 0104,  
0046  
Sansui  
Sanyo  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
54  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Setting the AVHD device skip time  
Setting the time and date  
When you connect an external AVHD (audio/video hard drive)  
device—such as the Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder—to  
one of the TV’s IEEE1394 ports, you can use the AVHD device  
skip time feature to set the number of minutes the device will  
skip forward or backward when you press the SKIP buttons.  
Note: If you already set up the TV Guide On Screen® system, the  
time and date were set automatically and you can skip this step.  
To set the time and date:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. (A new set of  
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown in  
step 3 below.)  
Note:  
• This TV will work best with the Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder*  
for recording high definition and standard definition material from  
either tuner and for controlling live TV (pause/rewind/etc.). When the  
Symbio AVHD Recorder is connected to the TV, the remote control  
keys (LIVE, STOP, REW, PAUSE, PLAY, etc.) are automatically  
activated to allow pausing of live TV.  
3. Open the Time And Date menu, highlight Start Setup, and  
press ENTER.  
Time And Date  
Start Setup  
• When you connect an AVHD (or D-VHS) device, the TV Guide  
On Screen® system is automatically configured to allow recording. See  
page 26 for device connection information. See Chapters 5 and 7 for  
details about setting up and using the TV Guide On screen® system.  
To set the AVHD device skip time:  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
1. Press MENU and open  
the Setup menu.  
If you have not set up the TV Guide On Screen® system, the  
following screen will appear. To set the time, highlight  
TV Guide On Screen® and press ENTER. The TV Guide  
On Screen® setup sequence will start, and the time and date  
will be set automatically.  
Setup  
2. Highlight AVHD Skip  
1 min  
3 min  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
Time and press .  
5 min  
Auto  
15 min  
HDMI 1 Audio  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
AVHD Skip Time  
3. Press y or z to select  
the AVHD skip time  
(1, 3, 5, or 15 minutes)  
and press ENTER.  
AAuutoo  
2 Sec  
15 min  
Time And Date  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Your TV Guide On Screen system can provide accurate  
time and date information.  
It is recommended you set up TV Guide On Screen  
first and use it to obtain the time and date.  
*
To enjoy the full benefits of your Toshiba Symbio™ AVHD Recorder, you  
must first set up the TV Guide On Screen® system (see Chapter 5). Full  
Symbio™ AVHD Recorder benefits, including Intelligent One Touch  
recording, will not be available unless the TV Guide On Screen® system is  
fully operational. However, even if the TV Guide On Screen® system is not  
fully operational, manual recording is available as long as the TV Guide  
On Screen® system has acquired the necessary date and time data. If you  
experience any issues with your Symbio AVHD Recorder, please contact  
Toshiba Consumer Solutions by calling (800) 631-3811 or visiting  
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp.  
Manual  
TV Guide On Screen  
Cancel  
If you have already set up the TV Guide On Screen® system,  
or if you have not set up the time, the Time and Date setting  
screen will appear and you will need to manually set the time  
and date.  
Time And Date  
Date (MM/DD/YY)  
Time (HH:MM)  
0 6 / 3 0 / 0 5  
1 1 : 1 1 AM  
Setting the HDMI™ audio mode  
Cancel  
Done  
To set the HDMI audio mode:  
1. Press MENU and open  
Note:  
the Setup menu.  
• If you highlight TV Guide On Screen® (above) to set the time  
and date through the TV Guide On Screen® system and a  
power outage occurs, the time and date will be updated  
automatically when the power is restored.  
Setup  
2. Highlight HDMI 1 (or  
Installation  
Auto  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
Digital  
Analog  
2) Audio and press .  
Auto  
Auto  
3. Press z or y to select  
the HDMI audio mode  
(Auto, Digital, or  
HDMI 1 Audio  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
• If you highlight Manual (above) to set the time and date  
manually and a power outage occurs, you will lose the time  
and date settings when the power is restored.  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Analog) and press  
• If you manually set the time and date and then perform  
TV Guide On Screen® setup, the manual time and date settings  
will be overridden by the TV Guide On Screen® settings.  
ENTER. (Auto is the  
recommended mode). See “Connecting an HDMI or DVI  
device to the HDMI input” on page 21.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
55  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Viewing the CableCARD™ menu  
Setting the Quick Restart™ feature  
A CableCARDenables you to view encrypted digital channels.  
See page 14 for connection and subscription information.  
After the CableCARDis inserted, a CableCARDoption  
appears in the Applications menu, with informational screens  
provided by your digital CableCARDservice (see illustrations  
below).  
With the Quick Restartfeature set to ON, the TV will stay in  
Shutdown mode for several minutes after the TV is turned off  
(see Notes below).  
If the TV is turned on from Shutdown mode, the full picture  
appears immediately.  
To set the Quick Restartfeature:  
CableCard Connected -- Acquiring  
channel information.  
1. Press MENU, and then press x or until the Setup menu  
appears.  
CableCard services will only operate  
with cable signal connected to Antenna 1.  
2. Highlight Quick Restart and press .  
3. Press z or y to select either On or Off.  
To view the CableCARDmenu:  
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
2. Highlight CableCARDand press .  
Setup  
PC Settings  
Off  
Auto  
On  
HDMI 1 Audio  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
AVHD Skip Time  
Gray Level  
Auo
2 Sec  
15 min  
1
3. Press z or y to select one of the side menu items and then  
press ENTER to display the information.  
On  
Quick Restart  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Applications  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
IP Service  
Note:  
Conditional Access  
CableCARD(tm) Status  
Network Setup  
Picture Viewer  
If Quick Restart is set to OFF and you turn off the TV, it can take  
several seconds for the picture to appear when you turn on the TV  
again. See “Important notice about hot lamp restart,” below.  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
CableCARD(tm) Pairing  
If Quick Restart is set to ON and you turn off the TV, the following  
will occur for a few minutes:  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Note: The CableCARDmenu is for informational purposes  
only and has no user-adjustable options.  
• the screen (lamp) will light dimly; and  
• the fans will continue to run.  
This is a function of the Quick Restart Shutdown mode and is not a  
TV malfunction. If you do not prefer this, set the Quick Restart  
feature to OFF.  
When the Quick Restart feature is set to OFF, if you repeatedly turn  
the TV on and off in a short period of time, the useful service life of  
the lamp may be shorter than the average useful service life. See  
page 129.  
IMPORTANT NOTICE ABOUT  
“HOT LAMP RESTART”  
When the TV has been powered on long enough for the lamp  
unit to get hot, it may take several minutes for the picture to  
appear on-screen in the following situations:  
• when the Quick Restart™ feature is set to OFF and you turn  
the TV off and then on again within a few minutes; or  
• if the TV is on when a short-term power failure, power surge,  
or other similar power failure occurs, such that the TV loses  
and regains power within a few minutes.  
This is a property of DLP lamp technology  
and is NOT a sign of malfunction.  
If this occurs, the green LED on the TV front panel will blink  
(and the red LED will be lit solid) until the TV is finished  
restarting the lamp and the normal picture appears. If both LEDs  
are blinking, you will need to turn the TV off and then on again  
to restart the lamp.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
56  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 6: Setting up your TV  
Viewing the digital signal meter  
Viewing the system status  
You can view the digital signal meter for the ANT 1 and ANT 2  
digital TV input sources only.  
To view the system status:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
To view the digital signal meter:  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. A new set of  
Installation menu icons will appear on-screen, as shown  
below right.  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER.  
Setup  
Installation  
System Status  
System Infomation  
Setup  
Sleep Timer  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
HDMI 1 Audio  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
Auto  
Auto  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
2 Sec  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Select  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
3. Open the System Status menu, highlight System  
Information, and then press ENTER.  
3. A new set of Installation menu icons will appear on-screen,  
as shown below. Open the Terrestrial menu, highlight  
Signal Meter, and press ENTER.  
4. Press x • to scroll through the menu bar to check the  
Product Information and Software Version.  
System Information  
System Information  
Product Information  
Software Version  
Brand:  
Model:  
Toshiba  
52HMX95  
0.3.0  
Mar 9 2005 - 12:37:10  
FW:0.12  
Terrestrial  
IEEE1394 GUID:  
00003914-28343803  
Input Configuration  
Channel program  
Channel Add/Delete  
Signal Meter  
Sub:47  
Done  
Done  
To close the screen and return to the Installation menu:  
Highlight Done and press ENTER.  
To return to normal viewing:  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
4. Press yzx • to select the antenna input and digital  
channel whose signal you want to check.  
Press EXIT.  
Note: The physical digital channel number listed in the Signal  
Meter screen may not correspond to a virtual TV channel  
number. Contact your local broadcasters to obtain the RF  
channel numbers for your local digital stations.  
Restore Factory Defaults  
To restore all settings and channels to their factory default  
values:  
Signal Meter  
1. Follow steps 1–3 above.  
Signal Locked  
0
Peak  
0
2. Press x • to scroll through the menu bar to select Factory  
Antenna  
1
Defaults.  
Physical Digital Channel  
Virtual Digital Channel  
13  
N/A  
3. Enter your PIN code (or 0000 if no PIN code has been set).  
Done  
4. Highlight Yes and press ENTER. The TV will turn off  
automatically after a few seconds. After the TV turns off,  
unplug the TV power cord and then plug it in again to  
complete the restore process.  
To close the screen and return to the Terrestrial menu:  
Highlight Done and press ENTER.  
System Information  
To return to normal viewing:  
Press YES to confirm. After the TV  
turns off, unplug it and plug it dack  
in to complete the reset.  
Press EXIT.  
Yes  
No  
To cancel the reset:  
Highlight No and press ENTER.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
57  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
®
Using the TV Guide On Screen  
interactive program guide  
7
The TV Guide On Screen® system is a free, interactive,  
on-screen program guide built in to your Toshiba TV that lists  
schedules and information for TV programs in your area.  
Direct tuning—Directly tune the TV to a current program  
you want to watch by selecting it in the program guide.  
RemindersSchedule show reminders that will either display  
an on-screen notification banner or automatically tune the TV  
to the channel of the show for which you set the reminder.  
Note: Over-the-air or cable access to stations carrying TV Guide  
On Screen® data is required for the TV Guide On Screen® system to  
operate. The TV Guide On Screen® system does not work with satellite  
programming. Toshiba does not provide the TV Guide On Screen® data;  
rather, such data is provided by a third party, which is responsible for its  
accuracy and availability. Additionally, occasional compatibility issues may  
exist between the TV Guide On Screen® system contained in your TV and  
the data provided by the third party. If you experience any performance  
issues with your TV Guide On Screen® system, please contact Toshiba  
Consumer Solutions by calling (800) 631-3811 or visiting  
Recording—Easily schedule recording of one or more  
programs.  
Note: A VCR or IEEE1394 recording device is required for recording.  
It is recommended that you connect your devices according to the  
instructions in Chapter 2.  
Search—Search for shows by category, by keyword, or  
alphabetically.  
On-screen help—The TV Guide On Screen® system contains  
on-screen feature definitions and navigation instructions.  
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp.  
The TV Guide On Screen® system includes the following  
features:  
To open the TV Guide On Screen® system:  
• While watching TV, press  
Streamlined on-screen assisted setup—Quickly and easily set  
up your TV Guide On Screen® system using the on-screen  
prompts (see “Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system”  
below).  
the TV GUIDE button  
Applications  
on the remote control;  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
—or—  
Program listings and INFO windows—Scroll through eight  
days of TV listings and view program information such as  
rating, stereo, HDTV, new episode.  
Watch TV and display TV Guide On Screen® information  
simultaneously.  
Channel lineup customization—Customize your channel  
Picture Viewer  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
• Press MENU, open the  
CableCARD  
Applications menu,  
highlight TV Guide  
On Screen®, and press  
ENTER.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Note: After setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system, the program  
guide opens automatically by default when you turn on the TV. To turn  
off this feature, see page 45.  
lineup so your favorite stations are listed first.  
Setting up the TV Guide On Screen® system  
Follow these instructions to set up the TV Guide On Screen®  
system so it can receive current program data for your area.  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and then press ENTER to open the  
Installation menus. (A new set of menu icons will appear  
on-screen, as shown in step 3 below.)  
Note: If you move the TV to a different ZIP/postal code, you must  
perform the TV Guide On Screen® Setup process to reconfigure your  
TV Guide On Screen® system for the new location  
3. Open the TV Guide On Screen® Setup menu, highlight  
Start, and then press ENTER.  
If you have not already connected your antenna, cable box,  
and/or recording device, see Chapter 2 for connection  
instructions.  
Note: You must connect a VCR or an IEEE1394 compatible  
recording device to use the TV Guide On Screen® systems  
one-touch recording feature. It is recommended that you  
connect your devices according to the connection instructions  
in Chapter 2.  
Setup  
Installation  
TV Guide On Screen Setup  
Start  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
HDMI 1 Audio  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
Auto  
Auto  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of  
television programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is  
prohibited under the Copyright Laws of the United States and  
other countries, and may subject you to civil and criminal liability.  
4. Go to Chapter 5 for instructions on completing the setup.  
Read this chapter for details on using the TV Guide  
On Screen® interactive program guide.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
58  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen® system  
• While watching TV, press  
the TV GUIDE button  
to open the TV Guide  
On Screen® system. The  
LISTINGS screen will  
appear with the current show  
highlighted.  
• When the TV Guide  
On Screen® system is open,  
pressing the TV GUIDE button  
from any screen will tune the TV  
to the show displayed in the  
Video Window.  
• Use the arrow keys on the  
remote control (yzx •) to  
highlight any show, and then  
press ENTER to tune to that  
show.  
• Scroll left or right (x •)  
to view eight days of listings.  
• Press MENU to display a panel menu with options for the currently  
highlighted program or tile, including setting recordings and reminders.  
To access another Service screen:  
Note:  
The TV Guide On Screen® menus shown in this manual are for  
illustration purposes only. The channels, programs, and  
TV Guide On Screen® information as illustrated may not be  
available in your area. The options and features as illustrated  
are subject to change when updates are downloaded from the  
TV Guide On Screen® service to your TV.  
1. Press y to highlight the Service Bar.  
2. Press x or to highlight a different Service (LISTINGS, SEARCH,  
SETUP, SCHEDULE, or RECORDINGS).  
3. Press z to use that Service.  
The TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide supports  
cable-ready, cable box, and digital cable services, as well as  
over-the-air broadcasts, but does not provide listings for  
satellite services.  
Note: Helpful information about each Service appears in the Info Box.  
TV Guide On Screen® remote control functions  
BUTTON  
FUNCTION  
Numbers  
TV GUIDE  
• When watching TV, opens the TV Guide On Screen® system and highlights the current show  
listing.  
• When the TV Guide On Screen® system is open, closes the TV Guide On Screen® system and  
tunes the TV to the show displayed in the Video Window.  
– (digital  
Numbers  
– (digital separator)  
MENU  
• For direct channel tuning, priority ordering, and channel editing.  
• For entering digital channel numbers.  
separator)  
MENU  
INFO  
• Displays the panel menu, in which you can choose options (record, remind, keyword, etc.).  
• Cycles between levels of information, as available, in a Service screen or other type of screen.  
• Makes a selection or executes an action.  
• With a currently airing show listing highlighted, returns to watching TV and tunes to the show  
channel.  
INFO  
TV GUIDE  
ENTER  
ENTER  
y
x
• With a future airing show listing highlighted, displays a panel menu with viewing options.  
z
PAGE UP/  
DOWN  
yzx •  
• Provide directional control.  
• When watching TV, y and z surf through channels you set to “ON” in the LISTINGS screen.  
PAGE UP/DOWN  
• When the TV Guide On Screen® system is open, moves from one set of screen information to  
the next, when applicable.  
|
|
SS and TT  
REC  
• When the TV Guide On Screen® system is open or when watching TV, starts recording.  
SPLIT  
• When the TV Guide On Screen® system is open, toggles between locking and unlocking the  
Video Window.  
REC  
|
|
SS and TT  
• Jump forward and backward one day in the LISTINGS screen.  
SPLIT  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
59  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen® system (continued)  
Video Window  
• When you open the  
TV Guide On Screen®  
system, the current  
program appears in the  
Video Window.  
• As you scroll through  
the listings, the Video  
Window will change  
to display the selected  
program.  
Info Box  
• The lock/unlock icon indicates the status of the Video Window.  
If you lock the Video Window:  
As you navigate through listings, the Video Window channel will remain on  
the channel it was tuned to when you locked it.  
If you unlock the Video Window:  
As you navigate through listings, the Video Window channel will change to  
the currently highlighted listing.  
To lock/unlock the Video Window:  
Press the SPLIT button on the remote control to toggle between locking and  
unlocking the Video Window.  
—or—  
Highlight a channel logo or the LISTINGS Service Bar Label and press MENU  
to display the option to lock/unlock the Video Window.  
Panel Menus  
• A panel menu appears:  
– when you press MENU on a highlighted tile (if additional options  
are available); or  
– when you press ENTER on a show starting in the future.  
• When a panel menu appears, the highlighted tile changes color  
to indicate that the panel menu relates to the tile.  
• Press INFO to display help for the current panel menu.  
• Press y and z to move among the options.  
• Press x and to move to adjacent options or, if the highlight is  
on an odometer, to change the odometer choice.  
To move the highlight to the default command button, press ENTER  
from an odometer or entry box.  
To execute the action and close the panel menu, highlight the  
command button and press ENTER.  
To cancel any changes and close the panel menu:  
– press MENU; or  
– highlight Cancel and press ENTER.  
• If a panel menu contains more options than can be displayed in one  
panel, the word “more” appears at the bottom of the menu. To access  
the additional options, either scroll down using the z button or the  
PAGE UP/DOWN (CH yz) button.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
60  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
Navigating the TV Guide On Screen® system (continued)  
Info Box  
Info Action Bar  
• An Info Box contains information about a show, Service, or Panel Ad, or  
provides general help (for example, for a panel menu).  
• An Info Box for a program in the LISTINGS screen can have up to three  
sizes: Small, Large, or “No.”  
– Press INFO on the remote control to cycle among the sizes.  
– The default Info Box size is Small. To change the default size, open the  
SETUP Service screen (see page 70).  
Small Info Box  
• The Info Button icon (  
) appears on the Info Action Bar if the Info  
Box size can change and/or if there are additional Info screens. Press the  
INFO key on the remote control to change the size and/or display  
additional Info screens.  
• In some instances, the INFO button on the remote control is used to page  
forward (for example, if there are additional pages of information in a Panel  
Ad, a Channel Ad, or help text).  
Large Info Box  
TV Guide On Screen® Icons  
ICON  
NAME  
DESCRIPTION  
Info Button  
• Additional Info Box information is available, or the Info Box has additional sizes.  
Progress Bar • Elapsed time in current show.  
• Progress bar appears in LISTINGS and SEARCH and when the Info Button is pressed while watching TV.  
HDTV  
New  
• Show is presented in high-definition TV, if available.  
• Show is new (not a repeat).  
• Show is available in stereo.  
Stereo  
Dolby Digital • Show is available with Dolby Digital 5.1 audio (digital channels only).  
CC  
• Closed captioning is available for the show.  
• TV rating for the show.  
TV Rating  
Record Once • Show is set to record once.  
• Other frequencies are Daily (manual recording only),  
Regularly, and Weekly.  
Record Off  
• Show is set to record but recording is currently Off (show remains in schedule).  
• Recording is suspended due to a schedule conflict (show remains in schedule).  
• Recording resumes when the conflict no longer exists.  
Record  
Suspended  
Remind Once • Show is set to remind once.  
• Other frequencies are Daily (manual reminding only),  
Regularly, and Weekly.  
Remind Off  
• Show is set to remind but reminder is currently Off (show remains in schedule).  
Remind  
Suspended  
• Reminder is suspended due to a schedule conflict (show remains in schedule).  
• Reminder resumes when the conflict no longer exists.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
61  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services  
The TV Guide On Screen® system consists of five main services: LISTINGS, SEARCH, RECORDINGS, SCHEDULE, and SETUP.  
Note:  
• For the RECORDINGS service to display, an IEEE1394 recording device must be connected to the television (see Chapter 2); otherwise, only  
four services display. Recording to other devices, such as a VCR, is possible from within the LISTINGS service.  
• When using the TV Guide On Screen® system to record a program for the first time, it is recommended that you perform a test recording to  
make sure your system is set up properly.  
• If the power is cut or the plug becomes disconnected during timer recording, any recorded contents will be lost. It may take up to 7 days before  
an entire program schedule is available.  
• If the TV power cord is unplugged for an extended period of time, it may take up to 24 hours with the TV in standby mode (power cord  
plugged in and power OFF) to download the entire TV Guide On Screen® program schedule. It may take up to 7 days before an entire  
program schedule is available. Be sure to follow the instructions under “TV Guide On Screen® Reminder” on page 45.  
LISTINGS screen  
• When you open the TV Guide On Screen® system,  
LISTINGS is always the first service displayed.  
• Use the Number keys on the remote control to jump to a  
specific channel’s listings.  
To watch a show (if on now), highlight the show and press  
ENTER.  
To display the Episode Options panel menu for a particular  
show, highlight a show and press MENU.  
• With LISTINGS highlighted in the Service Bar, press INFO  
to display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the screen.  
Episode Options panel menu  
From the Episode Options panel menu, you can choose to set a  
recording, set a reminder, or tune to the channel. The following  
are descriptions of the buttons.  
• Use the arrow keys to move the highlight within LISTINGS  
to do the following:  
– View eight days of show listings  
– Read show descriptions  
GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no  
information, and returns to the Service Bar.  
TUNE TO CHANNEL / WATCH NOW: Exits the TV Guide  
On Screen® system and tunes to the show (if the show is  
currently airing) or tunes to the channel of the highlighted show  
(if the show airs in the future). The button label changes  
according to whether the show is currently airing or not.  
SET RECORDING: Displays the Record Options panel menu,  
from which you can set the show to record. For additional  
information, see “SCHEDULE screen” and “Recording  
features” on page 66.  
SET REMINDER: Displays the Remind Options panel menu,  
from which you can set a reminder for the show. For additional  
information, see “SCHEDULE screen” on page 66 and  
“Remind features” on page 68.  
Tune directly to a show currently airing  
– Set a show to Remind (e.g., start time, frequency,  
automatic power ON, auto-tune TV)  
– Set a show to Record (e.g, start/end time, frequency)  
– Lock and unlock the Video Window  
CANCEL: Closes the menu, changes no information, and  
returns to the highlighted show.  
– Access panel ads and channel ads  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
62  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
SEARCH screen  
• SEARCH allows you to find shows by keyword,  
alphabetically, or by category (HDTV, Movies, Sports,  
Children, Educational, News, Variety, Series).  
Example: Category search  
1. From the SEARCH screen, press z to highlight a category  
(in this example, MOVIES).  
• With SEARCH highlighted in the Service Bar, press INFO to  
display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the screen.  
2. Press z to highlight a subcategory (in this example, ALL).  
• Use the arrow keys to move the highlight within SEARCH.  
3. Press ENTER to display a list of all movies, organized by  
date and time.  
4. Highlight a show and press ENTER to watch (if on now)  
or press MENU to display the Episode Options panel  
menu. (See “Episode Options panel menu” on page 62.)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
63  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
SEARCH screen (continued)  
Example: Keyword search  
6. A list of all matching shows for that keyword is displayed.  
Keyword search lets you enter a word(s) to find a particular  
show by category or for every show title that matches.  
1. From the SEARCH screen, highlight KEYWORD, and  
then press ENTER.  
2. Highlight NEW SEARCH in the panel menu, and then  
press ENTER.  
7. Highlight a show and press ENTER to display all airings.  
Then highlight a specific listing and press ENTER to watch  
(if on now) or press MENU to display the Episode Options  
panel menu. From the Episode Options menu, you can  
choose to set a recording or reminder, or tune to the  
channel (see “Episode Options panel menu” on page 62.)  
3. The Search Options panel menu opens. Highlight  
CATEGORY, and then use the arrow keys to highlight a  
category to search (All, HDTV, Children, Sports, etc.).  
4. After highlighting a category, press z to highlight ENTER  
KEYWORD, and then press ENTER.  
The TV Guide On Screen® system stores all the keywords you  
create.  
To edit or delete a keyword:  
From the SEARCH/KEYWORD screen, highlight the  
keyword you want to edit or delete, and then press MENU  
to display the Search Options panel menu, with the  
following options:  
5. The keyboard is displayed. Use the arrow keys to highlight  
a character and then press ENTER to display it. When  
finished entering all characters, highlight DONE and press  
ENTER.  
– GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no  
information, and returns to the Service Bar.  
– EDIT SEARCH: Displays the keyboard, from which you  
can change the keyword.  
– DELETE SEARCH: Displays the Confirmation panel  
menu. Select YES to delete the search or NO to close the  
panel menu.  
– CANCEL: Closes the panel menu, changes no  
information, and returns to the highlighted keyword.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
64  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
RECORDINGS screen  
The RECORDINGS service screen displays a list of shows that  
were previously recorded or are currently recording on an  
IEEE1394 recording device connected to the TV.  
To view a recording, you can do one of the following:  
• Highlight an episode and press ENTER to view it now. The  
episode either starts from the beginning or from where it  
was last stopped (if viewed previously).  
Note: RECORDINGS will not appear in the Service Bar unless you  
have an IEEE1394 video recording device connected to one of the  
IEEE1394 ports on the TV. See Chapter 2 for details.  
• Highlight an episode and press MENU to display the  
Episode Options panel menu, with the following options:  
For additional details, see “Recording features” on page 66.  
– GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no  
information, and returns to the Service Bar.  
• With RECORDINGS highlighted in the Service Bar, press  
INFO to display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the  
screen.  
– RESUME: Starts from the beginning or from where it  
was last stopped (if viewed previously).  
– PLAY FROM BEGINNING: Starts from the beginning,  
even if stopped previously.  
– DELETE EPISODE: Deletes the episode from the  
RECORDINGS list and deletes the recording from the  
IEEE1394 recording device. A Confirm panel menu  
displays. Press YES to delete the episode or NO to close  
the panel menu.  
To choose the way recordings are displayed:  
– CANCEL: Closes the panel menu, changes no  
information, and returns to the highlighted show.  
1. Highlight RECORDINGS on the Service Bar and press  
MENU to display the Recording Options panel menu.  
2. Press yz to choose between View As and Sort By, as  
described below.  
View As: Press x • to choose between the following:  
List—Displays every recorded episode for a show  
(see example in Screen A, at right).  
Note: In List view, highlight an episode to display an Info  
Box with show information. Press MENU to display the  
Episode Options panel menu (see “Episode Options panel  
menu” on page 62).  
Screen A  
Group—Displays recorded shows without listing  
every recorded episode (see example in Screen B, at  
right).  
Note: In Group view, highlight a show and press ENTER to  
view all recorded episodes. Press ENTER again to collapse  
the episode list.  
Screen B  
Sort By: Press x and to choose between the following:  
• Title—Displays recorded shows in alphabetical order  
(see example in Screen A, at right).  
• Date—Displays recorded shows by date and time,  
with the most recent first.  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
3. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and  
then press ENTER again to close the panel menu and  
display the recordings with the selected options.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
65  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
SCHEDULE screen  
The SCHEDULE service screen allows you to review, edit, or  
delete Record and Remind events you set previously.  
Recording features  
You can set a show to record, or edit the recording settings for a  
show, in the LISTINGS, SEARCH, and SCHEDULE screens.  
There are three ways to set a show to Record, as described below.  
1) Set a show to Record using the REC key on the  
remote control  
Press the REC key on the remote control to record the  
show Once with current default settings (start and end  
recording on time). Each time you press REC, you change  
the Record frequency (but not the default settings) among  
Once (default), Regularly, Weekly, and Cancel.  
• With SCHEDULE highlighted in the Service Bar, press  
INFO to display a help screen. Press INFO again to close  
the screen.  
Note: The related Record icon appears on the show tile  
each time you press REC. See “Record icons,” on page 67.  
2) Set a show to Record from a panel menu  
1. Highlight a show and press MENU to display the  
Episode Options panel menu.  
2. Highlight SET RECORDING and press ENTER to  
display the Record Options panel menu.  
• Highlight an event and press MENU to display the Schedule  
Options panel menu, with the following options (as applicable):  
GO TO SERVICE BAR: Closes the menu, changes no  
information, and returns to the Service Bar.  
WATCH NOW: Exits the TV Guide On Screen® system and  
tunes to the highlighted show.  
3. Highlight the FREQUENCY field, and press x or to  
choose among Once, Regularly, Weekly, or Off.  
SET RECORDING: Opens a menu in which you can set a  
recording for a show (does not cancel a set reminder).  
4. Highlight the START field, and press x or to choose  
in the range from 120 minutes early to 120 minutes late  
or On Time (default = On Time).  
DELETE RECORDING: Removes the recording from the  
schedule. A Confirm panel menu displays. Press YES to  
delete the recording or NO to close the panel menu.  
5. Repeat step 4 for the END field.  
6. Highlight the RECORDER field and press x or to  
choose the recording device.  
EDIT RECORDING: Opens a menu in which you can  
change existing recording information.  
Note: For connected IEEE1394 recording devices only.  
SET REMINDER: Opens a menu in which you can set a  
reminder for a show (does not cancel a set recording).  
7. Highlight the KEEP UNTIL field and press x or to  
choose how long you want to keep the Record event.  
Note: For connected IEEE1394 recording devices only.  
DELETE REMINDER: Removes the reminder from the  
schedule. A Confirm panel menu displays. Press YES to  
delete the reminder or NO to close the panel menu.  
8. Press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE RECORDING,  
and press ENTER again to close the menu.  
EDIT REMINDER: Opens a menu in which you can change  
existing reminder information.  
A Record icon for the selected frequency appears on the  
show tile. See “Record icons” on page 67.  
Note: For connected IEEE1394 recording devices only.  
CANCEL: Closes the panel menu, changes no information,  
and returns to the highlighted show.  
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the  
menu, change no information, and return to the  
highlighted show.  
Note: You can change the default values of the Record Options  
panel menu fields. See “Change default options” on page 71.  
An icon identifies the event type. For more details, see  
“Recording features,”at right, and “Reminder features” on  
page 68.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
66  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
Recording features (continued)  
3) Manually set a show to Record  
Recording conflict  
1. Highlight SCHEDULE in the Service Bar, and press  
MENU to display the Schedule Options panel menu.  
A recording conflict message will appear in the following  
situations:  
2. Highlight NEW MANUAL RECORDING and press  
ENTER to display the Record Options panel menu.  
• A show set to Record overlaps with any part of another  
show previously set to Record.  
Press yzx • to move through the options.  
• A show set to Record overlaps with a show previously set to  
auto-tune. (For auto-tune details, see “Remind features” on  
page 68.)  
Press the Number keys or yzx • to change the  
information, as necessary.  
Select one of these options:  
3. Enter the information in the panel menu fields. You will  
need to set the start and end time for the recording. For  
details, see “Set a show to Record from a panel menu” on  
the previous page.  
Note: When setting a Manual Recording, the frequency  
option “Daily” is available instead of “Regularly.” See “Record  
icons,” below right, for a description of the Record icons.  
• Record Anyway—This show will override an existing show  
set to Record or auto-tune.  
• Don’t Record This Show—Cancels the Recording.  
4. When finished entering the information in the fields,  
press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE RECORDING,  
and press ENTER again to close the menu.  
A Record icon for the selected frequency appears on the  
show tile. See “Record Icons,” below right.  
Note: Manual recording is listed by channel number.  
Record icons  
Following is a description of the Record icons that will appear  
on the tile for a show set to Record.  
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the  
menu, change no information, and return to the  
highlighted show.  
• Record Once  
—Records the show one time.  
When using the TV Guide On Screen® system to record a program for the  
first time, it is recommended that you perform a test recording to make  
sure your system is set up properly.  
• Record Regularly  
show airs on the same channel and starts at the same time.  
—Records the show every time the  
Recording notification banner  
• Record Weekly —Records the show every time the show  
airs on the same day of the week and on the same channel,  
and starts at the same time.  
• If the TV is not on, the recording occurs as scheduled.  
• If the TV is on and you are watching the channel that is set to  
record, the recording occurs as scheduled.  
• Record Daily  
—Records on the same channel and at the  
• If the TV is on and you are watching a channel other than  
the one that is set to record, a notification banner (illustrated  
below) appears on-screen before recording starts. At that time  
you can choose to start or cancel recording.  
same start time every weekday (Monday through Friday).  
Note: This icon displays for manual recordings only.  
The default highlighted item in the notification banner is  
“Change channel; start recording.” If no change is made  
within 3 minutes, the notification banner will close  
automatically, the channel will change to the one set to  
record, and the recording will occur as scheduled. If you want  
to cancel the recording, select “Don’t change; cancel  
recording” in the notification banner and press ENTER.  
• Record Suspend  
schedule conflict (show remains in the Schedule list).  
—Recording is Suspended due to a  
• Record Off  
—Keeps the Recording in the Schedule list  
but will not record this show until the frequency is changed.  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under the  
Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may subject  
you to civil and criminal liability.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
67  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
Reminder features  
You can set a Reminder to perform the following functions:  
7. Press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE REMINDER,  
and press ENTER again to close the menu. A Remind  
icon for the selected frequency appears on the show tile.  
See “Remind icons” on page 69.  
• Automatically turn on the TV (if off) at the scheduled  
reminder time, and tune the TV to the channel of the show  
for which you set the reminder.  
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the  
menu, change no information, and return to the  
highlighted show.  
• Automatically tune the TV, at the scheduled reminder time,  
to the channel of the show for which you set the reminder.  
• Display an on-screen notification banner (reminding you that  
the show is about to start), from which you can choose to  
tune the TV to the show’s channel or cancel the reminder.  
2) Manually set a show Reminder  
1. Highlight SCHEDULE in the Service Bar, and press  
MENU to display the Schedule Options panel menu.  
You can set a show reminder, or edit the reminder settings for a  
show, in LISTINGS, SEARCH, and SCHEDULE. There are  
two ways to set a show reminder, as described below.  
2. Highlight NEW MANUAL REMINDER and press  
ENTER to display the Remind Options panel menu.  
1) Set a show Reminder from a panel menu  
Press yzx • to move through the options.  
1. Highlight a show and press MENU to display the  
Episode Options panel menu.  
Press the Number keys or yzx • to change the  
information, as necessary.  
2. Highlight SET REMINDER and press ENTER to  
display the Remind Options panel menu.  
3. Enter the information in the panel menu fields. You will  
need to set the start and end time for the reminder. For  
details, see “Set a show Reminder from a panel menu,”  
at left.  
3. Highlight the FREQUENCY field, and press x or to  
choose among Once, Regularly, Weekly, or Off.  
Note: When setting a Manual Reminder, the frequency  
option “Daily” is available instead of “Regularly.” See “Remind  
icons,” on the following page, for a description of Reminder  
icons.  
4. Highlight the POWER ON TV field, and press x or •  
to choose either Yes (to turn on the TV automatically, if  
off, at the scheduled Reminder time) or No (default).  
5. Highlight the AUTO TUNE TV field, and press x or •  
to choose either Yes (to automatically tune the TV to the  
channel you are setting the Reminder for at the  
scheduled Reminder time; the TV must be on at the  
time) or No (default).  
4. When finished entering the information in the fields,  
press ENTER to highlight SCHEDULE REMINDER,  
and press ENTER again to close the menu.  
A Remind icon for the selected frequency appears on the  
show tile. See “Remind icons” on the following page.  
Note: Manual reminders are listed by channel number.  
Note: You can change the default values of the Remind  
Options panel menu fields. See “Change default options” on  
page 71 for details.  
Or highlight CANCEL and press ENTER to close the  
menu, change no information, and return to the  
highlighted show.  
6. Highlight the WHEN field (to set a time for displaying  
the reminder screen), and press x or to choose in the  
range from 15 minutes early to 15 minutes late or On  
Time (default = 1 minute early).  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
68  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
Reminder features (continued)  
Reminder notification banner  
Remind icons  
Based on your option settings, a notification banner will appear  
on-screen if your TV is on at the scheduled Reminder time.  
Following is a description of the Remind icons that will appear  
on the tile for a show set to Remind.  
At that time you can either press ENTER to hide the Reminder  
banner or highlight the show and press ENTER to tune to  
the show.  
• Remind Once  
—Displays a show reminder one time.  
If no choice is made within 3 minutes, the notification banner  
closes automatically and performs the highlighted option  
(default is HIDE REMINDERS).  
• Remind Regularly  
time the show airs on the same channel and starts at the same  
time.  
—Displays a show reminder every  
Note: If more than two reminders are set for the same time,  
arrows appear on the Reminder notification banner. Press yz  
to highlight the shows.  
• Remind Weekly  
the show airs on the same day of the week and on the same  
channel, and starts at the same time.  
—Displays a show reminder every time  
• Remind Daily  
—Displays a show Reminder every  
weekday (Monday through Friday) for the same channel and  
start time.  
Note: This icon displays for manual reminders only.  
Reminder conflict  
A conflict message will appear in the following situations:  
• Remind Suspend  
schedule conflict (show remains in Schedule).  
—Reminder is Suspended due to a  
• A show set with an auto-tune Reminder has the same start  
time as an existing auto-tune Reminder.  
• A show set with an auto-tune Reminder overlaps with a  
scheduled Recording.  
• Remind Off  
—Keeps the Reminder in the Schedule list  
but will not display a reminder until you change the  
frequency.  
Select one of these options:  
• Auto-Tune Anyway—This show will override an existing  
show set to auto-tune.  
• Proceed, No Auto-Tune—Set the show as a Reminder but  
do not auto-tune.  
• Don’t Set This Reminder—Cancels the Reminder.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
69  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
SETUP screen  
The SETUP service screen allows you to change the following  
settings:  
Change channel display  
This option allows you to edit channel information that appears  
in LISTINGS, including the following:  
• System settings  
• Channel display  
• Default options  
Note: You must complete the TV Guide On Screen® setup (as  
described in Chapter 5) before you can change these settings.  
• Reorder the position the channels appear in LISTINGS.  
• Change the “tune channel” number.  
Note: The “tune channel” is the channel on which you receive  
a station. For example, two viewers in the same zip code may  
receive the same station on different channel numbers,  
depending on whether they have Cable service or are using a  
cable box.  
With SETUP highlighted in the Service Bar, highlight the  
settings you want to change, press ENTER, and follow the  
on-screen instructions.  
• Switch a channel to one of the following settings:  
On (channel is always displayed in LISTINGS)  
Off (channel is never displayed in LISTINGS)  
Auto-Hide (channel is displayed in LISTINGS only  
when program information is available)  
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE CHANNEL  
DISPLAY and press ENTER.  
With SETUP highlighted in the Service Bar, press INFO to  
display a help screen. Press INFO again to close the screen.  
2. Highlight the channel row you want to edit and press  
ENTER to display the Grid Options panel menu.  
Change system settings  
This option appears only after you have completed the initial  
TV Guide On Screen® setup process (as described in Chapter 5).  
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE SYSTEM  
SETTINGS and press ENTER.  
3. To edit the options, press INFO and follow the on-screen  
instructions.  
2. Press ENTER  
again to display  
the Confirming  
Your Settings  
screen.  
3. Highlight one of  
the options, press ENTER, and follow the on-screen  
instructions.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
70  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 7: Using the TV Guide On Screen® interactive program guide  
TV Guide On Screen® Services (continued)  
SETUP screen (continued)  
Change default options  
Record defaults  
This option allows you to change default settings in the  
following categories:  
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE DEFAULT  
OPTIONS and press ENTER.  
• General defaults  
• Record defaults  
• Remind defaults  
2. Highlight RECORD DEFAULTS and press MENU to  
display the Record Defaults panel menu.  
General defaults  
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE DEFAULT  
OPTIONS and press ENTER.  
3. Enter the required information in the panel menu fields  
(start time, end time, recorder choice, how long to keep a  
Record event, the quality of the recording). See “Record  
features” on page 66 for details on entering values in these  
fields.  
4. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and  
then press ENTER again to close the menu and accept the  
changes (or highlight CANCEL to close the menu with  
no changes).  
2. Highlight GENERAL DEFAULTS and press MENU to  
display the General defaults panel menu.  
Remind defaults  
1. From the SETUP screen, highlight CHANGE DEFAULT  
OPTIONS and press ENTER.  
2. Highlight REMIND DEFAULTS and press MENU to  
display the Remind Defaults panel menu.  
3. Enter the following information in the panel menu fields:  
• BOX SIZE: The initial Info Box size when you open the  
TV Guide On Screen® system. Choices are No, Small  
(default), Large, and Last Used.  
• BOX CYCLE: The Info Box size rotation when you press  
INFO on the remote control when the TV Guide  
On Screen® system is open. Choices are No Only, Small  
Only, Large Only, No & Small, No & Large, Small &  
Large, and All (default).  
3. Enter the required information in the panel menu fields  
(power On TV, auto-tune, when to display the Remind  
screen). See “Reminder features” on page 68 for details on  
entering values in these fields.  
• AUTO GUIDE: Automatic entry into the TV Guide  
On Screen® system when the TV is powered on. Choices  
are On (default) and Off.  
4. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and  
then press ENTER again to close the menu and accept the  
changes (or highlight CANCEL to close the menu with  
no changes).  
Note: Set the AUTO GUIDE to Off if you do not want the  
TV Guide On Screen® system to open every time you turn  
on the TV.  
4. When finished, press ENTER to highlight DONE, and  
press ENTER again to close the menu and accept the  
changes (or highlight CANCEL to close the menu with no  
changes).  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
71  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Using the TV’s features  
8
Selecting the video input source to view  
To select the video input source to view:  
1. Press INPUT on the remote control or TV/VIDEO on the  
TV front panel.  
2. Press 0–9 to select the input source you want to view, which  
will depend on the input terminals you used to connect  
your devices (see Chapter 2).  
Numbers  
The current signal source displays in the top right corner of  
the Input Selection screen.  
INPUT  
TheaterNet DEVICE  
Input Selection  
ANT 1  
y
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1  
Video 1  
Video 2  
z
Video 3  
ColorStream HD1  
ColorStream HD2  
HDMI 1  
HDMI 2  
PC  
ANT 2  
0
9
INPUT  
to Select  
-
/
Note:  
• When the Input Selection screen is open, you also can use the yz  
buttons on the remote control (or the Channel yz buttons on the  
front panel) to change the input.  
Remote control  
You can repeatedly press the INPUT button on the remote control  
or the TV/VIDEO button on the TV front panel to change the input.  
To select an IEEE1394 input source, press the TheaterNet DEVICE  
button on the remote control (see page 31 and 51).  
• If an IEEE1394 device is the current input, it will appear at the  
bottom of the Input Selection list; however, it will not display in the  
list if you change the input source.  
TV front panel touchpad  
You can label the video input sources according to the specific  
devices connected to the TV (see “Labeling the video input  
sources” on the next page).  
• The source can be “hidden.” See page 73 for details.  
CHANNEL zy  
TV/VIDEO  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
72  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Labeling the video input sources  
You can label each video input source according to the type of  
device you connected to each source, from the following preset  
list of labels:  
4. Press x or to select the desired label for that input source.  
If a particular input is not used, you can select “Hide” as  
the label, which will cause that input to be “grayed out” in  
the input list and skipped over when you press the INPUT  
button on the remote control.  
– – (default label)  
Hide (to hide an unused input in the Input Selection  
window)  
Note: If you select “Hide” for all of the input labels, the POP  
feature will be disabled. If you then attempt to access the POP  
feature, the message “NOT AVAILABLE” will appear on-screen.  
Audio Receiver  
VCR  
Video Recorder  
Laser Disk  
Compact Disc  
DVD  
5. To save the new input labels, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory default labels, highlight  
Reset and press ENTER.  
Input labeling example:  
The screen below left shows the default Input Selection screen  
(with none of the inputs labeled). The screen below right is an  
example of how you could label the inputs if you connected  
a DVD player to VIDEO 1, Cable TV to VIDEO 2, an audio  
receiver to VIDEO 3, a video recorder to ColorStream HD1,  
a DTV set-top box to HDMI 1, and a satellite/DSS set-top box  
to HDMI 2. Also note that the ColorStream HD2 input is  
labeled “Hidden,” which means that the input will be skipped  
over when INPUT or TV/VIDEO is pressed.  
DTV  
Satellite/DSS  
Cable  
Game Console  
Note:  
• If you set up devices in TheaterNet,™ the associated inputs are  
automatically labeled and cannot be relabeled until you remove the  
device from TheaterNet (see page 50).  
• If you set up a cable box in VIDEO 1, that input will be labeled  
automatically and cannot be relabeled until you remove the device  
from the TV Guide On Screen® setup.  
You cannot select IEEE1394 devices through the Input Selection  
window; however, you can select and control IEEE1394 devices  
through TheaterNet (see page 50).  
Input Selection  
ANT 1  
Input Selection  
ANT 1  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1  
DVD  
Video 1  
Cable  
Video 2  
Audio Receiver  
Video 3  
Video Receiver  
ColorStream HD1  
ColorStream HD2  
HDMI 1  
ColorSteram HD2 (Hidden)  
DTV  
To label the video input sources:  
Satellite/DSS  
PC  
HDMI 2  
PC  
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.  
2. Highlight Input Labeling and press ENTER.  
ANT 2  
ANT 2  
0
9
INPUT to Select  
0
9
INPUT to Select  
-
/
-
/
3. Press y or z to highlight the video source you want to  
Input Selection screen  
with no inputs labeled  
Input Selection screen with  
all inputs labeled except input 5,  
which has been hidden.  
label.  
To clear the input labels:  
Preferences  
Favorite Channels  
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.  
2. Highlight Input Labeling and press ENTER.  
3. Highlight Reset and press ENTER.  
Closed Caption Mode  
Closed Caption Advanced  
Input Labeling  
Off  
Menu Language  
Home CH Setup  
English  
Note: If you set up a device in TheaterNet, its input label will  
not be cleared unless you remove the device from TheaterNet  
(see page 50).  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Input Labeling  
Video 1  
DVD  
Cable  
Video 2  
Video 3  
Audio Receiver  
ColorStream HD 1  
ColorStream HD 2  
HDMI 1  
Video Receiver  
Hide  
DTV  
HDMI 2  
Satellite/DSS  
PC  
--  
--  
ANT 2  
Reset  
Done  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
73  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Tuning channels  
Using the Channel Browser™  
The Channel Browser stores in the channel history up to 32 of the most recently viewed channels. This feature allows you to:  
• Keep a separate, temporary* history of the last 32 channels tuned from each of three inputs: ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box.  
*
Note: Turning off the TV will clear the channel history for all three inputs.  
• Quickly surf and tune your recently viewed channels from the Channel Browser banner (illustrated below).  
• Surf via Browse mode (to immediately tune channels as you highlight them in the Channel Browser banner) or Select mode (to  
surf over channels in the browser banner before you select one to tune).  
• Set a “HOME” channel for the ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box inputs.  
To open the Channel Browser banner: Press x ( ), ( ), or ENTER on the remote control.  
– Press x ( ) to surf back from the most recently viewed channel through the last 32 channels that were tuned from the current  
input, which are automatically stored in the channel history for the current input (ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable Box only).  
– Press ( ) to surf forward from the previous channels in the channel history up to the most recently viewed channel.  
Elements of the Channel Browser banner  
Active channel  
status  
Highlighted channel  
Channels stored  
in the channel  
history  
Active channel  
Home channel instructions  
or (  
(Displays with a yellow  
background in Select mode.  
Displays with a yellow  
(In Browse mode, because the highlighted  
channel is tuned automatically, the active  
channel and the highlighted channel  
will always be the same.)  
[Press x (  
)
)
(Displays in this area  
only if available.)  
to surf the other channels  
in the channel history.]  
outline in Browse mode.)  
Hold HOME key  
3 sec to program  
12-3  
12345678  
14  
26-1  
QRS  
17-2  
TUV  
3
XYZ  
ABCD-DTV  
CB  
ANT 1 CABLE 3  
XYZ  
480p  
17-2  
Select Mode  
Current mode  
Current  
input  
Current  
antenna type  
(cable or TV)  
Active  
channel  
number  
Channel call  
letters  
Resolution  
Home channel  
(Select or Browse)  
(if available)  
To toggle between Browse mode and Select mode:  
After opening the Channel Browser banner, press y or z to toggle between Browse mode and Select mode. The “Current mode”  
field on the Channel Browser banner will flash green. Note: The Channel Browser banner opens in Browse mode by default.  
To tune to a channel in Browse mode:  
To tune to a channel in Select mode:  
1. While watching TV, press x ( ) or ( ) to open the  
Channel Browser banner and surf back to a previous channel  
or surf forward to the next channel in the channel history.  
1. While watching TV, press x ( ) or ( ) to open the  
Channel Browser banner and surf back to a previous channel  
or surf forward to the next channel in the channel history.  
In Browse mode, when you stop on a channel number in  
the browser banner, it will be highlighted with a yellow  
outline and the TV will automatically tune to the channel.  
In Select mode, when you stop on a channel number in  
the browser banner, it will be highlighted with a yellow  
background but the TV will not automatically tune to the  
channel.  
2. Press EXIT to close the Channel Browser banner.  
2. Press ENTER to tune the TV to the highlighted channel.  
3. Press EXIT to close the Channel Browser banner.  
Hold HOME key  
3 sec to program  
3
2
102-1  
Ch.3  
Browse Mode  
ANT 1  
CABLE Ch.102-1  
1080i  
Hold HOME key  
3 sec to program  
3
2
102-1  
In Browse mode, the highlighted channel number is outlined  
in yellow and the channel will be tuned to automatically.  
Ch.3  
Select Mode  
ANT 1  
CABLE Ch.102-1  
1080i  
In Select mode, the highlighted channel number has a  
yellow background. Press ENTER to tune to the channel.  
Note: The Channel Browser banner will close automatically if  
you do not make a selection within 60 seconds.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
74  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Tuning channels (continued)  
Using the Channel Browser(continued)  
Adding and clearing channels in the  
channel history  
Setting a channel as the “Home” channel  
for an input  
To set a channel as Home using the remote control:  
Adding channels to the channel history  
1. Tune the TV to the channel you would like to set as the  
Home channel for the current antenna input.  
The Channel Browser automatically creates a temporary* history  
of the last 32 channels that were tuned in the current input  
(ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box inputs only). A separate  
history will be stored for each of these inputs.  
2. Press and hold the HOME ( ) button on the remote  
control for 3 seconds. When the Home channel is saved,  
the Channel Browser banner will appear at the bottom of  
the screen with the home icon flashing green.  
*
Note: Turning off the TV will clear the channel history for all  
three inputs.  
Note: You can set a different Home channel for each input  
(ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box inputs only).  
If you change the input you are viewing:  
a) you will begin a channel history for that input if one had  
not already been started; or  
To set a channel as Home using the menus:  
b) you will return to the existing channel history for that input  
if one had already been started.  
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.  
2. Highlight Home CH Setup and press ENTER. The Home  
CH Setup window will display.  
The Channel Browser will store the following channels:  
• All channels that are tuned using the numeric buttons on the  
remote control.  
Home CH Setup  
ANT 1  
--  
--  
--  
ANT 2  
• All channels that are tuned for at least 7 seconds using the  
CH yz buttons or the FAV CH yz buttons on the remote  
control.  
Cable Box  
Reset  
Done  
Note:  
Note: "Cable Box" will appear in the Home CH Setup  
window only if you connected a cable box to your TV.  
• The Channel Browser banner will not appear when the POP double  
window is open; however, channels tuned while the POP double  
window is open will be added to the Channel Browser history for the  
current input.  
• The Channel Browser banner will not appear in the FAV SCAN  
(favorite scan) multi-window. Channels that appear in the FAV SCAN  
multi-window will not be added to the Channel Browser history;  
however, the channel last selected from the multi-window will be  
added to the channel history.  
3. Use the y z buttons to select the input for which you  
want to set the Home channel.  
4. Use the numeric and dash (–) buttons on the remote  
control to enter the desired Home channel for each input.  
5. To save your entries, highlight Done and press ENTER.  
To clear your entries, highlight Reset and press ENTER.  
Clearing channels from the channel history  
To tune to the Home channel:  
Turning off the TV will clear all three channel histories  
(ANT 1, ANT 2, and Cable Box).  
• Removing the CableCARDwill clear the channel history  
for the ANT 1 input.  
While an input that has a set  
Home channel is active, press the  
HOME ( ) button on the  
remote control.  
• Reconfiguring the ANT 1, ANT 2, or Cable Box input  
will clear the channel history for the newly configured  
input(s).  
Note: If you press the HOME  
button while an input other than  
an antenna or Cable Box input is  
selected, the TV will tune to the  
most recently tuned Home  
channel and input.  
x /BACK  
Note: See page 46 for details on configuring the antenna inputs.  
/NEXT  
HOME (  
)
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
75  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Tuning channels (continued)  
Switching between two channels using  
Channel Return  
The Channel Return feature allows you to switch between two  
channels without entering an actual channel number each time.  
Tuning your favorite channels  
To tune to the channels you programmed as Favorite Channels,  
see page 49.  
1. Select the first channel you want to view.  
Tuning to the next programmed channel  
To tune to the next programmed channel:  
2. Select a second channel using the Channel Number buttons  
(and the dash (–) button if selecting a digital channel).  
Press CHANNEL y or z on the remote control or TV front  
panel.  
Note:  
3. Press CH RTN on the remote control. The previous  
channel will display. Each time you press CH RTN, the TV  
will switch back and forth between the last two channels  
that were tuned.  
• This feature will not work unless you program channels into the  
TV’s channel memory (see page 47).  
Note:  
• If you are recording a digital channel, you will only be able to  
change analog channels while the recording is in progress. If you  
are recording an analog channel, you will only be able to change  
digital channels while the recording is in progress. This is  
because the TV tuner that is being recorded (digital or analog)  
will be locked on the channel that is currently recording.  
• If you press CH RTN from a non-antenna input, the TV will  
return to the last-viewed ANT input and channel.  
• If you are currently recording a program, this feature will  
not be available.  
Switching between two channels using  
SurfLock™  
The SurfLockfeature temporarily “memorizes” one channel in  
the CH RTN button, so you can return to that channel quickly  
from any other channel by pressing CH RTN. To memorize a  
channel in the CH RTN button:  
Tuning to a specific channel  
(programmed or unprogrammed)  
Tuning analog channels:  
Press the Channel Number buttons (0–9) on the remote  
control. For example, to select channel 125, press 1, 2, 5.  
1. Tune the TV to the channel you want to program into the  
CH RTN button.  
Tuning digital channels:  
Press the Channel Number buttons (0–9) on the remote  
control, followed by the – (dash) button and then the sub-  
channel number. For example, to select digital channel 125-1,  
press 1, 2, 5, –, 1.  
2. Press and hold CH RTN for about 2 seconds until the  
message “Channel Memorized” appears on the screen. The  
channel has been programmed into the CH RTN button.  
3. You can then change channels repeatedly, and when you  
press CH RTN, the memorized channel will be selected.  
Note: If a digital channel is not programmed—either  
through the automatic channel scan (page 47) or the channel  
add/delete function (page 48)—you will have to tune the RF  
channel using the Channel Number and Dash buttons on the  
remote control.  
The TV will return to the memorized channel one time only.  
Once you press CH RTN and then change channels again, the  
CH RTN memory will be cleared and the button will function  
as Channel Return, by switching back and forth between the last  
two channels that were tuned.  
Channel Numbers  
(dash)  
CHANNEL yz  
CH RTN  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
76  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Selecting the picture size  
You can view many program formats in a variety of picture  
sizes—Natural, TheaterWide 1, TheaterWide 2, TheaterWide 3,  
and Full—as described below and on the next page.  
Numbers  
PIC SIZE  
The way the image displays in any of the picture sizes will vary  
depending on the format of the program you are viewing. Select  
the picture size that displays the current program the way that  
looks best to you.  
Your picture size preferences can be saved for each input on your  
TV.  
y
z
To select the picture size:  
1. Press PIC SIZE on the remote control.  
2. While the Picture Size menu is on-screen, press the  
corresponding number button (0–4) to select the desired  
picture size.  
Note:  
Picture Size  
You also can select the picture size using the  
menu system. Select Picture Size in the  
Video/Theater Settings menu. Select the input  
for which you want to save your picture settings.  
To save your settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER.  
0
1
2
3
4
Natural  
TheaterWide 1  
TheaterWide 2  
TheaterWide 3  
Full  
0
4
PIC SIZE  
to Select  
-
/
Note:  
Theater Settings  
Picture Size  
Natural  
You also can repeatedly press PIC SIZE to select the desired  
picture size (or press the yz buttons on the remote control  
while the Picture Size screen is open).  
Picture Scroll  
Cinema Mode  
Auto Aspect Ratio  
--  
Film  
On  
• “Full” may not be available for some program formats (it will  
be “grayed out” in the Picture Size screen).  
Reset  
Done  
Natural picture size  
• The image is displayed close to its originally formatted  
proportion. Some program formats will display with  
sidebars and/or bars at the top and bottom.  
Natural picture size example: The way the image displays will  
vary depending on the format of the program you are currently  
watching.  
Conventional picture on a  
conventional TV screen  
Conventional picture in Natural size on  
your wide-screen TV  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
77  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Selecting the picture size (continued)  
Note:  
TheaterWide 1 picture size (For 4:3 format program)  
• If you select one of the TheaterWide® picture  
sizes, the top and bottom edges of the  
picture (including subtitles or captions) may  
be hidden. To view the hidden edges, either  
scroll the picture (TheaterWide 2 and 3 only)  
or try viewing the program in Full or Natural  
picture size.  
• The center of the picture remains close to its  
original proportion, but the left and right  
edges are stretched wider to fill the screen.  
• When selecting the picture size, the way  
the image displays will vary depending on  
the format of the program you are  
currently watching.  
TheaterWide 1 picture size example  
Using these functions to change the  
picture size (i.e., changing the height/  
width ratio) for any purpose other than  
your private viewing may be prohibited  
under the Copyright Laws of the United  
States and other countries, and may  
subject you to civil and criminal liability.  
TheaterWide 2 picture size (for letter box programs)  
• The picture is stretched wider to fill the width  
of the screen, but only slightly stretched taller.  
• The top and bottom edges of the picture  
A B C D E F G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -  
are hidden. To view the hidden areas, see  
“Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture” on  
page 79.  
TheaterWide 2 picture size example  
TheaterWide 3 picture size (for letter box programs with subtitles)  
• The picture is stretched wider to fill the width  
of the screen, but only slightly stretched taller.  
• The top and bottom edges are hidden. To view  
A B C D E F G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -  
the hidden areas (such as subtitles or captions),  
see “Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture” on  
page 79.  
A B C D E F G - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - - -  
TheaterWide 3 picture size example  
Full picture size (for 16:9 [480i, 480p] source programs only)  
• If receiving a squeezed 4:3 format program, the  
picture is stretched wider to fill the width of  
the screen, but not stretched taller.  
• None of the picture is hidden.  
Full picture size example  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
78  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Scrolling the TheaterWide® picture  
Using the auto aspect ratio feature  
(TheaterWide 2 and 3 only)  
When the auto aspect ratio feature is set to On, the picture size  
is automatically selected when one of the following input  
sources is received:  
You can set separate scroll settings for the TheaterWide 2 and  
TheaterWide 3 modes for each input.  
• A 480i signal from the VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3,  
ColorStream HD-1, or ColorStream HD-2 input.  
To set the scroll settings:  
1. Press INPUT on the remote control or TV/VIDEO on the  
TV to select the input for which you want to set the picture  
size and scroll settings.  
• A 1080i, 480i, 480p, or 720p signal from the HDMI input.  
Automatic aspect size  
Aspect ratio  
(automatically selected  
of signal source  
2. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
when Auto Aspect is On)  
3. Highlight Theater Settings and press ENTER.  
4:3 normal  
4:3 letter box  
16:9 full  
Natural (with sidebars)  
TheaterWide 2  
Full  
Video  
Not defined  
(no ID-1 data or  
HDMI aspect data)  
Picture Settings  
User-selected picture size  
(see pages 77–78)  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
Note:  
• The auto aspect ratio feature is not applicable to antenna or Cable input  
sources.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
4. In the Picture Size field, select either TheaterWide 2 or  
TheaterWide 3 (you cannot scroll in any other mode).  
• The auto aspect ratio feature is not available when the POP double-  
window is open, the Freeze mode is active, or the TV Guide On Screen®  
system is open.  
5. Press z to highlight the Picture Scroll field.  
6. Press x or to scroll the picture up and down as needed,  
To turn on the auto aspect ratio feature:  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
2. Highlight Theater Settings and press ENTER.  
from –10 to +20.  
Theater Settings  
Picture Size  
TheaterWide 2  
Picture Scroll  
Cinema Mode  
Auto Aspect Ratio  
-5  
Film  
On  
Video  
Picture Settings  
Reset  
Done  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
7. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
3. In the Auto Aspect Ratio field, select On.  
Theater Settings  
Picture Size  
Natural  
Picture Scroll  
Cinema Mode  
Auto Aspect Ratio  
-1  
Film  
On  
Reset  
Done  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
To turn off the auto aspect ratio feature:  
Select Off in step 3 above.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
79  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Selecting the cinema mode  
(480i signals only)  
Selecting the lamp mode  
You can select either High Bright or Low Power lamp mode.  
• High Bright mode is useful when additional picture  
brightness is desired (such as in a bright room).  
When you view a DVD (480i signal; 3:2 pulldown processed)  
from a DVD player connected to the VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2,  
ColorStream HD1/HD2 (component video), or HDMI inputs  
on the TV, smoother motion can be obtained by setting the  
Cinema Mode to Film.  
• Low Power mode reduces wear on the projection lamp. Using  
this mode should result in longer lamp life.  
See “Lamp unit replacement and care” on page 129–131.  
To set the Cinema Mode to Film:  
To select the lamp mode:  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
2. Highlight Theater Settings and press ENTER.  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
Video  
Video  
Picture Settings  
Picture Settings  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
3. In the Cinema Mode field, select Film.  
3. In the Lamp Mode field, select High Bright or Low Power,  
whichever you prefer.  
Theater Settings  
Picture Size  
Natural  
Advanced Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Picture Scroll  
Cinema Mode  
Auto Aspect Ratio  
-1  
Dynamic Contrast  
MPEG Noise Reduction  
CableClear  
On  
Low  
Film  
On  
Off  
Reset  
Done  
Color Temperature  
Lamp Mode  
Medium  
Low Power  
Color Management  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Reset  
Done  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
To set the Cinema Mode to Video:  
Select Video in step 3 above.  
Note:  
If you set the lamp mode to Low Power, each time you turn on the TV, the  
lamp will start out in High Bright mode but will switch to Low Power mode  
in approximately 1 minute. You will notice a change in screen brightness  
when this happens. This is normal and is not a sign of malfunction.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
80  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Using the POP features  
Using the POP double-window feature  
The POP (picture-out-picture) double-window feature splits the screen into two  
windows so you can watch two programs at the same time.  
Note:  
• When the main window is in ANT1 or ANT2 mode,  
the ANT1 and ANT2 inputs cannot be selected for  
the POP window.  
To display a program in the POP window:  
1. Select the program you want to watch in the main window.  
2. Press SPLIT to open the POP double-window.  
POP double-window  
• When the main window is in Video 1, Video 2,  
Video 3, ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2,  
HDMI 1, or HDMI 2 mode, that same input  
cannot be selected for the POP window.  
You cannot view IEEE1394 source programs in the  
POP window.  
You cannot view two video or two antenna sources  
in both the main and POP windows simultaneously.  
(You can view a video source in one window and  
an antenna source in the other.)  
POP window  
Main window  
ANT1  
POP  
TV12  
Video1  
• The FREEZE feature is not available when the POP  
double-window is open. If you press FREEZE  
when the POP double-window is open, the  
message “Not available” will appear.  
Green border  
(denotes active window)  
3. Press to highlight the POP (right) window. When highlighted, the window  
will have a green border.  
4. Press INPUT to open the POP Input Selection window. Select the input source  
for the POP window by pressing the corresponding Number button (0–9). The  
current source displays in purple in the POP Input Selection window.  
Numbers  
INPUT  
Note: If you labeled all of the inputs as  
POP Input Selection  
HIDE (page 73), the POP feature will be  
disabled and the message “NOT  
AVAILABLE” will appear on-screen if you try  
to open the POP double-window.  
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
ANT 1  
Video 1  
Video 2  
Video 3  
ColorStream HD1  
ColorStream HD2  
HDMI 1  
ENTER  
HDMI 2  
PC  
ANT 2  
0
9
INPUT  
to Select  
-
/
SPLIT  
To tune to the highlighted window (and close the POP window):  
Press ENTER after highlighting the window you want to view as a normal  
picture.  
To close the POP window:  
Press SPLIT or EXIT.  
Notes about recording:  
• If the POP window is open and you attempt to start recording, the POP window will close before  
recording starts.  
• If you use the TV’s remote control to start recording, you will not be able to open the POP window  
and the message “Not Available” will appear on-screen if you try to do so.  
• It is recommended that you use the TV’s remote control to start recording. If you use a device other  
than the TV’s remote control to start recording, you may be able to open the POP window during  
the recording process. If this happens, the recorded audio will reflect the audio of the active window  
(main or POP), which may not be the audio you intended to record.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
81  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Using the POP features (continued)  
Switching the speaker audio (main or POP)  
While the POP window is open, press x or to switch the audio (main or POP) that is  
output from the TV speakers (and also from the VARIABLE AUDIO OUT terminals).  
The window with the active sound is outlined with a green border.  
Example: Press x  
Example: Press •  
x •  
POP double-window aspect ratio  
The POP double-window feature displays each picture according to its input signal  
aspect ratio, as illustrated in the examples below.  
480i  
480i  
480p/720p/1080i  
480i  
Note:  
• The auto aspect ratio feature (page 79) does not  
operate in POP double-window mode.  
• Aspect ratio is the ratio of width to height of the  
picture.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
82  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Using the FREEZE feature  
To use the FREEZE feature:  
1. When viewing the TV, press FREEZE to make the picture a still picture.  
2. To return to the moving picture, either press FREEZE again, press EXIT, or press  
any other button.  
Using the FREEZE function for any  
purpose other than your private viewing  
may be prohibited under the Copyright  
Laws of the United States and other  
countries, and may subject you to civil  
and criminal liability.  
Note:  
• The FREEZE feature is not available when the POP double-window or FAV SCAN  
multi-window is open. If you press FREEZE when either window is open, the message  
“Not available” will appear.  
• If the TV is left in FREEZE mode for more than 15 minutes, the FREEZE mode will  
automatically be released and the TV will return to the moving picture.  
y
x
z
ENTER  
EXIT  
Moving picture  
Still picture  
Using the favorite channel scan feature  
You can use this feature to quickly scan and tune the channels you programmed as  
favorite channels (for the ANT 1 and ANT 2 inputs only) from a nine-picture  
multi-window.  
FREEZE  
FAV SCAN  
Note: To use the favorite channel scan feature, you must first program channels into the  
favorite channel memory. See “Programming your favorite channels” on page 49.  
To scan and tune your favorite channels:  
1. Press FAV SCAN. The TV will display the channels you programmed as favorite  
channels for the current ANT input in a nine-picture multi-window.  
(To display the channels you programmed as favorite channels for the other ANT  
input, you must change antenna inputs first (page 72), and then press FAV SCAN.)  
1
4
7
2
5
8
3
6
9
2
4–1  
11  
4–2  
13  
6
CABLE  
18  
31  
36  
18  
2. Highlight the window for the channel you want to view:  
Either... Press the channel’s multi-window position number (1–9, as illustrated  
above, and not the actual channel number) to highlight the window;  
Or...  
Use the y z x • buttons to highlight the window.  
The highlighted window will display as a moving picture.  
3. Press ENTER to tune the TV to the highlighted channel and close the multi-window.  
2
4–1  
11  
4–2  
13  
6
18  
31  
36  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
83  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the picture  
Selecting the picture mode  
Adjusting the picture quality  
You can select your desired picture settings from four different  
modes, as described below.  
You can adjust the picture quality (contrast, brightness, color,  
tint, and sharpness) to your personal preferences.  
Mode  
Picture Quality  
Selection  
x Pressing •  
Sports  
Standard  
Movie  
Bright and dynamic picture (factory setting)  
Standard picture settings (factory setting)  
Lower contrast for darkened room (factory setting)  
contrast  
brightness  
color  
tint  
sharpness  
lower  
darker  
paler  
reddish  
softer  
higher  
lighter  
deeper  
greenish  
sharper  
Preference Your personal preferences  
To select the picture mode using the  
remote control:  
To adjust the picture quality:  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
Press PIC MODE on the remote control.  
The following popup menu appears  
on-screen.  
2. Highlight Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
Picture Settings  
Mode: Standard  
Standard  
Mode  
Video  
Picture Settings  
PIC  
MODE  
Repeatedly press PIC MODE to cycle  
among the modes or use x or to  
select the picture mode you prefer.  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
3. Press y or z to select the picture quality you want to adjust  
(contrast, brightness, color, tint, or sharpness), and then  
x and to adjust the setting, as described in the table  
above.  
To select the picture mode using the menu system:  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
2. Highlight Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Mode  
Sports  
Contrast  
Brightness  
Color  
100  
50  
50  
0
Video  
Picture Settings  
Tint  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
Sharpness  
50  
Reset  
Done  
3. In the Mode field, select the picture mode you prefer.  
Picture Settings  
Mode: Preference  
Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Contrast  
70  
Mode  
Sports  
Contrast  
Brightness  
Color  
100  
50  
50  
0
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Tint  
Sharpness  
50  
Reset  
Done  
The picture qualities you adjusted are automatically saved in the  
Preference mode (see Selecting the picture mode,above left).  
Picture Settings  
Mode: Standard  
Standard  
Mode  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Note:  
• The picture mode you select affects the current input only  
(ANT 1 in the example above). You can select a different  
picture mode for each input.  
• If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,  
Standard, or Movie) and then change a picture quality setting  
(for example, increase the contrast or change the color  
temperature), the picture mode automatically changes to  
Preference in the Picture Settings menu.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
84  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the picture (continued)  
Using the Color Management feature  
6. Press y or z to select either Hue or Saturation, and then  
The Color management feature allows you to adjust the hue  
and saturation of six colors: red, green, blue, yellow, magenta,  
and cyan.  
press x and to adjust the setting.  
Hue  
+2  
To change the Color Management settings:  
1. Press Menu and open the Video menu.  
Saturation  
+2  
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
7. Press ENTER to return to the Color Management window.  
8. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Video  
Picture Settings  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
Note:  
• If you select Off in step 4 above, you cannot adjust the Hue  
or Saturation.  
3. Highlight Color Management and press ENTER.  
• If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,  
Standard, or Movie) and then change the Color Management  
to “On,” the picture mode automatically changes to  
Preference in the Picture Settings menu (page 84).  
Advanced Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Dynamic Contrast  
MPEG Noise Reduction  
CableClear  
On  
Low  
Auto  
Color Temperature  
Lamp Mode  
Cool  
Low Power  
Color Management  
Reset  
Done  
4. In the Color Management field, select On.  
5. Press y or z to highlight the color you want to adjust,  
and then press ENTER.  
Color Management  
Color Management  
On  
Hue  
–15  
Saturation  
+15  
Red  
Green  
Blue  
0
–15  
0
0
+15  
0
Yellow  
Magenta  
Cyan  
–15  
0
+15  
0
Reset  
Done  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
85  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the picture (continued)  
Using CableClear®/DNR (digital noise  
reduction)  
The CableClear® digital noise reduction feature allows you to  
reduce visible interference in your TV picture. This may be  
useful when receiving a broadcast with a weak signal (especially  
a Cable channel) or playing a noisy video cassette or disc. This  
feature is enabled for 480i signals only.  
Selecting the color temperature  
You can change the quality of the picture by selecting from three  
preset color temperatures (cool, medium, and warm), as  
described below.  
Mode  
Picture Quality  
cool  
blueish  
medium neutral  
warm reddish  
Note: The CableClear DNR feature does not function in  
ColorStream, HDMI (DVI), ATSC, IEEE1394, or digital  
Cable mode.  
To select the color temperature:  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
To change the CableClear/DNR settings:  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
Video  
Picture Settings  
AdvancedPictureSettings
Theater Settings  
Video  
Picture Settings  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
3. In the Color Temperature field, select the mode you prefer  
(Cool, Medium, or Warm).  
3. In the CableClear/DNR field, select your desired setting.  
Advanced Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Advanced Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Dynamic Contrast  
MPEG Noise Reduction  
CableClear  
On  
Low  
Dynamic Contrast  
MPEG Noise Reduction  
CableClear  
On  
Low  
Auto  
Auto  
Color Temperature  
Lamp Mode  
Cool  
Color Temperature  
Lamp Mode  
Cool  
Low Power  
Low Power  
Color Management  
Color Management  
Reset  
Done  
Reset  
Done  
Note:  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
• If the current input is ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, or  
VIDEO 3, the menu will display the text “CableClear.” The  
available selections are Off, Low, Middle, High, and Auto.  
Note:  
• If the current input is ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2, or  
HDMI, and the video resolution is 480i, the menu will display  
the text “DNR.” The available selections are Off, Low, Middle,  
High, and Auto. Auto will react proportionally to the strength of  
the noise. Low, Middle, and High will reduce the noise in  
varying degrees, from lowest to highest, respectively.  
If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,  
Standard, or Movie) and then change the color temperature  
mode, the picture mode automatically changes to Preference in  
the Picture Settings menu.  
• If the current input is ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2, or  
HDMI, and the video resolution is not 480i, the menu will  
display the text “DNR.  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
86  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the picture (continued)  
Using MPEG noise reduction  
Using dynamic contrast  
The MPEG noise reduction feature allows you to reduce visible  
interference caused by MPEG compression. Choices for MPEG  
noise reduction are High, Medium, Low, and Off. Off is  
automatically selected when this feature is disabled (grayed  
out). This feature is not available in the PC input mode.  
When dynamic contrast is set to On,the TV will detect  
changes in the picture quality that affect the appearance of your  
contrast settings and then automatically adjust the video.  
When dynamic contrast is set to Off,the settings selected in  
the Contrast field in Picture Settings will be used.  
To select the MPEG noise reduction level:  
To select dynamic contrast preferences:  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
1. Press MENU and open the Video menu.  
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
2. Highlight Advanced Picture Settings and press ENTER.  
Video  
Video  
Picture Settings  
Picture Settings  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
Advanced Picture Settings  
Theater Settings  
3. Press y or z to highlight the MPEG Noise Reduction  
field, and then press x or to select either High, Middle,  
Low, or Off.  
3. In the Dynamic Contrast field, select either On or Off.  
Advanced Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Dynamic Contrast  
MPEG Noise Reduction  
CableClear  
On  
Low  
Advanced Picture Settings  
ANT 1  
Auto  
Dynamic Contrast  
MPEG Noise Reduction  
CableClear  
On  
Low  
Color Temperature  
Lamp Mode  
Cool  
Low Power  
Auto  
Color Management  
Color Temperature  
Lamp Mode  
Cool  
Reset  
Done  
Low Power  
Color Management  
Reset  
Done  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Note:  
If you select one of the factory-set picture modes (Sports,  
Standard, or Movie) and then set the dynamic contrast to “On,”  
the picture mode will automatically change to Preference in the  
Picture Settings menu.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
87  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Using the closed caption mode  
The closed caption mode has two options:  
Advanced closed captions  
You can customize the closed caption display characteristics by  
changing the text size, type, edge, color, and the background  
color.  
CaptionsAn on-screen display of the dialogue, narration,  
and sound effects of TV programs and videos that are  
closed captioned (usually marked CCin program guides).  
TextAn on-screen display of information not related to  
the current program, such as weather or stock data (when  
provided by individual stations).  
Note:  
• This feature is available for digital channels only.  
You cannot set the Caption Text and Background as the same color.  
To view captions or text:  
To customize the closed captions:  
1. Press MENU and open the Preferences menu.  
2. Highlight Closed Caption Mode and then press .  
1. Press MENU and open  
the Preferences menu.  
3. Press z or y to select the desired closed caption mode and  
Preferences  
Favorite Channels  
2. Highlight Closed  
press ENTER.  
Closed Caption Mode  
CC1  
Caption Advanced and  
press ENTER.  
Closed Caption Advanced  
Input Labeling  
English  
Menu Language  
Home CH Setup  
Preferences  
3. Press y or z to  
highlight the  
Favorite Channels  
Closed Caption Mode  
Closed Caption Advanced  
Input Labeling  
Off  
CC1  
CC2  
CC3  
CC4  
T1  
Off  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
characteristic you want  
to change, and then  
press x or •  
to select the  
format for  
that  
English  
Menu Language  
Home CH Setup  
T2  
Advanced Closed Captions  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Caption Size  
Auto  
Caption Text Type  
Caption Text Edge  
Caption Text Color  
Background Color  
Auto  
Auto  
Auto  
Auto  
To view captions:  
Highlight CC1,  
CC2, CC3, or CC4.  
(CC1 displays  
translation of the  
primary language in  
your area.)  
characteristic.  
4. To save the  
new settings,  
highlight  
Reset  
Done  
Done and press ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults,  
highlight Reset and press ENTER.  
Giant pandas eat leaves.  
Note: If the program  
or video you selected  
is not closed captioned, no captions will display on-screen.  
Caption Size  
Auto, Small, Standard, Large  
Caption Text Type  
Auto, Default, Mono w. Serif, Prof. w. Serif,  
Mono w/o Serif, Prop w/o Serif, Casual,  
Cursive, Small Capitals  
To view text:  
Highlight T1, T2, T3,  
or T4.  
Caption Text Edge Auto, None, Raised, Depressed, Uniform,  
Left Drop Shadow, Right Drop shadow  
Note: If text is not  
available in your  
area, a black  
rectangle may  
appear on your  
screen. If this  
Caption Text Color Auto, Black, White, Red, Green, Blue,  
Yellow, Magenta, Cyan  
WORLD WEATHER  
Temps  
Current  
Weather  
Clear  
Cloudy  
Clear  
F
C
LONDON  
MOSCOW  
PARIS  
ROME  
TOKYO  
51  
57  
53  
66  
65  
11  
14  
12  
19  
18  
Auto, Black, White, Red, Green, Blue,  
Yellow, Magenta, Cyan  
Background Color  
Cloudy  
Rain  
happens, turn off the Closed Caption Mode.  
To turn off the Closed Caption mode:  
Select Off in step 3 above.  
Note: A closed caption signal may not display in the following situations:  
• When a videotape has been dubbed  
• When the signal reception is weak  
• When the signal reception is non-standard  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
88  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Using the closed caption mode (continued)  
Digital closed captions  
You can use the Digital CC/Audio selector to select digital  
closed caption services (if available), which will temporarily  
override closed captions for digital channels only.  
When such services are not available, the Digital CC/Audio  
selector presents a default list of services. If the selected service is  
not available, the next best service will be used instead.  
To select digital closed captions:  
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
2. Highlight Digital CC/Audio Selector and press ENTER.  
Applications  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
Picture Viewer  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
3. Press y or z to select Closed Caption, and then press  
x or to select the desired service.  
Audio  
CC 1  
Service 1  
Closed Caption  
4. Press ENTER.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
89  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the audio  
Muting the sound  
Press MUTE to partially reduce (1/2 MUTE) or turn off  
(MUTE) the sound. Each time you press MUTE, the mute  
mode will change in the following order:  
Selecting stereo/SAP broadcasts  
The multi-channel TV sound (MTS) feature allows you to  
output high-fidelity stereo sound. MTS also can transmit a  
second audio program (SAP) containing a second language,  
music, or other audio information (when provided by individual  
stations).  
1/2 Mute Mute Volume →  
If the closed caption mode is set to Off when you select  
MUTEmode, the closed caption feature is automatically  
activated. To mute the audio without automatically activating  
the closed caption feature, use the VOL z button to set the  
volume to 0. See Using the closed caption modeon page 88  
for more information on closed caption modes.  
The MTS feature is not available when the TV is in VIDEO  
mode. When the TV receives a stereo or SAP broadcast, the  
word STEREOor SAPappears on-screen when RECALL is  
pressed.  
To listen to stereo sound:  
1. Press MENU and open  
the Audio menu.  
Audio  
2. Highlight Audio Setup  
and press ENTER.  
Audio Settings  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Audio Setup  
VOL z  
Audio Setup  
RECALL  
MUTE  
3. In the MTS field, select  
Stereo.  
MTS  
Stereo  
English  
Language  
Speakers  
On  
Optical Output Format  
Dolby Digital  
Using the digital audio selector  
Reset  
Done  
You can use the Digital CC/Audio selector to conveniently  
switch between audio tracks on a digital channel (for those  
channels that have multiple audio tracks). This temporarily  
overrides the audio track chosen by the language option under  
Audio Setup (see Selecting stereo/SAP broadcasts,at right).  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To reset the settings to the factory defaults,  
highlight Reset and press ENTER.  
Note:  
• If you leave the TV in Stereo mode it will automatically output the  
type of sound being broadcast (stereo or monaural).  
To use the digital audio selector:  
• If the stereo sound is noisy, select MONO to reduce the noise.  
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
2. Highlight Digital CC/Audio Selector and press ENTER.  
To listen to an alternate language on an ATSC digital station  
(if available):  
Highlight the Language field in step 3 above, and then  
press x or to select the language you prefer.  
Applications  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
Picture Viewer  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
To listen to a second audio program on an analog station  
(if available):  
Select SAP in step 3 above.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Note:  
• A second audio program (SAP) can be heard only on TV  
stations that offer it. For example, a station might broadcast  
another language as a second audio program. If you have SAP  
on, you will see the current program on the screen but hear the  
other language instead of the program’s normal audio.  
3. Press y or z to select Audio, and then press x or to  
select the desired service.  
Audio  
CC 1  
Service 1  
Closed Caption  
• If you have SAP on and the station you are watching is not  
broadcasting a second audio program, the station’s normal  
audio will be output. However, occasionally there is no sound at  
all in SAP mode. If this happens, set the MTS feature to Stereo  
mode.  
4. Press ENTER.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
90  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the audio (continued)  
Adjusting the audio quality  
Using the StableSound® feature  
The StableSound® feature limits the highest volume level to  
prevent extreme changes in volume when the signal source  
changes (for example, to prevent the sudden increase in volume  
that often happens when a TV program switches to a  
commercial).  
You can adjust the audio quality by adjusting the bass, treble,  
and balance.  
To adjust the audio quality:  
1. Press MENU and open the  
Audio  
Audio menu.  
Audio Settings  
To turn on the StableSound® feature:  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Audio Setup  
2. Highlight Audio Settings  
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.  
2. Highlight Audio Settings and press ENTER.  
and press ENTER.  
3. Press zor y to highlight  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
the item you want to adjust  
(bass, treble, or balance).  
Audio  
Audio Settings  
Audio Settings  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Audio Setup  
Bass  
100  
100  
0
Treble  
Balance  
SBS  
On  
Off  
SBS Level  
StableSound  
85  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Reset  
Done  
3. In the StableSound field, select On.  
4. Press x or to adjust the level.  
Audio Settings  
x makes the bass or treble weaker or increases the balance  
in the left channel (depending on the item selected).  
Bass  
100  
100  
0
Treble  
Balance  
SBS  
makes the bass or treble stronger or increases the balance  
in the right channel (depending on the item selected).  
On  
SBS Level  
StableSound  
85  
On  
Reset  
Done  
5. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To reset the settings to the factory defaults,  
highlight Reset and press ENTER.  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Note: The RESET function returns your audio adjustments to  
the following factory settings:  
Using the sub-bass system (SBS)  
The sub-bass system allows you to enhance bass performance,  
even when the volume is low.  
Bass ............. center (50)  
Treble .......... center (50)  
Balance ........ center (0)  
StableSound... Off  
To turn on the SBS and adjust the level:  
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.  
2. Highlight Audio settings and press ENTER.  
To turn off the StableSound feature:  
3. In the SBS field, select On.  
Select Off in step 3 above.  
4. Press y or z to highlight SBS Level, and then press x or •  
to adjust the sub-bass system.  
Audio Settings  
Bass  
100  
100  
0
Treble  
Balance  
SBS  
On  
Off  
SBS Level  
StableSound  
85  
Reset  
Done  
5. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To reset the settings to the factory defaults,  
highlight Reset and press ENTER.  
To turn off the SBS:  
Select Off in step 3.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
91  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the audio (continued)  
Using the SRSWOWsurround sound  
feature  
Using the virtual surround sound  
feature (Dolby® Virtual/TruSurround)  
WOWis a special combination of SRS Labs audio  
technologies (SRS 3D, FOCUS, and TruBass) that creates a  
thrilling surround sound experience with deep, rich bass from  
stereo sound sources. Your TV’s audio will sound fuller, richer,  
and wider.  
The Dolby* Virtual/TruSurround feature allows you to enjoy  
virtual surround sound from the TV’s speakers. This feature  
is enabled only when the TV is receiving digital broadcasts.  
To turn on the Dolby Virtual/TruSurround feature:  
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.  
To adjust the WOWsettings:  
2. Highlight Advanced Audio Settings and press ENTER.  
1. Put the TV in STEREO mode (see “Selecting stereo/SAP  
broadcasts” on page 90).  
Audio  
2. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.  
Audio Settings  
3. Highlight Advanced Audio Settings and press ENTER.  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Audio Setup  
3. In the Dolby Virtual/TruSurround field, select On.  
Audio  
Audio Settings  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Audio Setup  
WOW: SRS 3D  
WOW: FOCUS  
WOW: TruBass  
Off  
Off  
Low  
Dolby Virtual  
TruSurround  
On  
4. Press z or y to highlight the WOW feature you want to  
Reset  
Done  
adjust, and then press x or to adjust the item.  
Advanced Audio Settings  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
WOW: SRS 3D  
WOW: FOCUS  
WOW: TruBass  
Off  
Off  
Low  
Dolby Virtual  
TruSurround  
On  
To turn off theDolby Virtual/TruSurround feature:  
Reset  
Done  
Select Off in step 3 above.  
• WOW: SRS 3D — To turn the surround sound effect  
On or Off.  
Note: The Dolby Virtual/TruSurround and WOW SRS 3D  
features cannot be on at the same time. If you set one to  
On, the other will automatically be set to Off.  
Note: If the broadcast is monaural, the SRS 3D effect  
will not work.  
• WOW: Focus — To turn the vocal emphasis effect On  
or Off.  
• WOW: TruBass — To select the desired bass expansion  
level (High, Low, or Off).  
5. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
_________  
WOW, TruSurround, SRS and  
symbol are trademarks of SRS Labs, Inc.  
WOW technology is incorporated under license from SRS Labs, Inc.  
TruSurround technology is incorporated under license from SRS Labs, Inc.  
*Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby is a registered  
trademark of Dolby Laboratories.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
92  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Adjusting the audio (continued)  
Turning off the built-in speakers  
Selecting the optical audio output  
format  
You can use this feature to select the optical audio output format  
when you connect a Dolby Digital decoder or other digital  
audio system to the Optical Audio Out terminal on the TV (see  
Connecting a digital audio systemon page 24).  
You can use this feature to turn off the TV speakers when you  
connect an audio system to your TV (see Connecting a digital  
audio systemand Connecting an analog audio systemon  
page 24).  
To turn off the built-in  
speakers:  
To select the optical audio output format:  
1. Press MENU and open the Audio menu.  
2. Highlight Audio Setup and press ENTER.  
Audio  
1. Press MENU and open  
Audio Settings  
Advanced Audio Settings  
the Audio menu.  
Audio Setup  
2. Highlight Audio Setup  
and press ENTER.  
Audio Setup  
MTS  
Stereo  
English  
Audio  
Language  
Audio Settings  
Speakers  
On  
3. In the Speakers field,  
select Off.  
Advanced Audio Settings  
Audio Setup  
Optical Output Format  
Dolby Digital  
Reset  
Done  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
3. In the Optical Output Format field, select either Dolby  
Digital or PCM, depending on your device.  
Audio Setup  
MTS  
Stereo  
English  
To turn on the built-in speakers:  
Language  
Speakers  
On  
Select On in step 3 above.  
Optical Output Format  
Dolby Digital  
Reset  
Done  
4. To save the new settings, highlight Done and press  
ENTER. To revert to the factory defaults, highlight Reset  
and press ENTER.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
93  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Setting the On/Off Timer  
Setting the sleep timer  
You can use the On/Off Timer to turn the TV on and off at a  
preset time on a recurring basis.  
You can set the sleep timer to turn off the TV after a set length  
of time (maximum of 3 hours).  
Note: You must first set the time (see page 55).  
The sleep timer turns off the TV one time only, as opposed to  
the On/Off Timer, which turns off the TV on a recurring basis.  
To set the On/Off Timer:  
To set the sleep timer:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight On/Off Timer and press ENTER.  
Press SLEEP on the remote control to set the length of time until  
the TV turns off. Repeatedly press SLEEP to increase the time in  
10-minute increments or press y or z to increase or decrease the  
time in 10-minute increments, to a maximum of 3 hours and 00  
minutes.  
Setup  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
To cancel the sleep timer:  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
Press SLEEP until it is set to 0.  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
SLEEP  
3. In the DAY field, press x or to select the recurrence  
(weekends, weekdays, every day, etc).  
To set the sleep timer using the on-screen menus:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Sleep Timer and press ENTER.  
On/Off Timer  
Turn TV ON:  
Day  
Weekends  
9 : 0 AM  
30 Minutes  
0
0
Time (HH:MM)  
TV ON Duration:  
Reset  
Cancel  
Done  
Setup  
Installation  
4. Press z to highlight the Time field, and then use the  
Number buttons to enter the time you want the TV to  
turn on.  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
HDMI 2 Audio  
5. When the AM/PM field is highlighted, press to select  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
AM or PM.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
6. Press z to highlight the TV ON Duration field, and then  
press x or to select the length of time until the TV turns  
off (30 Minutes, 12 Hours, 8 Hours, 4 Hours, 2 Hours,  
1 Hour).  
3. Press the Number buttons to enter the length of time in  
10-minute increments.  
Sleep Timer  
7. Highlight Done and press ENTER.  
Enter total minutes until the TV  
turns off automatically (Maximum  
180 minutes)  
8. Turn off the TV. The TV will turn on automatically on the  
day(s) and at the time you set. The TV will then turn off  
automatically after the length of time you set in the  
TV ON Duration field.  
1 2 0  
Cancel  
Done  
Note:  
4. Highlight Done and press ENTER.  
• When a power failure occurs, the On/Off Timer settings may  
be cleared.  
Note:  
• When a power failure occurs, the sleep timer setting may be cleared.  
To display the On/Off Timer setting, press RECALL.  
To display the amount of time left on the sleep timer, press RECALL.  
To turn off the On/Off Timer:  
To display the remaining sleep time:  
Select Not Set in step 3 above.  
Press SLEEP.  
On/Off Timer  
Sleep Timer  
Turn TV ON:  
Day  
Not Set  
1h10m  
Note:  
A message will display on-screen when there is one minute  
Reset  
Cancel  
Done  
remaining on the sleep timer.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
94  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Using the PC settings feature  
• Horizontal Position:  
Moves the picture left/right.  
The adjustment range is within 5 from center.*  
You can view the image from a PC on the TV screen. The PC  
must be connected to the TVs PC IN terminals. (See page 29  
for connection details.)  
You can use the PC Settings feature to adjust the pictures  
horizontal position/size, vertical position/size, clock phase, and  
sampling clock.  
Vertical Position:  
Moves the picture up/down.  
The adjustment range is within 5 from center.*  
Note: If a PC is not connected, this feature will be grayed out  
in the Input Selection screen and Setup menu.  
• Horizontal Width:  
To adjust the PC settings:  
Adjusts the width of the picture.  
The adjustment range is within 5 from center.*  
1. Repeatedly press INPUT to select PCinput mode. (See  
Selecting the video input source to viewon page 72.)  
• Vertical Height:  
Adjusts the height of the picture.  
The adjustment range is within 5 from center.*  
2. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
3. Highlight PC Settings and press ENTER.  
• Clock Phase:  
Helps to reduce noise and sharpen the picture.  
The adjustment range is within 15 from center.*  
Setup  
Installation  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
• Sampling Clock:  
HDMI 1 Audio  
Auto  
Auto  
Helps to minimize periodic vertical stripes on the screen.  
The adjustment range is within 15 from center.*  
___________  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
2 Sec  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
*The range of adjustment may vary slightly.  
4. Press y or z to highlight the item you want to adjust.  
5. Press x or to make the appropriate adjustments.  
PC Settings  
Horizontal Position  
Horizontal Width  
Vertical Position  
Vertical Height  
Clock Phase  
0
0
0
0
0
0
Sampling Clock  
Reset  
Done  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
95  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 8: Using the TV’s features  
Displaying TV setting information  
on-screen using RECALL  
Understanding the auto power off  
feature  
To display TV setting information on-screen:  
Press RECALL on the remote control.  
The TV will automatically turn itself off after approximately 15  
minutes if it is tuned to a vacant channel or a station that  
completes its broadcast for the day. This feature functions in  
ANT 1 and ANT 2 modes only.  
The following information will display on-screen (if applicable):  
Current input (ANT 1, ANT 2, VIDEO 1, etc.)  
If ANT 1 or ANT 2 is the current input, whether it is  
Cable TV (CABLE) or  
STEREO  
Tuner Hold: On  
off-air (TV)  
Understanding the last mode  
memory feature  
NC-17  
Channel number (if in  
ANT 1 or ANT 2 mode)  
On Timer: Weekdays 12:00pm  
Sleep Timer: 18 min.  
Game Timer: 28 min.  
ANT 1  
Signal strength indicator  
(bar graph in lower right  
corner of screen; for  
Natural  
If the power is cut off while you are viewing the TV, the Last  
Mode Memory feature automatically turns on the TV when  
the power is resupplied.  
5:32pm  
1080i  
CABLE 81-1  
Sample RECALL screen  
ATSC signal only)  
Note: The signal strength indicator will react to fading and  
increasing signals.  
Note: You should unplug the TV’s power cord if it is possible  
that you will be away from the TV for an extended period of time  
after the power is restored.  
Time (if set)  
On/Off timer settings (if set)  
Remaining time on sleep timer (if set)  
Remaining time on game timer (if set)  
Stereo or SAP audio status  
V-Chip rating status  
Using the Gray Level feature  
The gray level feature will set the sidebars to three different  
levels of darkness. Sidebars are the blanks spaces on either side  
of a 4:3 viewing area.  
Picture size  
Tuner hold* (if applicable)  
To set the gray level of the sidebars:  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Gray Level and press .  
*If you are recording on one tuner (for example, the digital  
tuner), you will be able to change channels on the other tuner  
only (the analog tuner in this example). The tuner from which  
you are recording is “on hold” (i.e., locked) so your  
3. Press y or z to select your desired level of darkness  
recordings will not be affected by channel changes.  
(1 Black, 2 Dark Gray or 3 Gray).  
Video resolution  
Lamp mode (appears only if the TV is in Hi Bright mode)  
To close the RECALL screen:  
Setup  
PC Settings  
1
2
3
Press RECALL again.  
Auto  
HDMI 1 Audio  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
AVHD Skip Time  
Gray Level  
Auto
2 Sec  
15 min  
2
On  
Quick Restart  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Note:  
• The gray level feature does not affect video being viewed in 16:9  
aspect ratio.  
• When receiving a signal that has sidebars (e.g., 4:3 aspect ratio  
video over a 1080i or 720p signal), the gray level feature will not be  
applied to the sidebars.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
96  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Using the Locks menu  
9
The Locks menu includes the Enable Rating Blocking, Edit Rating Limits, Channels Block, Input Lock, Front Panel Lock, Game  
Timer, and New PIN Code features. You can use these features after entering the correct PIN code.  
Entering the PIN code  
If you cannot remember your  
PIN code  
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.  
While the PIN code entering screen is displayed, press RECALL  
four times within five seconds. The PIN code will be cleared and  
you can enter a new PIN code.  
Locks  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
New PIN Code  
Changing your PIN code  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.  
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.  
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.  
4. Press z to highlight New PIN Code and press ENTER.  
2. Press z, which displays the PIN code entry screen.  
• The Lock System screen (below) appears if a PIN code has  
not been stored. Press the Channel Number buttons to  
enter a new four-digit code, enter the code a second time to  
confirm, and press ENTER.  
Lock System  
Locks  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Please enter a 4 digit PIN code  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Confirm PIN code  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
New PIN Code  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Cancel  
Done  
5. Press the Number buttons to enter a new four-digit code.  
Retype the numbers to confirm the PIN code you entered.  
6. Press ENTER. The new PIN code is now active.  
• The Locks/Active screen (below) appears if the PIN code is  
already stored. Use the Channel Number buttons to enter  
your four-digit code and press ENTER.  
New PIN Code  
Locks  
Active  
Please enter a 4 digit PIN code  
Please enter the 4 digit PIN code  
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
Confirm PIN code  
*
*
*
*
Cancel  
Done  
Cancel  
Done  
If the wrong PIN code is entered, the message “Incorrect PIN  
code, please try again!” appears. Highlight Retry and press  
ENTER. Enter the code again and press ENTER.  
When the correct PIN code is entered, the Locks menu opens.  
Locks  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
New PIN Code  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
97  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu  
Blocking TV programs and movies by rating (V-Chip)  
Some TV programs and movies include signals that classify the  
Independent rating system for broadcasters  
content of the program (violence, sex, dialog, language). The  
V-Chip feature in this TV detects the signals and blocks the  
programs according to the ratings you select. (See the tables at  
right for rating descriptions.)  
Ratings  
Description and Content themes  
TV-MA Mature Audience Only (This program is specifically designed  
to be viewed by adults and therefore may be unsuitable for  
children under 17.)  
Note: Rating blocking is a function of the V-Chip feature in this  
TV, which supports the U.S. V-Chip system only.  
L) Crude or indecent language S) Explicit sexual activity  
V) Graphic violence  
TV-14 Parents Strongly Cautioned (This program contains some  
material that many parents would find unsuitable for children  
under 14 years of age.)  
To block and unblock TV programs and movies:  
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.  
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.  
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.  
4. Press z to highlight Enable Rating Blocking.  
D) Intensely suggestive dialog L) Strong, coarse language  
S) Intense sexual situations V) Intense violence  
TV-PG Parental Guidance Suggested (This program contains  
material parents may find unsuitable for younger children.)  
D) Some suggestive dialog L) Infrequent coarse language  
S) Some sexual situations V) Moderate violence  
5. Press and then z to select On, and then press ENTER.  
TV-G  
General Audience (Most parents would find this program  
suitable for all ages.)  
Locks  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Off  
TV-Y7, Directed to Older Children (This program is designed  
TV-Y7FV for children age 7 and above. Note: Programs in which  
fantasy violence may be more intense or more combative  
than other programs in this category are designated Y7FV.)  
On  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
New PIN Code  
TV-Y  
All Children (This program is designed to be appropriate for  
all children.)  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
6. Press z to highlight Edit Rating Limits and press ENTER.  
Independent rating system for movies  
Locks  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Rating  
Description and content themes  
X-rated (For adults only)  
X
Off  
Off  
Off  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
NC-17 Not intended for anyone 17 and under  
Restricted (Under 17 requires accompanying parent or adult)  
New PIN Code  
R
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
PG-13 Parents Strongly Cautioned (Some material may be  
inappropriate for children under 13)  
The Edit Rating Limits screen (below) appears.  
PG  
G
Parental Guidance Suggested (Some material may not be  
suitable for children)  
7. Press yzx • and then press ENTER to select the level of  
blocking you prefer. A box with an “×” is a rating that will  
be blocked. As you highlight a rating, a definition for the  
rating appears at the bottom of the screen.  
General Audience (Appropriate for all ages)  
Note:  
8. When you are finished selecting the ratings you want to  
block, highlight Done and press ENTER.  
• If you place an “X” in the box next to None’ Rated,” programs rated  
“None” will be blocked; however, programs that do not provide any  
rating information will not be blocked.  
To display the rating of the program you are watching, press RECALL on  
the remote control. If it is rated “None,” the word “NONE” appears in the  
RECALL screen (as shown below right). If rating information is not  
provided, no rating will appear in the RECALL screen.  
TV PG  
L
V
NONE  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
98  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu  
Blocking channels  
Unlocking programs temporarily  
With the Channels Block feature, you can block specific  
channels. You will not be able to tune blocked channels unless  
you clear the setting first.  
If you try to tune the TV to a program that exceeds the rating  
limits you set, the TV will enter program lock mode and the  
following message will appear on-screen:  
To block channels:  
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.  
2. Press z to display the  
You can either temporarily unlock the program or select an  
unlocked program to watch.  
PIN code entering  
screen.  
Locks  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
To temporarily unlock the program:  
3. Enter your four-digit  
PIN code and press  
ENTER (see page 97 for  
details).  
Locks  
Active  
1. Press MUTE.  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
Enter PIN code to temporaily un-  
block.  
2. Enter your four-digit  
PIN code and press  
New PIN Code  
*
*
*
*
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
ENTER. If the correct  
code is entered, the  
4. Press z to highlight  
Cancel  
Done  
Channels Block and then press ENTER.  
program lock mode is  
5. Using the yz x • buttons, select the input for which you  
want to change the rating limits (ANT1, ANT2, or Cable  
Box, if connected) and press ENTER.  
released and the normal picture appears. All locking is  
disabled until the TV is turned off, and will be enabled  
when the TV is turned on again.  
A list of the channels available for that input will be  
displayed along with the call letters for each channel, if  
available.  
Using the input lock feature  
Channels Block  
ANT 1  
6. Press yz to highlight  
the channel you want to  
block, then press  
1
2
ANT 1  
You can use the Input Lock feature to lock the video inputs  
(VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3, ColorStream HD-1,  
ColorStream HD-2, HDMI 1, HDMI 2, and PC) and channels  
3 and 4. You will not be able to view the input sources or  
channels until you unlock the inputs.  
ANT 2  
3
Cable Box  
ENTER, which puts an  
×” in the box next to  
that channel.  
4
5
6
7
Allow All  
Block All  
Cancel  
Done  
8
7. Repeat step 6 for other  
channels you want to  
block.  
To lock/unlock the video inputs:  
9
10  
1. Press MENU and  
highlight the Locks menu  
icon.  
2. Press z to display the  
PIN code entering screen.  
3. Enter your four-digit PIN  
code and press ENTER.  
Locks  
8. Highlight Done and press ENTER.  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Off  
Video  
Video +  
To unblock individual channels:  
Off  
Off  
Off  
In step 6 above, press yz to highlight the channel you want to  
unblock, and then press ENTER to remove the “X” from the  
box, and then highlight Done and press ENTER.  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
New PIN Code  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
4. Press z to highlight Input  
To block all channels at once:  
Lock and press .  
5. Press y or z to select the level of video input locking you  
Highlight Block All in step 6 above, and then highlight Done,  
and press ENTER.  
prefer, as described below.  
To unblock all locked channels at once:  
6. Press ENTER.  
Channels Block  
ANT 1  
ANT 1  
Highlight Allow All in step 6  
above, and then highlight  
Done and press ENTER.  
Video: Locks VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3,  
ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2, HDMI 1,  
HDMI 2, and PC.  
1
2
ANT 2  
3
Cable Box  
Video+: Locks VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3,  
ColorStream HD1, ColorStream HD2, HDMI 1,  
HDMI 2, PC, and channels 3 and 4.  
4
5
6
7
Allow All  
Block All  
Cancel  
Done  
8
• Make sure the POP window is not on channel 3 or 4.  
9
• Select Video+ if you play video tapes via an ANT input.  
10  
• When a CableCARD™ is inserted, Video+ will not lock  
channels 3 and 4.  
Note: Channel blocking may not take effect if you have a cable box  
connected and use the cable box controls to change channels.  
Off:  
Unlocks all video inputs and channels 3 and 4.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
99  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 9: Using the Locks menu  
Using the GameTimer™  
Using the front panel lock feature  
You can use the GameTimer to set a time limit for playing a  
video game (30–120 minutes). When the GameTimer is  
activated, the TV enters VIDEO LOCK mode and locks out  
the input source for the video game device.  
You can lock the front panel touchpad controls to prevent your  
settings from being changed accidentally (by children, for  
example). When the front panel lock is On, none of the controls  
on the TV front touchpad will operate except POWER.  
To set the GameTimer:  
To lock the front panel:  
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.  
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.  
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.  
4. Press z to highlight Game Timer and then press .  
1. Press MENU and highlight the Locks menu icon.  
2. Press z to display the PIN code entering screen.  
3. Enter your four-digit PIN code and press ENTER.  
4. Press z to highlight Front Panel Lock.  
5. Press y or z to select the length of time until the Video  
Lock is activated (30, 60, 90, or 120 minutes) and press  
ENTER.  
5. Press to highlight On and press ENTER. When the front  
panel is locked and any button on the touchpad (except  
POWER) is pressed, the message “Not Available” appears.  
Locks  
Locks  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Off  
Enable Rating Blocking  
Edit Rating Limits  
Channels Block  
Input Lock  
Off  
Off  
30 min  
60 min  
90 min  
120 min  
On  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Off  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
Front Panel Lock  
Game Timer  
New PIN Code  
New PIN Code  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
To cancel the GameTimer:  
To unlock the front panel:  
Select Off in step 5 above.  
Highlight Off in step 5 above, or press and hold the  
VOLUME x button on the TV front panel for about 10  
seconds until the volume icon appears on-screen.  
To deactivate the video lock once the GameTimer has  
activated it:  
Set the VIDEO LOCK to Off (see “Locking video inputs” on  
page 99).  
TV front panel touchpad  
Note:  
• A message will appear on-screen when 10 minutes,  
3 minutes, and 1 minute remain on the GameTimer.  
• If the TV loses power with time remaining on the GameTimer,  
when power is restored the TV will enter VIDEO LOCK mode  
(as if the GameTimer had expired) and you will have to  
deactivate the video lock (as described above).  
VOLUME x  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
100  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Using the Picture Viewer and Audio Player  
10  
You can use the Picture Viewer to view compatible JPEG-format  
photos on your TV’s screen.  
Media specifications  
You can use the Audio Player to play compatible MP3 files on  
the TV.  
File/folder name specifications  
The TV can access JPEG and/or MP3 files that are stored  
on either a memory card (as described in this chapter) or a  
networked PC (as described in this chapter, in Chapter 11, and  
on page 30).  
Maximum file name length: 255 characters.  
Maximum shared folder* name length: 12 characters.  
File names must contain US-ASCII characters only.  
Note:  
Never remove a memory card or turn off the TV while  
viewing/playing files from a memory card. Doing so may  
result in loss of data and/or damage to the memory card and/or TV.  
SUCH DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED BY YOUR TOSHIBA  
WARRANTY.  
File and folder names cannot contain any special characters,  
such as \ / : ? “ ” < > | .  
Picture Viewer/JPEG file  
specifications  
• If you are viewing/playing files stored on a memory card or networked  
PC, IT IS RECOMMENDED THAT YOU BACK UP YOUR DATA.  
Toshiba is not liable for any damage caused by the use of any memory  
card, networked PC, or shared files with this TV. Toshiba will not  
compensate for any lost data or recording(s) caused by the use of  
such cards, PCs, or data.  
Maximum JPEG file size: 8 MB  
• JPEG files larger than 8 MB will not display.  
• Failure to take proper care of a memory card may prevent display of  
pictures or playback of MP3 files from the card or result in damage to  
the memory card and/or TV. SUCH DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED  
BY YOUR TOSHIBA WARRANTY. See “Memory card care and  
handling” on page 106.  
Maximum JPEG image resolution: 6000 x 4000 pixels  
• Images with a resolution higher than 6000 x 4000 pixels will  
not display.  
– The Picture Viewer is designed to display only pictures stored  
in compatible JPEG formats with a file extension of “.jpg.”  
• The technical criteria set out in this owner’s manual are meant as a  
guide only.  
– JPEG images processed and/or edited on a personal computer  
(PC) may not display properly or at all.  
You must obtain any required permission from copyright  
owners to download or use copyrighted content. Toshiba  
cannot and does not grant such permission.  
– Some digital cameras may store images in a format that is not  
compatible with the TV.  
JPEG files stored on a memory card or networked PC that  
are not in a file and folder format compatible with the TV  
will not display on the TV.  
___________  
*The words “folder” and “directory” are used interchangeably.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
101  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 10: Using the Picture Viewer and Audio Player  
Media specifications (continued)  
Audio Player/MP3 file specifications  
Memory card specifications  
Maximum MP3 file size: 50 MB  
The TV is designed to read the following memory cards:  
– SD Memory Card (ver. 1.0)  
• MP3 files larger than 50 MB will not play.  
– MMC (MultiMediaCard)  
– Memory Stick(Pro)  
The Audio Player is designed to play only music files stored  
in compatible MP3 formats with a file extension of “.mp3.”  
– xD-Picture Card® (16MB–512MB)  
– CompactFlash® memory card (Type1)  
MP3 files processed and/or edited on a PC may not play  
properly or at all. Some MP3 files may be in a format that is  
not compatible with the TV.  
Memory card format: FAT16  
MP3 files must be in the following format:  
• Other memory card formats (including but not limited to  
FAT32 and NTFS) are not compatible.  
• MPEG1 (ISO/IEC 11172-3) Layer3.  
• Sampling frequency—MPEG1: 32 kHz, 44.1 kHz,  
48 kHz.  
Maximum memory card capacity: 512 MB  
Maximum number of files per memory card:  
• Bitrate—MPEG1: 32–320 kbps.  
– JPEG = 1,000  
• Channels—Stereo, Joint stereo, Dual channel, Single  
channel.  
• All JPEG files over the 1,000th on a single memory card  
will not display.  
• ID3 Ver. 1, Ver. 2.  
– MP3 = 200  
The meta-data for MP3 files (e.g, artist name, album name,  
• All MP3 files over the 200th on a single memory card  
will not play.  
song title, etc.) must be in the following format:  
ISO-8859-1 (US-ASCII/ Western European)  
character sets  
MP3 files stored on a memory card or networked PC that  
are not in a file and folder format compatible with the TV  
will not play on the TV.  
Networked PC specifications  
Maximum number of files per shared folder:  
– JPEG = 1,000  
• All JPEG files over the 1,000th in a shared folder  
will not display.  
– MP3 = 200  
• All MP3 files over the 200th in a shared folder  
will not play.  
Maximum number of nested folder levels: 10 levels  
• Files in folders more than 10 levels down from the  
top level folder will not display/play.  
• See Chapter 11, pages 107–112, for details on  
networking your TV and PC for file sharing.  
______________  
The SD logo is a trademark.  
MMC and MultiMediaCard are trademarks of Infineon Technologies AG  
and licensed to MMCA (MultiMediaCard Association).  
Memory Stick is a trademark of Sony Corporation.  
xD-Picture Card is a trademark of Fuji Photo Film Co., Ltd.  
Toshiba is an authorized licensee of the CompactFlash® and CF logo®  
registered trademarks.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
102  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 10: Using the Picture Viewer and Audio Player  
Using the Picture viewer  
You can use the TV’s Picture Viewer to display your digital  
photos (JPEG files) on your TV’s screen in thumbnail mode or  
as a slide show.  
Accessing JPEG files stored on a  
memory card  
Note:  
1. Insert a memory card into the appropriate card slot on the  
side of your TV.  
You cannot use the Picture Viewer and Audio Player at the  
same time.  
Note:  
You must obtain any required permission from  
copyright owners to download or use copyrighted  
content. Toshiba cannot and does not grant such  
permission.  
• If you are using a memory card on which you stored both  
JPEG and MP3 files, the Picture Viewer will start  
automatically when you insert the memory card into the TV.  
Never insert more than one memory card at time.  
Be sure to insert the card correctly—label side facing  
left and the end with the notched corner (if applicable)  
inserted into the memory card slot.  
Accessing JPEG files stored on a  
networked PC  
• When a CompactFlash memory card is inserted correctly, the  
ejector button pops out (see illustration below).  
1. Make sure you have correctly set up your home network  
and file sharing (see page 30 and Chapter 11).  
2. Go to “Viewing JPEG files on the TV” on the next page.  
2. If a memory card is inserted in the TV, you must first close  
the Picture Viewer or Audio Player and then remove the  
memory card or you will not be able to view any JPEG  
files shared over your home network.  
Memory card  
VIDEO-3 IN  
slots  
NOTE: ALWAYS CLOSE THE PICTURE  
VIEWER OR AUDIO PLAYER BEFORE  
REMOVING THE MEMORY CARD.  
Right side  
of TV  
If you remove the memory card while viewing pictures or playing  
audio files, the card and/or saved data may be damaged. THIS  
TYPE OF DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED UNDER YOUR  
TOSHIBA WARRANTY.  
To remove the memory card (if applicable):  
a) Press EXIT to close the Picture Viewer, Audio Player,  
or any other application that may be running.  
CompactFlash  
ejector button  
b) For a CompactFlash memory card, press the ejector  
button and then pull the card straight out from the  
TV.  
For all other memory cards, pull the card straight out  
from the TV.  
or  
or  
3. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
4. Highlight Picture Viewer and press ENTER.  
CompactFlash  
memory card  
xD-Picture Card  
MMC  
(MultiMediaCard)  
5. Go to “Viewing JPEG files on the TV” on the next page.  
or  
Secure Digital  
SD  
Memory Stick  
(Secure Digital)  
memory card  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
103  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 10: Using the Picture Viewer and Audio Player  
Using the Picture viewer (continued)  
Viewing JPEG files on the TV  
1. After accessing your JPEG files from your memory card or  
networked PC (see previous page), the images automatically  
display on-screen, with one as a large picture and six in  
thumbnail format.  
To set the slide show interval:  
1. Press EXIT to close the Picture Viewer (if it is open).  
2. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
3. Highlight Slide Show Interval and press ENTER.  
Picture Viewer  
1
of  
6
May 28 04  
4. Select the interval from the menu sidebar (2, 5, 10, 15, or  
20 seconds).  
2
of  
6
Jan  
8
04  
3
of  
6
Jan 18 04  
4
of  
6
May 12 04  
5
of  
6
Sep 18 03  
Setup  
6
of  
6
Oct 10 10  
Installation  
2 sec  
5 sec  
Rotate  
Next  
Slide Show  
EXIT Exit  
Sleep Timer  
On/Off Timer  
PC Settings  
10 sec  
15 sec  
20 sec  
2. Press x to rotate the large picture 90° counterclockwise.  
HDMI 1 Audio  
HDMI 2 Audio  
Slide Show Interval  
Auto  
Auto  
Picture Viewer  
2 Sec  
1
of  
6
May 28 04  
2
of  
6
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Jan  
8
04  
3
of  
6
Jan 18 04  
4
of  
6
May 12 04  
5
of  
6
To close the Picture Viewer:  
Sep 18 03  
6
of  
6
Oct 10 10  
Press EXIT to close the Picture Viewer and return to the regular  
TV screen.  
Rotate  
Next  
Slide Show  
EXIT Exit  
3. Press to rotate the large picture 90° clockwise.  
Picture Viewer  
To restart the Picture Viewer while the memory  
card is still inserted:  
1
of  
6
May 28 04  
2
of  
6
Jan  
8
04  
3
of  
6
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
2. Highlight Picture Viewer and press ENTER.  
Jan 18 04  
4
of  
6
May 12 04  
5
of  
6
Sep 18 03  
6
of  
6
Oct 10 10  
Rotate  
Next  
Slide Show  
EXIT Exit  
Applications  
4. Press y or z to select another picture as the large picture.  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
Picture Viewer  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
5. Press ENTER to view your pictures in a slide show.  
3. Follow the steps under “Viewing JPEG files on the TV,”  
above.  
To close the Picture Viewer and remove the  
memory card:  
1. Press EXIT to close the Picture Viewer and return to the  
regular TV screen.  
During the slide show:  
To stop on an image during the slide show, press ENTER.  
To resume the slide show, press ENTER again.  
NOTE: ALWAYS CLOSE THE PICTURE  
VIEWER BEFORE REMOVING THE  
MEMORY CARD.  
To rotate the picture, press x or , and then press ENTER.  
To select another image, press y or z, and then press  
ENTER.  
If you remove the memory card while viewing pictures, the card  
and/or saved data may be damaged. THIS TYPE OF DAMAGE  
IS NOT COVERED UNDER YOUR TOSHIBA WARRANTY.  
To stop the slide show and return to the picture viewer,  
press CH RTN.  
2. For a CompactFlash memory card, press the ejector button  
and then pull the card straight out from the TV.  
To stop the slide show and return to the regular TV screen,  
press EXIT.  
For all other memory cards, pull the card straight out from  
the TV.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
104  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 10: Using the Picture Viewer and Audio Player  
Using the Audio Player  
You can use the TV’s Audio Player to listen to MP3 files on  
the TV.  
Accessing MP3 files stored on  
a memory card  
Note:  
Note:  
• Make all desired adjustments to the TV’s audio features  
(e.g., surround, bass, treble, balance) before starting the  
Audio Player.  
Never insert more than one memory card at a time.  
Be sure to insert the card correctly—label side facing  
left and the end with the notched corner (if applicable)  
inserted into the memory card slot.  
You cannot use the Picture Viewer and Audio Player at the  
same time.  
• When a CompactFlash memory card is inserted correctly, the  
ejector button will pop out (see page 103).  
You must obtain any required permission from  
copyright owners to download or use copyrighted  
content. Toshiba cannot and does not grant such  
permission.  
For a memory card that is already inserted  
in the TV:  
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
2. Highlight Audio Player and press ENTER.  
Accessing MP3 files stored on a  
networked PC  
1. Make sure you have correctly set up your home network  
and file sharing (see page 30 and Chapter 11).  
Applications  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
Picture Viewer  
2. If a memory card is inserted in the TV, you must first close  
the Audio Player or Picture Viewer and then remove the  
memory card or you will not be able to play any  
networked MP3 files.  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
3. Go to “Playing MP3 audio files on the TV” on the  
next page.  
NOTE: ALWAYS CLOSE THE PICTURE  
VIEWER OR AUDIO PLAYER BEFORE  
REMOVING THE MEMORY CARD.  
For a memory card that contains both MP3 files  
and JPEG files when no memory card is inserted  
in the TV:  
If you remove the memory card while viewing pictures or playing  
audio files, the card and/or saved data may be damaged. THIS  
TYPE OF DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED UNDER YOUR  
TOSHIBA WARRANTY.  
1. Insert the memory card into the applicable memory card  
slot on the side of your TV (see page 103 for details).  
2. The Picture Viewer will start automatically (by default).  
Press EXIT to close the Picture Viewer.  
To remove the memory card (if applicable):  
a) Press EXIT to close the Audio Player, Picture Viewer,  
or any other application that may be running.  
3. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
4. Highlight Audio Player  
b) For a CompactFlash memory card, press the ejector  
button and then pull the card straight out from  
the TV.  
and press ENTER.  
Applications  
5. Go to “Playing MP3  
TV Guide On Screen  
Audio Player  
audio files on the TV”  
For all other memory cards, pull the card straight out  
from the TV.  
Picture Viewer  
on the next page.  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
CableCARD  
3. Press MENU and open  
For a memory card  
that contains only  
MP3 files  
the Applications menu.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
Applications  
TV Guide On Screen  
4. Highlight Audio Player  
Audio Player  
and press ENTER.  
when no memory card is inserted in the TV:  
Picture Viewer  
Digital CC/Audio Selector  
5. Go to “Playing MP3  
CableCARD  
1. Insert the memory card into the applicable memory card  
slot on the side of your TV (see page 103 for details). The  
Audio Player starts automatically.  
audio files on the TV”  
on the next page.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
2. Go to “Playing MP3 audio files on the TV” on the  
next page.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
105  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 10: Using the Picture Viewer and Audio Player  
Using the Audio Player (continued)  
Playing MP3 audio files on the TV  
1. After accessing your MP3 files from your memory card or  
networked PC (see previous page), the Audio Player will  
begin playing the first MP3 file in the list.  
To close the Audio Player and remove the  
memory card:  
1. Press EXIT to close the Audio Player and return to the  
regular TV screen.  
Audio Player  
Title  
Artist  
Ser No.1 in D, Op.11...  
SCO/Sir Charles...  
Vol  
Requiem, Op. 5: IV. R... Robert Shaw/Atla...  
Rapsodie Espagnole:... Jesus Lopez-Cobo...  
NOTE: ALWAYS CLOSE THE PICTURE  
VIEWER OR AUDIO PLAYER BEFORE  
REMOVING THE MEMORY CARD.  
Moolight Sonata, movement  
A-M Classical  
III. Sanctus: Sanctu...  
Boston Baroque/M...  
Piano Sonata, K. 545... A-M Classical  
Pathétique Sonata, m... A-M Classical  
If you remove the memory card while viewing pictures or playing  
audio files, the card and/or saved data may be damaged. THIS  
TYPE OF DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED UNDER YOUR  
TOSHIBA WARRANTY.  
Chopin Prelude No. ...  
Piano Sonata, K. 545...  
Andrys  
A-M Classical  
A-M Classical  
Moolight Sonata, mo...  
Navigate  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
2. For a CompactFlash memory card, press the ejector button  
and then pull the card straight out from the TV.  
2. Press yz x • to navigate to the rewind, pause, fast  
forward, skip backward, skip forward, volume, and mute  
buttons—or to select another MP3 file—and then press  
ENTER.  
For all other memory cards, pull the card straight out from  
the TV.  
Note: After 30 seconds of inactivity, a screen saver will  
appear. To start the screen saver immediately, press any  
button on the remote control.  
Memory card care and handling  
To use the mute function:  
• Use index labels made exclusively for your specific brand of  
memory card. Do not use commercially sold labels, which  
can cause a malfunction when the card is inserted or  
ejected.  
Press yz x • to select the  
ENTER. See page 90 for details on muting the sound.  
(mute) button, and then press  
To start the MP3 audio player when a memory  
card is already inserted:  
1. Press MENU and open the Applications menu.  
2. Highlight Audio Player and press ENTER.  
• If the image does not appear correctly, or the audio file does  
not play correctly, clean the metallic area of the memory  
card using a soft, dry, lint-free, anti-static cloth, and then  
reinsert the card.  
3. Press yz x • to navigate to the rewind, pause, fast  
forward, skip backward, skip forward, volume, and mute  
buttons, and then press ENTER.  
• Prevent the metallic area on the memory card from coming  
in contact with dust, dirt, or other foreign particles. Do not  
touch the metallic area of the memory card with your hands  
or otherwise handle it with anything other than a soft, dry,  
lint-free, anti-static cloth.  
To close the Audio Player:  
Press EXIT to close the Audio Player and return to the regular  
TV screen.  
Note: Toshiba is not liable for any damage caused  
by the use of any memory card with this TV. Toshiba  
will not compensate for any lost data or recordings  
caused by the use of such cards.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
106  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Using the THINChome network feature  
The Toshiba Home Interactive Network Connection (THINC) feature allows you to connect the TV to your home network,  
11  
which will enable access to the file sharing and e-mail scheduling features.  
File sharing  
You can access JPEG and MP3 files that are stored on your networked home PC and view/play them on the TV.  
Note: Requires a home network* (see page 30). Does NOT require Internet/e-mail service.  
E-mail scheduling of recordings and reminders  
You can schedule recordings and reminders by sending an e-mail to the TV from any PC.  
Note:  
• Requires a compatible recording device (see chapter 2); a home network* (see page 30); and  
home Internet service with a dedicated POP3 e-mail address for the TV (different from your personal e-mail address).  
Contact your Internet Service Provider (ISP) to obtain and set up Internet/e-mail service.  
You will NOT be able to access or browse the Internet through the TV.  
* The THINChome network feature is compatible only with Microsoft® Windows® 2000 and the Home  
and Professional versions of Microsoft® Windows® XP Service Pack 1 and Service Pack 2.  
Follow the steps in sections A through D (below through page 112) to set up and use the TV’s home network features.  
A. Connect the TV to your  
home network  
B. Set up the network address  
To set up the network address:  
1. First, try automatically setting up the network address  
1. Connect the TV to your home network via the TV’s  
RJ-45 (Ethernet) port. See page 30 for connection  
instructions.  
(below).  
2. If the automatic setup is not successful, you can either retry  
the automatic setup (below) or try manually setting up the  
network address (page 108).  
2. If you want to use file sharing only and do not have  
Internet service in your home:  
Skip to section B, “Set up the network address,”  
at right.  
Automatically setting up the  
network address  
Note: If you do not have Internet service, you will not be  
able to use the e-mail scheduling feature.  
1. Press MENU and open  
the Setup menu.  
If you want to use file sharing and e-mail  
scheduling:  
Network  
Basic Network Setup  
2. Highlight Installation  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
and press ENTER. The  
Installation menu  
appears.  
Home File Server Setup  
a) You must have Internet service in your home and a  
dedicated e-mail address for the TV (different from your  
personal e-mail address). Contact your ISP to obtain  
and set up Internet/e-mail service in your home.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
3. Open the Network  
menu.  
b)After you have obtained Internet/e-mail service in your  
home (from your ISP), go to section B, “Set up the  
network address,” at right.  
4. Highlight Basic Network Setup and press ENTER.  
Router technology, like all new and emerging technology, may  
For home networktroubleshooting tips, see Chapter 12.  
from time to time cause compatibility issues because of the differences  
in router systems implemented by the various router manufacturers;  
however, most issues can be easily resolved. If you think your Toshiba  
TV and router might have compatibility problems, please contact  
Toshiba Consumer Solutions by calling 1-800-631-3811 or by visiting  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of television  
programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is prohibited under  
the Copyright Laws of the United States and other countries, and may  
subject you to civil and criminal liability.  
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp  
.
___________  
Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the United States and /or other countries.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
107  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
B. Set up the network address (continued)  
9. If, after repeating steps 1–6, you receive the error  
5. The message “Obtain network address automatically?” will  
display. Highlight Yes and press ENTER.  
message shown in step 8:  
Either…  
Basic Network Setup  
a) Highlight “OK” and press ENTER.  
Obtain network address automatically?  
b) Go to “Manually setting up the network address,”  
Yes  
No  
below.  
6. The message “Please wait…” will display while the TV is  
attempting to load the network address information from  
the DHCP server.  
Or…  
a) Highlight “OK” and press ENTER.  
b) Continue to sections C, D, and E on pages 110–112  
(to set up and use file sharing) and/or to sections F  
and G on pages 113 (to set up and use e-mail  
scheduling).  
Basic Network Setup  
Please wait...  
If the file sharing and/or e-mail scheduling features  
work correctly, then the automatic network address  
setup was successful (even though the TV displayed the  
error message).  
If the automatic network address setup is successful,  
go to step 7.  
If the automatic network address setup is not successful,  
go to step 8.  
If the file sharing and/or e-mail scheduling features  
do not work correctly, go to “Manually setting up the  
network address,” below.  
7. If the automatic network address setup is successful, the  
following screen will appear:  
Basic Network Setup  
Done! Network address information has been found!  
Manually setting up the  
network address  
This setup requires the data listed below. You can get this data  
from either your ISP or the configuration utility for your  
DSL/cable modem or router.  
OK  
a) Press ENTER to close the screen and return to the  
Network menu.  
b) Skip to section C, “Set up file sharing on your PC,”  
on page 110.  
IP address:  
8. If the automatic network address setup is not successful,  
___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___  
Subnet mask:  
the following screen will appear:  
___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___  
Gateway (Router) address:  
___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___  
DNS (Domain Name Server) address:  
a) Make sure all cables for your home network are securely  
connected.  
___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___ . ___ ___ ___  
b) Make sure your home network is set up properly.  
See page 30 for TV connection information.  
Also consult the owner’s manuals for your other  
components.  
c) Make sure the DHCP and security settings on your  
home router are correct. Consult the owner’s manual  
for your router.  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. The Installation  
menu appears.  
3. Open the Network  
Network  
menu.  
Basic Network Setup  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
d) Retry the automatic network address setup by following  
these steps:  
4. Highlight Basic  
Home File Server Setup  
Network Setup and  
press ENTER.  
(1) Highlight OK and press ENTER.  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
(2) Repeat steps 1–6. (If you have already repeated  
this setup process, go to step 9.)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
108  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
B. Set up the network address (continued)  
Resetting the network address  
Manually setting up the network  
address (continued)  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
5. The message “Obtain network address automatically?”  
appears.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. The Installation  
menu appears.  
Highlight No and press ENTER.  
3. Open the Network menu.  
Basic Network Setup  
4. Highlight Basic Network Setup and press ENTER.  
Obtain network address automatically?  
5. The message “Your Basic Network Setup is complete.  
Would you like to start over?” will appear.  
Yes  
No  
To continue, highlight Yes and press ENTER.  
6. The Basic Network Setup menu appears.  
To return to the Network menu, highlight No and press  
ENTER.  
Press y or z to highlight the IP address field, and then use  
the Number buttons on the remote control to input the  
IP address.  
Basic Network Setup  
Please enter your Network Address Information  
IP Address  
Subnet Mask  
Gateway(Router)  
6. If you selected Yes in step 5, the message “Obtain network  
address automatically?” will appear.  
DNS(Domain Name Saver)  
Cancel  
Done  
Basic Network Setup  
7. Press z to highlight the Subnet Mask field, and then use  
Obtain network address automatically?  
the Number buttons to input the Subnet Mask.  
Yes  
No  
8. Press z to highlight the Gateway (Router) field, and then  
use the Number buttons to input the Gateway (Router)  
address.  
To obtain the network address automatically, go to step 5  
under “Automatically setting up the network address” on  
page 108.  
9. Press z to highlight the DNS (Domain Name Server) field,  
and then use the Number buttons to input the Gateway  
(Router) address.  
To manually enter the network address, go to “Manually  
setting up the network address” on page 108.  
10. When finished, highlight Done and press ENTER.  
The Basic Network Setup menu closes and the Network  
menu appears.  
For home networktroubleshooting tips, see Chapter 12.  
11. Go to section C, “Set up file sharing on your PC,”  
on page 110.  
Note:  
• If you used an Ethernet crossover cable to connect your PC directly  
to the TV, you will not be able to use the automatic setup, and  
must manually set up the network address.  
• If you used a hub or switch to connect the TV to your home  
network, you will not be able to use the automatic setup, and must  
manually set up the network address.  
• If you used a router with built-in DHCP functionality, use the  
automatic setup. Manual setup may not work.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
109  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
C. Set up file sharing on your PC  
Compatible operating systems  
The following operating systems are compatible for file sharing  
with the TV:  
• Microsoft® Windows® XP Service Pack 2  
(Home Edition and Professional) [See setup details below]  
2. In the Properties window for the selected folder:  
a) Click to display  
the “Sharing” tab.  
• Microsoft® Windows® XP Service Pack 1  
(Home Edition and Professional) [See setup details below]  
• Microsoft® Windows® 2000 [See setup details on next page]  
b)Click to select  
“Share this folder.”  
No other operating systems are compatible with the TV.  
c) Click “Permissions”  
(which will open  
the Permissions  
window for the  
Note:  
• The name of any directory/folder on your PC that you are  
setting up for file sharing with the TV can have a maximum of  
12 characters and cannot contain any special characters.  
selected folder.  
See “Media specifications” on pages 101–102 for  
details on compatible JPEG and MP3 files.  
Note: If the “Sharing” tab on your specific PC looks like the one illustrated  
below (with no “Permissions” button), follow the steps below. When you  
click “OK,” you are finished setting up file sharing on your PC and can  
proceed to section D.  
To determine which operating system and  
service pack (if applicable) are on your PC:  
1. On your PC, click the “Start” button.  
2. Click “Settings | Control Panel.”  
a) Click to display  
the “Sharing” tab.  
3. In the Control Panel, double-click “System.”  
4. Select the “General” tab, which will display your PC’s  
current operating system and service pack.  
b)Click to select  
“Share this folder  
on the network.”  
c) Click “OK”  
Setting up file sharing on a PC  
with Microsoft® Windows® XP  
Service Pack 1 or Service Pack 2  
1. On your PC:  
(which will close the  
Permissions window  
for the selected folder.  
3. In the Permissions window for the selected folder:  
a) Click “Add...”  
and then select the  
user to be given  
a) Right-click  
the folder  
to be shared.  
sharing privileges.*  
*This user must match  
the user stored in the  
TV’s “Home File Server  
Setup” menu.  
b)Click “Sharing  
and Security...”  
(which will open  
the Properties  
window for the  
selected folder.  
b)Click to check  
“Allow” next to  
“Full Control.”  
c) Click “Apply.”  
d)Click “OK”  
to close the window.  
___________  
Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation in the  
United States and/or other countries.  
Microsoft product screen shot(s) reprinted with permission from Microsoft  
Corporation.  
4. Go to section D, “Set up file sharing on the TV.”  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
110  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
C. Set up file sharing on your PC (continued)  
®
®
Setting up file sharing on a PC with Microsoft Windows 2000  
1. On your PC:  
4. In the Properties window:  
a) Right-click  
the folder  
to be shared.  
b)Click “Sharing...”  
(which will open  
the Properties  
window for the  
selected folder.  
Click “OK”  
(which closes  
the Properties  
window).  
2. In the Properties window for the selected folder:  
5. The shared folder will display with a “shared folder” icon  
(a hand holding a folder).  
a) Click to display  
the “Sharing” tab.  
b)Click to select  
“Share this folder.”  
c) Click “Permissions”  
(which will open  
the Permissions  
window for the  
selected folder).  
3. In the Permissions window for the selected folder:  
6. Go to section D, “Set up file sharing on the TV” on  
page 112.  
a) Click “Add...”  
and then select the  
user to be given  
For home networktroubleshooting tips, see Chapter 12.  
sharing privileges.*  
*This user must match  
the user stored in the  
TV’s “Home File Server  
Setup” menu.  
b)Click to check  
“Allow” next to  
“Full Control.”  
c) Click “Apply.”  
d)Click “OK”  
(which closes the  
Permissions window).  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
111  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
D. Set up file sharing on the TV  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
7. Press yz to highlight either JPEG Picture Directory or  
MP3 Music Directory.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. The Installation  
menu will appear.  
Note: The first time you highlight either of these fields, the  
message “Please Wait...” will appear on-screen until the field is  
populated with the files in your PC’s shared folder(s).  
Open the Network menu.  
Home File Server Setup  
Please Wait...  
Please enter your Home File Server Setup information.  
ABCD  
Home Server Name  
User Name  
Network  
XYZ  
Basic Network Setup  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
Home File Server Setup  
Password  
*****  
JPEG Picture Directory  
MP3 Music Directory  
––  
––  
Cancel  
Done  
Navigate  
CH RTN  
Back  
EXIT Exit  
Select  
8. Press x • to select the shared folder (on your PC) that  
contains the JPEG and/or MP3 files you want to view/play  
on the TV.  
3. Highlight Home File Server Setup and press ENTER. The  
Home File Server Setup window will appear.  
After a few moments, the message “Please Wait...” will  
appear until the network finds your networked PC.  
Note: Make sure you select the correct folder in this step.  
9. To exit the window and save your settings, highlight Done  
and press ENTER.  
The networked PC will act as the “Home Server” for file  
sharing with the TV.  
To exit the window without saving your settings, highlight  
Cancel and press ENTER.  
Home File Server Setup  
Please enter your Home File Server Setup information.  
ABCD  
Home Server Name  
User Name  
XYZ  
Password  
*****  
JPEG Picture Directory  
MP3 Music Directory  
JPEG  
MP3  
E. Viewing/playing shared files  
on the TV  
See Chapter 10, “Using the Picture Viewer and Audio Player,”  
for details on viewing/playing your shared JPEG and MP3 files  
on the TV.  
Cancel  
Done  
4. Press yz to highlight Home Server Name, and then press  
x • to select the name of the PC you set up for file  
sharing.  
If you have multiple PCs on your home network that have  
shared folders, press x • to select the PC (home server)  
from which you want to access files.  
USING THE ON-SCREEN KEYBOARD  
Home File Server Setup  
Please enter your Home File Server Setup information.  
a. Press yzx • to highlight the desired letter, number, or  
ABCD  
Home Server Name  
User Name  
character, and then  
XYZ  
press ENTER.  
Password  
*****  
JPEG Picture Directory  
MP3 Music Directory  
JPEG  
1
q
2
3
e
4
r
5
t
6
y
7
u
8
i
9
o
0
p
-
[
=
]
MP3  
w
b. Repeat step “a” until  
you have finished  
entering all characters  
for the selected field.  
Note:  
a
s
d
f
g
h
j
k
l
;
'
z
x
c
v
b
n
m
,
.
/
Cancel  
Done  
Shift  
Done  
BS  
Cancel  
Clear  
5. a. Press yz to highlight User Name and then press  
ENTER to open the on-screen keyboard for that field.  
To toggle between uppercase and lowercase letters and  
between numbers and symbols, highlight Shift and press  
ENTER.  
To erase the last entered character, highlight BS  
(backspace) and press ENTER.  
b. Enter the User Name for your PC using the on-screen  
keyboard. See “Using the on-screen keyboard,”  
at right.  
Note: The User Name is case sensitive.  
To clear your entered characters, highlight Clear and press  
ENTER.  
c. When finished entering all characters, highlight Done  
and press ENTER.  
c. When you are finished entering all characters for the  
selected field, highlight Done and press ENTER.  
6. Repeat step 5 for the Password field.  
Note: The Password is case sensitive.  
You will return to the previous Setup window.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
112  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
F. Set up e-mail scheduling  
You can remotely schedule and delete recordings and reminders  
via e-mail to the TV from any PC.  
Setting up e-mail scheduling  
1. Press MENU and open the Setup menu.  
Note:  
• If you have not already done so, follow the instructions in  
sections A and B , pages 107–109, before proceeding.  
2. Highlight Installation and press ENTER. The Installation  
menu appears.  
• Before you can schedule recordings, the time and date in the  
TV Guide On Screen feature must be set. See “Setting the  
time and date” on page 55.  
3. Open the Network menu.  
4. Highlight E-mail Scheduling Setup and press ENTER. The  
E-mail Scheduling Setup window opens.  
Required information and services  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
Please enter your E-mail Setup Information.  
E-mail Scheduling  
ID Required  
On  
On  
Before you can set up the e-mail scheduling feature, you must  
have the following information and related services:  
ID  
XXXXXXXXXXXX  
E-mail Address  
Account  
a) A valid POP3 e-mail address dedicated for use by the TV  
only.  
Password  
Incoming Mail Server  
Outgoing Mail Server  
Note: The e-mail address assigned to the TV must be a  
dedicated POP3 address, different from your personal  
e-mail address. Assigning your personal e-mail address  
to the TV will eventually lead to the deletion of all of  
your personal e-mails (including attachments). This is  
NOT covered under the Toshiba warranty.  
E-mail Authorization  
Authorized E-mail  
On  
Enter YOUR E-mail here  
Test  
cancel  
Done  
5. Enter the required data in the fields.  
See “Description of fields in the E-mail Scheduling Setup  
window” on page 115 for details on the settings for these  
fields.  
b) A personal e-mail address (different from the TV’s  
dedicated e-mail address) from which you can send e-mails  
to the TV.  
c) Login and password settings for the TV’s POP3 e-mail  
account.  
d) Name or IP address of the incoming (POP3) mail server.  
e) Name or IP address of the outgoing (SMTP) mail server.  
• For the fields listed below, press y or z to highlight the  
field, and then press x or to select On or Off:  
– E-mail Scheduling  
– ID Required  
– E-mail Authorization  
To obtain the required e-mail services listed above, contact  
your ISP.  
• For the fields listed below, press y or z to highlight the  
To obtain the required addresses and settings listed above,  
either contact your ISP or use the configuration utility for  
your DSL/cable modem or router.  
field, press ENTER to  
E-mail Address  
open the keyboard  
window for the  
selected field, and then  
enter the required  
information using the  
on-screen keyboard:  
1
q
2
3
e
4
r
5
t
6
y
7
u
8
i
9
o
0
p
-
[
=
]
w
Note:  
a
s
d
f
g
h
j
k
l
;
'
z
x
c
v
b
n
m
,
.
/
Toshiba is not responsible for any damage or loss caused  
directly or indirectly by the failure of the e-mail scheduling  
feature to record content intended to be recorded.  
Toshiba is not responsible for, nor has any control over,  
any content recorded and/or viewed using the e-mail  
scheduling feature. Further, the e-mail scheduling feature  
is not meant to be used for unauthorized recording and/or  
viewing of copyrighted works.  
Shift  
Done  
BS  
Cancel  
Clear  
– ID  
– E-mail Address  
– Account  
– Password  
– Incoming Mail Server  
– Outgoing Mail Server  
– Authorized E-mail  
The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision  
of television programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other  
materials is prohibited under the Copyright Laws of the  
United States and other countries, and may subject you  
to civil and criminal liability.  
See “USING THE ON-SCREEN KEYBOARD” on  
page 112 for instructions on entering data in the  
fields using the on-screen keyboard.  
For home networktroubleshooting tips, see Chapter 12.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
113  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
F. Set up e-mail scheduling (continued)  
6. When you are finished entering all characters for the  
selected field, highlight Done and press ENTER.  
If the e-mail test does not pass:  
a. An error message and  
code will appear  
You will return to the  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
Please enter your E-mail Setup Information.  
E-mail Scheduling  
on-screen (similar to  
the example at right).  
E-mail Scheduling  
ID Required  
On  
On  
Setup window.  
ID  
XXXXXXXXXXXX  
E-mail Address  
Account  
Note: The first number in  
7. Highlight Test and  
press ENTER to test  
the e-mail setup.  
the error code denotes an  
Password  
error that occurs when the  
TV is receiving an e-mail;  
the second number denotes an error that occurs when the TV is  
sending an e-mail.  
Incoming Mail Server  
Outgoing Mail Server  
E-mail Authorization  
Authorized E-mail  
On  
During testing, the  
TV will display the  
Enter YOUR E-mail here  
Test  
cancel  
Done  
b. Locate the error code in the “‘TESTING E-MAIL’  
ERROR CODES” table (below) and try the solutions.  
c. Repeat steps 1–8.  
message “Testing E-mail.”  
Note: Depending on your configuration, the e-mail test can  
take several minutes. Do not press EXIT during this time.  
8. When testing is finished, a message will appear indicating  
whether the e-mail test passed or not.  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
9. To exit the E-mail Scheduling Setup window and save your  
settings, highlight Done and press ENTER.  
Please enter your E-mail Setup Information.  
To exit the E-mail Scheduling Setup window without saving  
your settings, highlight Cancel and press ENTER.  
If the e-mail test  
passes:  
E-mail Scheduling  
ID Required  
ID  
On  
On  
XXXXXXXXXXXX  
E-mail Address  
a. The Test Passes”  
message (shown at  
right) will appear.  
Testing E-mail  
A
Test Passes  
P
IMPORTANT NOTE  
I
Outgoing Mail Server  
E-mail Authorization  
Authorized E-mail  
OK  
To use e-mail scheduling, you must first set up the TV Guide  
On Screen® system. E-mail scheduling will not be available unless the  
TV Guide On Screen® system is fully operational. See Chapter 5 for  
details on setting up the TV Guide On Screen system.  
On  
Enter YOUR E-mail here  
cancel Done  
b. Go to step 9.  
Test  
If you experience any issues with e-mail scheduling, please contact  
Toshiba Consumer Solutions by calling 1-800-631-3811 or by visiting  
For home networktroubleshooting tips, see Chapter 12.  
http://www.tacp.com/customersupport/contact.asp  
.
“TESTING E-MAILERROR CODES  
Code Description  
Solutions  
–1 The TV was able to connect to the  
• If you receive the message “Error Sending Mail (–1),” the TV may not have received the test e-mail. Send  
another test e-mail to the TV using the “HELP request e-mail” format (see page 118).  
• Make sure the TV Guide On Screen® system was set up properly. See “IMPORTANT NOTE,” above.  
e-mail server(s) but not log on.  
• Make sure you entered the correct information for the following fields in the TV’s “E-mail Scheduling Setup”  
window (confirm this information with your ISP):  
– “Incoming Mail Server” and “Outgoing Mail Server” names (or IP addresses).  
Account” (user name) and “Password” for the TV’s e-mail account.  
– “E-mail Address” for the TV.  
• Check with your ISP to make sure your TV’s e-mail account has been activated.  
• Check with your ISP to make sure their servers support POP3 and SMTP protocols without secure  
password authentication or secure connections.  
27 The TV could not resolve the e-mail  
• Make sure you entered the correct information for the following fields in the TV’s “E-mail Scheduling Setup”  
window (confirm this information with your ISP):  
server name(s)/address(es).  
– “Incoming Mail Server” and “Outgoing Mail Server” names (or IP addresses).  
– “IP,” “Netmask,” “Gateway,” and “DNS” settings (applicable if you manually set up the network address).  
• Make sure all cables are connected properly and securely.  
• Check your router hardware/settings to make sure your Internet service is currently available (especially  
if the e-mail test takes several minutes to complete).  
30 The e-mail server name(s)/address(es) • Make sure you entered the correct information for the following fields in the TV’s “E-mail Scheduling Setup”  
were resolved but the TV could not  
connect to the server(s).  
window (confirm this information with your ISP):  
– “Incoming Mail Server” and “Outgoing Mail Server” names (or IP addresses).  
– “IP,” “Netmask,” “Gateway,” and “DNS” settings (applicable if you manually set up the network address).  
• Make sure all cables are connected properly and securely.  
• Check your router hardware/settings to make sure your Internet service is currently available.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
114  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
F. Set up e-mail scheduling (continued)  
Description of fields in the “E-mail Scheduling Setup” window  
For instructions on entering data in these fields, see step 5 under “Setting up e-mail scheduling” on page 113.  
E-mail Scheduling Setup  
“E-mail Scheduling” field  
You can select On or Off for the “E-mail Scheduling” field.  
“ID” field  
Please enter your E-mail Setup Information.  
E-mail Scheduling  
On  
On  
Use the on-screen  
keyboard to enter six  
to 16 numbers and/or  
letters to create your  
ID (spaces and  
punctuation are not  
allowed).  
ID Required  
ID  
XXXXXXXXXXXX  
E-mail Address  
Account  
When this field is set to On, it will be possible for the TV  
to receive e-mails from any PC to remotely schedule and  
modify recordings and reminders.  
Password  
Incoming Mail Server  
Outgoing Mail Server  
E-mail Authorization  
Authorized E-mail  
On  
When this field is set to Off, it will not be possible for the  
TV to receive any e-mail, the other fields in this window  
will be disabled (“grayed out”), and it will not be possible to  
remotely schedule recordings or reminders via e-mail.  
Enter YOUR E-mail here  
Test  
cancel  
Done  
Also see the “Security settings” table, below.  
Note:  
Also see the “Security settings” table, below.  
To help protect your privacy, you may want to choose an ID  
that is different from any of your usual passwords or security  
PINs (e.g., different from your personal e-mail password,  
banking login code, social security number, etc.).  
“ID Required” field  
You can select On or Off for the “ID Required” field.  
• The ID is case sensitive.  
When this field is set to On (recommended), you must  
include the ID that you enter in the “ID” field in all e-mails  
you send to the TV. This is a security feature to protect your  
TV from unauthorized e-mail access.  
“E-mail Address” field  
Use the on-screen keyboard to enter the TV’s dedicated e-mail  
address (different from your personal e-mail address). You will  
send e-mails to this address to add, modify, or delete schedules  
and reminders.  
When this field is set to Off, you do not need to include  
the ID in e-mails you send to the TV.  
Also see the “Security settings” table, below.  
Security settings  
(Results of various setting combinations when the “E-mail Scheduling” field is set to ON in the “E-mail Scheduling Setup” window)  
“E-mail  
Scheduling” Authorization”  
“E-mail  
Authorized  
E-mail”  
field  
“ID  
Level of  
security  
Required” “ID”  
field  
Result  
field  
ON  
field  
ON  
field  
High*  
Enter single  
ON  
Enter The TV will only accept e-mails from the one e-mail address  
[default settings]  
(Recommended)  
E-mail address  
ID  
specified in the Authorized E-mail” field that also include the  
“ID” in the body of the e-mail. All other e-mails received by  
the TV (except GET and HELP commands) will be deleted.  
Medium  
Low  
ON  
ON  
ON  
ON  
OFF  
OFF  
Enter single  
E-mail address  
OFF  
ON  
The TV will only accept e-mails from the one e-mail address  
specified in the Authorized E-mail” field. All other e-mails  
received by the TV will be deleted.  
Enter  
ID  
The TV will accept e-mails from any e-mail address that  
includes the “ID” in the body of the e-mail. All other e-mails  
received by the TV will be deleted.  
None  
(Not recommended)  
OFF  
The TV will accept e-mails from any e-mail address (including  
unwanted e-mails, such as spam) and will reply to those  
e-mails with a failure acknowledgment.  
*The “High” settings are the default settings. To help prevent the TV from receiving or sending unwanted e-mails (including e-mails that contain information about  
the programs the TV is set to record), it is recommended that you not change these settings unless you need to diagnose a problem or deal  
with a unique user situation.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
115  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
F. Set up e-mail scheduling (continued)  
Description of fields in the “E-mail Scheduling Setup” window (continued)  
Account” field  
“E-mail Authorization” field  
Use the on-screen keyboard to enter the TV’s e-mail account  
login. Depending on your ISP, this may be the entire e-mail  
address or just the characters in the e-mail address before the  
“@” sign.  
You can select On or Off for the “E-mail Authorization” field.  
When this field is set to On (recommended), the TV will  
only accept e-mails from the e-mail address you specify in  
the “Authorized E-mail” field (e.g., your personal e-mail  
address). The TV will delete any e-mails not sent from this  
authorized e-mail address.  
“Password” field  
Use the on-screen keyboard to enter the password for the TV’s  
e-mail account.  
This is a security feature to protect the TV from  
unauthorized e-mail access and from replying to unwanted  
e-mail, such as spam.  
Note: To help protect your other personal Internet or e-mail accounts,  
create a password that is significantly different from any of your usual  
passwords and security PINs (e.g., different from your e-mail  
password, banking log-ons, social security code etc.).  
When this field is set to Off, it will be possible for the TV  
to accept e-mails from any e-mail address (depending on  
the other settings in the “E-mail Scheduling Setup”  
window).  
Also see the “Security settings” table on page 115.  
“Incoming Mail Server” field  
Use the on-screen keyboard to enter the incoming (POP3)  
mail server that hosts the TV’s e-mail account.  
Authorized E-mail” field  
Enter the single e-mail address that is authorized to send  
e-mails to the TV (e.g., your personal e-mail address).  
Note: The TV does not support encrypted e-mail.  
To enable this field, you must set the “E-mail  
Authorization” field to On.  
“Outgoing Mail Server” field  
Use the on-screen keyboard to enter the outgoing (SMTP)  
mail server associated with the TV’s e-mail account. (The TV  
will use this server for sending reply e-mails to your personal  
e-mail account.)  
– This field can be left blank if you have the “E-mail  
Authorization” field set to Off.  
Also see the “Security settings” table on page 115.  
For home networktroubleshooting tips, see Chapter 12.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
116  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
G. Using e-mail scheduling  
You can use the e-mail scheduling feature to schedule and delete  
recordings and reminders by sending a “request e-mail” to the  
TVs e-mail address from any PC.  
Sending a request e-mail to the TV  
To send a request e-mail to the TV:  
1. Format the e-mail according to the instructions under  
“Formatting a request e-mail” below.  
The four commands the TV will accept are ADD, DELETE,  
GET, and HELP, as described in this section.  
2. Send the e-mail to the TV.  
If you have not already done so, follow the instructions in  
sections A and B , pages 107–109, and in section F, pages  
113–116, before proceeding.  
3. After the TV receives and processes the e-mail, the TV will  
send a reply e-mail to your PC indicating whether the  
e-mailed request succeeded or failed. See “Receiving an  
e-mail from the TV” on page 119.  
When a recording is scheduled via e-mail, the recording device  
used will be the first of the following attached devices found by  
the network (in this order):  
Formatting a request e-mail  
Recognized tags  
1) an AVHD recorder connected to one of the TV’s  
IEEE1394 ports (see page 26); or  
2) a D-VHS recorder connected to one of the TV’s IEEE1394  
ports (see page 26); or  
When you send an ADD, DELETE, GET, or HELP request  
e-mail to the TV, the TV will recognize only the tags listed  
below. These tags (and their accompanying data) must be listed  
in the body of the request e-mail in the following order:  
3) a VCR connected to the TV’s analog A/V OUT terminals  
(see item 4 on page 11 for the location of the A/V OUT  
terminals; see Chapter 2 for various VCR connection  
examples).  
ID* Your ID (required only if you set the “ID Required” field to On*)  
COMMAND ADD —or— DELETE —or— GET —or— HELP  
INPUT ANT-1 —or— ANT-2 —or— CABLE BOX  
CHANNEL Channel number of the recording or reminder  
DATE Date of the recording or reminder  
START TIME Start time of the recording or reminder  
DURATION Length of time of the recording or reminder  
TYPE RECORD —or— REMIND  
E-mail parameters  
• The maximum allowable e-mail size is 16 KB. E-mails over  
16 KB will be automatically deleted.  
• E-mails sent to the TV cannot contain any attachments.  
The TV will automatically delete any e-mail with an  
attached file.  
Tag and data formats  
The data for each tag can be formatted in various ways, as  
described in the following table:  
• E-mails can be formatted either Plain Text or Rich Text  
Format (HTML style).  
• E-mails sent to the TV that are not properly formatted,  
are from the wrong e-mail address, or have the wrong ID  
(if specified) will be deleted.  
Tag formats  
Data formats  
ID*  
[6- to 16-character alphanumeric code]  
MyID1234 … MYID1234 … myid1234  
• All e-mails sent to the TV will be deleted eventually.  
COMMAND  
CMD  
ADD  
DELETE … DEL  
Note:  
Toshiba is not responsible for any damage or loss caused directly  
or indirectly by the failure of the e-mail scheduling feature to record  
content intended to be recorded.  
GET  
HELP  
INPUT  
INP  
ANT1 … ANT-1 … Antenna-1  
ANT2 … ANT-2 … Antenna-2  
CABLE BOX … cablebox … CB  
SET-TOP BOX … settopbox … STB  
Toshiba is not responsible for, nor has any control over, any content  
recorded and/or viewed using the e-mail scheduling feature.  
Further, the e-mail scheduling feature is not meant to be used  
for unauthorized recording and/or viewing of copyrighted works.  
• The unauthorized recording, use, distribution, or revision of  
television programs, videotapes, DVDs, and other materials is  
prohibited under the Copyright Laws of the United States and  
other countries, and may subject you to civil and criminal liability.  
CHANNEL  
CH  
For cable channels: 4 … 38 … 100  
For digital channels, use a hyphen: 5-1 … 102-2  
DATE  
[If the year is not specified, the current year is assumed.]  
7-4 … 7/23 … 7-16-05 … 12/4/05 … 12/19/2005  
START TIME  
START  
8am … 4:45pm … 8:30AM … 9PM  
Noon: 12:00pm … Midnight: 12:00am  
_____________  
*The ID is case sensitive. The ID tag is required only if you created an ID in the  
“ID” field and set the “ID Required” field to On. If you set the “ID Required”  
field to Off, you do not need to include the ID tag line in your request e-mail.  
See “Description of fields in the E-mail Scheduling Setup window” on pages  
115–116.  
DURATION  
DUR  
15m … 15min … 15minutes … 2h … 2hr …  
2h15m … 2hr15min … 2:15  
TYPE  
RECORD … REC … Rec … recording  
REMIND … REM … Rem … reminder  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
117  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
G. Using e-mail scheduling (continued)  
Formatting a request e-mail  
(continued)  
Sample request e-mails  
• The examples shown below are for illustration purposes only.  
• Styles applied to the sample e-mail text (such as bold, italic, and underline) are for illustration purposes only. The text you use in  
your request e-mails does not need to be styled.  
• The only text in a request e-mail that is case sensitve is the ID. All other text is not case sensitive.  
DELETE request e-mail  
ADD request e-mail  
The DELETE request allows you to cancel an existing scheduled  
recording or reminder.  
The ADD request allows you to schedule a new recording or  
reminder.  
The required tags for a DELETE request e-mail are (in this  
order):  
The required tags for an ADD request e-mail are (in this  
order):  
ID [This tag is not required if the “ID Required” field is set to Off ]  
ID [This tag is not required if the “ID Required” field is set to Off ]  
COMMAND DELETE  
INPUT  
COMMAND ADD  
INPUT  
CHANNEL  
DATE  
CHANNEL  
DATE  
START TIME  
DURATION  
TYPE  
START TIME  
DURATION  
TYPE  
Sample DELETE request e-mail  
Sample ADD request e-mail to  
Sample ADD request e-mail to  
Sample DELETE request e-mail  
to delete an existing recording:  
schedule a new recording:  
schedule a new reminder:  
to delete an existing reminder:  
To: [TV’s email address]  
To: [TV’s email address]  
To: [TV’s email address]  
To: [TV’s email address]  
Subject: [this can be left blank]  
Subject: [this can be left blank]  
Subject: [this can be left blank]  
Subject: [this can be left blank]  
ID MYID1234*  
ID MYID1234*  
cmd add  
input cb  
ID MYID1234*  
ID MYID1234*  
cmd del  
COMMAND ADD  
INPUT ANT-1  
COMMAND DELETE  
INPUT ANT-1  
input cb  
CHANNEL 102-1  
DATE 06/10/2005  
START TIME 7 PM  
DURATION 2H15M  
TYPE RECORD  
ch 4  
CHANNEL 102-1  
DATE 06/10/2005  
START TIME 7 PM  
DURATION 2H15M  
TYPE REC  
ch 4  
date 7-4  
date 7-4  
start 8:30pm  
dur 1hr  
start 8:30pm  
dur 1hr  
type remind  
type rem  
GET request e-mail  
HELP request e-mail  
When you send a GET request e-mail to the TV, you will  
receive a reply e-mail that lists all currently scheduled recordings  
and/or reminders.  
When you send a HELP request e-mail to the TV, you will  
receive a reply e-mail that contains helpful information about  
formatting a request e-mail (syntax, definition of the various  
commands, etc.).  
The only required tag and data for a GET request e-mail is  
GET.  
The only required tag and data for a HELP request e-mail is  
Sample GET request e-mail:  
HELP.  
Sample HELP request e-mail:  
To: [TV’s email address]  
To: [TV’s email address]  
Subject: [this can be blank]  
Subject: [this can be blank]  
GET  
HELP  
_______________  
*The ID is case sensitive. The ID tag is required only if you created an ID in the “ID” field and set the “ID Required” field to On. If you set the “ID Required” field to  
Off, you do not need to include the ID tag line in your request e-mail. See “Description of fields in the E-mail Scheduling Setup window” on pages 115–116.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
118  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Chapter 11: Using the THINC™ home network feature  
G. Using e-mail scheduling (continued)  
Receiving an e-mail from the TV  
If the e-mailed request was successful, the reply e-mail from  
the TV to your PC will contain one of the following (or similar)  
messages, depending on the command you sent to the TV:  
Modifying an existing recording  
or reminder  
If you want to modify an existing scheduled recording or  
reminder:  
• ADD SUCCESS  
• DELETE SUCCESS  
• GET SUCCESS  
• HELP SUCCESS  
1. Send a DELETE request e-mail to cancel the existing  
recording or reminder.  
2 Send an ADD request e-mail to schedule the modified  
recording or reminder.  
If the e-mailed request was not successful, the reply e-mail  
from the TV to your PC will contain one of the following  
(or similar) messages, depending on the command you sent  
to the TV:  
For home networktroubleshooting tips, see Chapter 12.  
• FAILED – SCHEDULE CONFLICT  
The new recording or reminder you attempted to schedule  
conflicts with an existing one that was previously  
scheduled.  
If you want to schedule the new recording or reminder, you  
will have to DELETE the existing one first, and then ADD  
the new one.  
• FAILED – COULD NOT UNDERSTAND “Line x”  
The e-mailed request has an error in the line of text  
referenced in the error message. Correct the text and  
resend the e-mail.  
• FAILED – NO DEVICE AVAILABLE  
Make sure you have a recording device connected to the  
TV and that all cables are properly connected.  
• FAILED – MISC ERROR  
Make sure all devices and cables are properly connected  
and that the text in the body of your e-mail is correct, and  
then send the corrected e-mail to the TV.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
119  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 42/50HPX95 *web 213:276  
Troubleshooting  
12  
General troubleshooting  
Before calling a service technician, please check this entire chapter for a possible cause of the problem and some solutions you can try.  
Black box on screen  
• The Closed Caption feature is set to one of the Text modes (T2, T2, T3, or T4). Set the Closed Caption feature to “Off” (page 88).  
TV stops responding to controls  
• If the TV stops responding to the controls on the remote control or TV front panel and you cannot turn off the TV, press and hold the  
POWER button on the TV front panel for 5 or more seconds to reset the TV.  
Other problems  
• If your TV’s problem is not addressed in this Troubleshooting section or the recommended solution has not worked, use the Restore  
Factory Defaults procedure as described on page 57.  
TV will not turn on  
• Make sure the power cord is plugged in, and then press POWER.  
• The remote control batteries may be dead. Replace the batteries or try the front panel buttons.  
• If you have recently replaced the lamp unit, make sure the lamp unit and lamp unit door are installed properly (See “Lamp unit  
replacement and care” in Chapter 13).  
• The lamp unit may need to be replaced (pages 129–131). Also see “LED indications” on page 125.  
• If the TV is powered off and then quickly on again when the lamp unit is hot, it may take several minutes for the picture to appear  
on-screen. This is a property of DLP TV lamp technology and is NOT a sign of malfunction. For details, see “IMPORTANT NOTICE ABOUT  
HOT LAMP RESTART” on page 5.  
Picture problems  
General picture problems  
• Check the antenna/cable connections (Chapter 2).  
• Press INPUT on the remote control or TV/VIDEO on the TV front panel and select a valid video input source (page 72). If no device is  
connected to any of the inputs on the TV, no picture will display when you select that particular input source. For device connection  
details, see Chapter 2.  
• Antenna reception may be poor. Use a highly directional outdoor antenna (if applicable).  
• The station may have broadcast difficulties. Try another channel.  
• Adjust the picture qualities (page 84).  
• If you are using a VCR, make sure the TV/VCR button on the remote control is set correctly (page 32).  
• If you have two VCRs connected to your TV, make sure you have not connected the same VCR to the TV’s output and input connections  
at the same time (page 20).  
• Do not connect both a standard video cable and an S-video cable to the same set of VIDEO inputs (VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, or VIDEO 3) at  
the same time (Chapter 2).  
Noisy picture  
• If you are watching a tuned analog channel (off-air broadcast or Cable TV), set the CableClear®/DNR feature to AUTO to reduce visible  
interference in the TV picture (page 86).  
Video Input Selection problems  
• If the Input Selection window does not appear when you press INPUT on the remote control or TV/VIDEO on the TV front panel, press  
INPUT or TV/VIDEO a second time, which will change to the next video input source and display the Input Selection window.  
Cannot view external signals or channel 3 or 4  
• If you cannot view signals from external devices connected to VIDEO 1, VIDEO 2, VIDEO 3, or ColorStream,® or from channels 3 or 4,  
make sure the Input Lock is set to Off (page 99).  
Poor color or no color  
• The station may have broadcast difficulties. Try another channel.  
• Adjust the Tint and/or Color (page 84).  
• When the ColorStream® signal source is active, the VIDEO OUT terminal outputs blank video. To receive video from the VIDEO OUT  
signal, a standard video or S-video IN terminal must be used instead of the ColorStream® connections.  
POP problems  
• If the POP double-window is open and you start recording, the POP window will close.  
• The VIDEO OUT terminal will not output the POP picture when the POP window is open (pages 20 and 81).  
• If you label all of the inputs as “Hide,” the POP feature will be disabled. If you then attempt to access the POP feature, the message “NOT  
AVAILABLE” will appear on-screen (page 81).  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
120  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
General troubleshooting (continued)  
Picture problems (continued)  
Picture brightness changes soon after turning on TV  
• If you set the lamp mode to Low Power, each time you turn on the TV, the lamp will start out in High Bright mode but will switch to Low  
Power mode in approximately 1 minute. You will notice a change in screen brightness when this happens. This is normal and is not a sign  
of malfunction. (See page 80.)  
Poor composite or S-video picture  
• If the TV is connected to an external A/V device (e.g., DVD player, video game system, set-top box, etc.) try using a ColorStream or  
HDMI video connection instead.  
Picture and sound are out of sync  
• As with all products that contain a digital display, in rare instances, when viewing certain content (e.g.. television broadcasts, video  
games, DVDs), you may notice that the sound and picture are slightly out of sync. This phenomenon can be caused by various factors  
including, without limitation, video processing within the TV, video processing in an attached gaming system, and video processing or  
different compression rates used by broadcasters in their programming. You may want to try one or more of the following suggestions,  
which may help to reduce the effect of this phenomenon:  
- If the TV is connected to an A/V receiver that has a programmable audio delay feature, use this feature to help synchronize the  
sound to the picture.  
- If you notice this phenomenon only on certain TV channels, please contact your local broadcast, cable, or satellite provider to inform  
them of this issue.  
“Now Booting” message appears on-screen  
• If you unplug the power cord, when you plug the power cord in again the message “Now Booting...” will display on-screen until the  
picture appears, or the green LED will blink until the TV enters standby mode. This is normal and is not a sign of malfunction.  
Sound problems  
• Check the antenna/cable connections (see Chapter 2).  
• The station may have broadcast difficulties. Try another channel.  
• The sound may be muted. Press VOLUME.  
• If you hear no sound, try setting the MTS feature to stereo mode (page 90).  
• Make sure the Speakers function in the Audio Setup menu is set correctly (page 93).  
• If you are not receiving a second audio program from a known SAP source, make sure the MTS feature is set to SAP mode (page 90).  
• If you hear audio that seems “incorrect” for the program you are watching (such as music or a foreign language), the SAP mode may be  
on. Set the MTS feature to stereo mode (page 90).  
• When using an external audio amplifier, if you connect the amplifier to the VAR. AUDIO OUT terminals on the TV, the volume of the TV  
and amplifier must be set above 0 or you will not hear any sound (page 24).  
Remote control problems  
• Make sure the remote control is set to the correct device mode (page 33).  
• Remove all obstructions between the remote control and the TV.  
• The remote control batteries may be dead. Replace the batteries (page 33).  
Your TV remote control may not operate certain features on your external device. Refer to the owner’s manual for your other device to  
determine its available features. If your TV remote control does not operate a specific feature on another device, use the remote control  
that came with the device (page 33).  
• If the TV still does not act as expected, use the Restore Factory Defaults procedure as described on page 57.  
Channel tuning problems  
• Make sure the remote control is set to the correct device mode (page 33).  
• The channel may have been erased from the channel memory by the Channel Add/Delete feature. Add the channel to the channel  
memory (page 48).  
• The channel may be blocked by the Channels Block feature. Unblock the channel (page 99).  
• If you are unable to tune digital channels, check the antenna configuration (page 46). If you are still unable to tune digital channels, clear  
all channels from the channel list (page 48) and reprogram channels into the channel memory (page 47). If you are still unable to tune  
digital channels, use the Restore Factory Defaults procedure as described on page 57. Also see “TV stops responding to controls” and  
“Other problems” on page 123.  
(Continued on next page)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
121  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
General troubleshooting (continued)  
Closed caption problems  
• If the program or video you selected is not closed-captioned, no captions will display on-screen (page 88).  
• If text is not available, a black rectangle may appear on-screen. If this happens, turn off the closed caption feature (page 88).  
• A closed caption signal may not display correctly in the following situations: a) when a videotape has been dubbed; b) when the signal  
reception is weak; or c) when the signal reception is nonstandard (page 88).  
Rating blocking (V-Chip) problems  
• If you forget your PIN code: While the PIN code entering screen is displayed, press RECALL four times within 5 seconds. The PIN code  
you previously stored will be cleared (page 97).  
• The V-Chip feature is available for the U.S. V-Chip system only (page 98).  
Recording problems  
• If you use the TV’s remote control to start recording, you will not be able to change inputs (page 72), open the POP window (page 81),  
or open the FAV SCAN multi-window (page 83). If you attempt to do so, the message “Not Available While Recording” will appear  
on-screen.  
• If you are recording a digital channel, you can only change analog channels while recording is in progress. If you are recording an analog  
channel, you can only change digital channels while recording is in progress. This is because the TV tuner that is being recorded (digital  
or analog) will be locked on the channel that is currently recording.  
• It is recommended that you use the TV’s remote control to start recording. If you use a device other than the TV’s remote control to start  
recording and then attempt to access a feature that is normally denied during recording (POP mode, FAV SCAN mode, changing inputs),  
the recorded audio and/or video may not be what you intended to record. See pages 72 and 76.  
• If you connected a Symbio™ AVHD recorder, in order to use its full functionality you must first set up the TV Guide On Screen® system  
(page 26 and Chapter 5).  
Memory card problems  
• Make sure you are using a supported or valid memory card format (page 102).  
• Make sure you have saved your files in the correct file format (page 102).  
• The memory card may be inserted improperly. Remove the card and reinsert it (page 103).  
• The memory card may be empty.  
• The memory card may be damaged.  
Audio Player problems  
The Audio Player stutters and/or stops when playing files over the network  
• The networked PC is not available, was removed from the network, or is in “hibernation.”  
• The Ethernet cables are not connected properly. Check all cables for proper connection.  
• Sufficient network band-width is not available. Turn off any other file sharing programs, network-based games, or other network-intensive  
operations while the Audio Player is playing.  
“No media found” message is displayed  
• The memory card is not inserted properly or at all, or does not contain valid MP3 files.  
• Sharing is not correctly set up on the networked PC. Make sure you connected your home network correctly (page 30) and set up the  
network address properly (Chapter 11).  
• The memory card or the shared folder(s) on your networked PC do not contain any files with “.mp3” extension.  
• The MP3 files exceed the specified limits (see “Media specifications” in Chapter 10).  
Title or artist name is not displayed  
• The MP3 file does not contain valid meta-data or does not meet supported specifications (see “Media specifications” in Chapter 10).  
The Audio Player takes almost a minute to start  
• Sufficient network band-width is not available. Turn off any other file sharing programs, network-based games, or other network-intensive  
operations while the Audio Player is playing.  
• The memory card or shared folder has too many files or sub-folders. If the memory card or shared folder on the networked PC contains  
a large number of files or nested directories, it may take over a minute for the Audio Player to locate all playable files.  
The file is displayed but is always skipped  
• The file is not a valid or supported MP3 file.  
Some files on the memory card or in the shared folder are not played  
• Only the first 200 MP3 files found will be played. Folders nested 10 or more levels below the shared folder are not searched.  
The Audio Player plays (the progress bar and animation change) but audio is not heard  
• The volume level is not high enough or the TV is muted.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
122  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
General troubleshooting (continued)  
Picture Viewer problems  
“No pictures found” message is displayed.  
• The memory card is not inserted properly or at all, or does not contain valid JPEG files.  
• Sharing is not correctly set up on the networked PC. Make sure you connected your home network correctly (page 30) and set up the  
network address properly (Chapter 11).  
• The memory card or the shared folder(s) on your networked PC do not contain any files with “.jpg” extension.  
• The JPEG files exceed the specified limits (see “Media specifications” in Chapter 10).  
Picture Viewer option in menu is disabled.  
• There are no picture files on the memory card or in the networked PC’s shared folder(s).  
• The memory card does not contain any valid JPEG files.  
• The memory card is not inserted properly or at all.  
• Basic network setup and Home server setup were not successfully performed.  
Picture is not displayed. Rectangle containing “X” is displayed instead.  
• The picture file does not meet the specifications for the Picture Viewer (see “Media specifications” in Chapter 10).  
Picture is not listed at all.  
• There are no picture files on the memory card or in the networked PC’s shared folder(s).  
• The number of pictures files found is more than the TV can display.  
• The picture file does not have a valid “.jpg” extension.  
• The file is too large or is otherwise not compatible with the TV for display. See “Media specifications” in Chapter 10 for Picture Viewer and  
JPEG file specifications.  
Home network troubleshooting  
Basic network setup problems  
Cannot connect to network  
• Check the modem and splitter connections.  
• Make sure the splitter is connected to the modem or TEL correctly (page 30).  
• Confirm your modem’s operation with this manual.  
• Make sure your network address and e-mail account are set up correctly (Chapter 11).  
No network connection  
• The Ethernet cables are not connected properly or at all. Connect all cables as shown on page 30.  
• Make sure the modem’s power cord is plugged in.  
• Make sure your network address and e-mail account are set up correctly (Chapter 11).  
Automatic setup fails  
• The Ethernet cables are not connected properly or at all. Connect all cables as shown on page 30.  
• The DHCP service is not enabled on the router, or no router is present. Refer to your router’s documentation for instructions on enabling  
DHCP. If you do not have a router, you must manually set up the network address (page108).  
• Internet service is not available. Check your cable/DSL modem or contact your ISP for Internet service issues.  
Manual setup fails  
• The Ethernet cables are not connected properly or at all. Connect all cables as shown on page 30.  
• The TV IP address is the same as the networked PC’s. The TV IP address must be different from the PC’s IP address.  
• The TV IP address is not on the same subnet as the networked PC’s. For example, if the PC has IP 192.168.0.100 with netmask  
255.255.255.0, and the TV has IP 192.168.0.200 with netmask 255.255.255.0, then they are both on same subnet. Conversely, if the PC  
has IP 192.168.1.100 with netmask 255.255.255.0, and the TV has IP 192.168.0.200 with netmask 255.255.255.0, then they are on  
DIFFERENT sub-nets.  
Unstable network connection  
• Unplug the Ethernet cables, and then connect them again.  
(Continued on next page)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
123  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
Home network troubleshooting (continued)  
Home network setup problems  
The PC (“Home Server”) name is not displayed  
• The Ethernet cables are not connected properly or at all. Connect all cables as shown on page 30.  
• The network setup on the PC is incorrect. Make sure both the PC and TV are using the same network type (DHCP/manual) and have  
compatible network settings.  
• The networked PC does not have shared folders set up correctly. See “Set up file sharing on your PC” in Chapter 11 for details.  
• There are no master browsers on the network. To configure your networked PC to be the master browser of its subnet, refer to your  
operating system user guide or consult an IT professional.  
Too many sharing devices are connected. You cannot connect more than 16 sharing devices at one time.  
The PC (“Home Server”) name is displayed but the shared folder(s) are not displayed.  
• The networked PC does not have shared folders set up correctly. See “Set up file sharing on your PC” in Chapter 11 for details.  
• The TV’s user name and password do not match the PC’s. Make sure the user name and password settings in the TV exactly match the  
settings in the networked PC. User names and passwords are generally case sensitive.  
E-mail scheduling problems  
Cannot schedule a recording by e-mail  
• Select “Test” to confirm the e-mail scheduling setup ( page 114).  
• Select “Done” after setting up e-mail scheduling ( page 114).  
• See Chapter 11 in this manual.  
E-mail test fails after waiting a long time  
• The Ethernet cables are not connected properly or at all. Connect all cables as shown on page 30.  
• The DNS (domain name server) is not set up correctly. Check the network settings.  
• The SMTP and POP3 server settings are incorrect.  
• The “E-mail Address,” Account,” or “Password” settings are incorrect. User names and passwords are generally case sensitive.  
Receiving succeeds but sending fails, or vice-versa  
• The SMTP and POP3 server settings are incorrect.  
• The “E-mail Address,” Account,” or “Password” settings are incorrect. User names and passwords are generally case sensitive.  
Your Internet service provider may not support SMTP or POP3 protocols. Check with your ISP for details on supported protocols.  
The e-mail test passes, but the TV never responds to the e-mails  
• E-mail scheduling is turned OFF. Turn e-mail scheduling ON (page 113).  
• The sender’s e-mail address is not the Authorized E-mail Address.” Make sure the e-mail address you are using to send e-mails to the TV  
is the same as the Authorized E-mail Address” in the TV’s e-mail scheduling setup. See “Set up e-mail scheduling” in Chapter 11.  
Note: Responses from the TV can often be delayed a few mintues, depending on  
e-mail/Internet service availability when you send the request e-mail.  
An ADD or DELETE request e-mail returns an “INVALID MAIL VERIFICATION ID” reply  
• The e-mail authorization ID is not specified or is different from the TV settings. See “Set up e-mail scheduling” in Chapter 11.  
The e-mail was successfully sent but the recording or reminder did not work.  
• The time and date in the TV Guide On Screen® system are not set. See “Setting the time and date” on page 55.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
124  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
LED indications  
The green and red LED lights on the TV front touchpad (to the left of the POWER button) indicate the TV’s status, as described below:  
• Red ON (solid) and Green OFF = The TV power cord is plugged in.  
• Green ON (solid) and Red OFF = A recording is in progress while the TV is OFF.  
• Red ON (solid) and Green ON (solid) = A recording is in progress while the TV is ON.  
• Green and/or Red blinking (see table below).  
Note: If the TV loses A/C power (e.g., a power outage occurs or the power cord is unplugged), when power is restored, the green LED will blink  
while the TV is booting until the remote control is usable. This is normal and is not a sign of malfunction.  
TV/VIDEO  
EXIT  
CHANNEL  
VOLUME  
MENU  
POWER  
TV front touchpad  
Red LED  
Green LED  
LED Indication  
Condition  
Solution  
1) Green blinks continuously The lamp unit door is not seated  
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Review “Lamp unit  
replacement and care” in Chapter 13 to ensure that the lamp door  
is installed securely. If the problem persists, contact a Toshiba  
Authorized Service Center.  
at 3-second intervals.  
Red blinks continuously  
at 0.5-second intervals.  
properly.  
2) Green blinks continuously The lamp is not working properly. The TV will automatically try to restart itself eight times (see  
at 0.5-second intervals;  
item #3).  
Red is ON (solid).  
Note: If the TV is powered off and then quickly on again when the lamp unit  
is hot, it may take several minutes for the picture to appear on-screen. This is  
a property of DLP TV lamp technology and is NOT a sign of malfunction. For  
details, see Setting the Quick Restart® featureand IMPORTANT NOTICE  
ABOUT HOT LAMP RESTARTon page 56.  
3) Green and Red blink  
continuously at  
The lamp is not working properly  
after the eighth automatic restart  
(see item #2).  
Turn the TV OFF and then ON again. If the problem persists, replace  
the lamp unit (see Chapter 13). If the problem still persists, contact a  
Toshiba Authorized Service Center.  
1-second intervals.  
4) Green is OFF;  
Red blinks at 0.2-second  
intervals 4 times (repeats).  
Turn OFF the TV. Check to make sure all slots and openings in the  
TV cabinet are not covered, blocked, or dusty. Turn ON the TV  
again. If the problem persists, contact a Toshiba Authorized Service  
Center.  
An abnormal temperature  
increase has occurred.  
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Plug the power cord  
in again and turn ON the TV. If the problem persists, contact a  
Toshiba Authorized Service Center.  
5) Green is OFF;  
Red blinks continuously  
at 0.5-second intervals.  
Abnormal operation  
(including cooling fan stop).  
6) Green is OFF;  
Red blinks continuously  
at 1-second intervals.  
Abnormal operation of BUS line.  
The color wheel has stopped.  
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Plug the power cord  
in again and turn ON the TV. If the problem persists, contact a  
Toshiba Authorized Service Center.  
7) Green is OFF;  
Red blinks at 0.2-second  
intervals 3 times (repeats).  
Turn OFF the TV and unplug the power cord. Plug the power cord  
in again and turn ON the TV. If the problem persists, contact a  
Toshiba Authorized Service Center.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
125  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
TV Guide On Screen® FAQ  
The following are frequently asked questions about the TV Guide On Screen® system. The answers represent the most likely solutions  
to the problem.  
After you set up the TV Guide On Screen® system (Chapter 5), the  
program guide opens automatically by default when you turn on  
the TV. You can turn off the automatic program guide (see page 45)  
and instead press the TV GUIDE button on the remote control to  
manually open the TV Guide On Screen® program guide.  
7. Q: I had a power outage. Do I need to go through initial  
setup of the TV Guide On Screen® system again?  
A: No. The information you entered is stored in the TV Guide  
On Screen® system memory.  
Note: For Cable box users, the TV must be OFF and the Cable  
box must be left ON for the TV Guide On Screen® system to  
receive channel line-up information.  
SETUP  
1. Q: What if I move and my ZIP code or postal code  
8. Q: How do I connect the G-LINK® (IR blaster) cable to  
changes?  
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight  
Change System Settings (page 70), and then press ENTER.  
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new information  
(see Chapter 5 for details). It can take up to 24 hours to  
receive new data.  
the G-LINK® input on the TV?  
A: See Chapter 2: Connecting your TV in this manual.  
You also can refer to the TV Guide On Screen® prompts  
during VCR or Cable box setup.  
9. Q: When will I be able to view my TV program listings and  
2. Q: What if I change my cable hook-up to antenna or vice  
use other TV Guide On Screen® system features?  
versa?  
A: You will be able to use initial program listings within 24  
hours of initial setup. It may take up to one week to receive  
the full eight days of program listings.  
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight  
Change System Settings (page 70), and then press ENTER.  
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new input  
information and rescan channels for the new input (see  
Chapter 5 for details). It can take up to 24 hours to receive  
new data.  
10. Q: What should I do if I cannot complete initial setup?  
A: If you are unable to complete initial setup using the owner’s  
manual and the on-screen prompts, please call Toshiba’s  
National Service Division at 1-800-631-3811.  
3. Q: What if I change cable boxes?  
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight  
Change System Settings (page 70), and then press ENTER.  
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new input  
information and rescan channels for the new input (see  
Chapter 5 for details). It can take up to 24 hours to receive  
new data.  
11. Q: If I make a mistake during setup, how do I go back to  
the previous step?  
A: Complete the remaining setup steps. When “Confirming  
Your Settings” appears, select “No, repeat setup process.”  
Follow the on-screen prompts and input the correct  
information.  
4. Q: I used to have a cable box, but now I get direct cable.  
What do I do?  
12. Q: What if the channel number is not visible on my cable  
box?  
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight  
Change System Settings (page 70), and then press ENTER.  
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new input  
information and rescan channels for the new input (see  
Chapter 5 for details). It can take up to 24 hours to receive  
new data.  
A: Your cable box may be defaulting to a clock or time display  
once the channel changes. Watch the box carefully when  
testing the cable box brand code to see if the channel  
changes to 09.  
13. Q: Why wont my VCR turn on?  
5. Q: If I add a recorder or change my cable service, how do I  
A: There are several possibilities:  
change my Setup information?  
a) An incorrect or “no VCR” code was entered during the  
TV Guide On Screen® initial setup. Press the TV GUIDE  
button on the remote control, and then press to  
highlight SETUP. Press z to highlight “Change system  
settings,” and then press ENTER. Follow the on-screen  
prompts to select the correct VCR information.  
A: Highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z to highlight  
Change System Settings (page 70), and then press ENTER.  
Follow the on-screen prompts to enter new information  
(see Chapter 5 for details). It can take up to 24 hours to  
receive new data.  
6. Q: Why does it take up to 24 hours for the TV Guide  
b) Make sure the G-LINK® (IR blaster) cable is connected  
correctly (see page 28).  
On Screen® system to be ready for use?  
A: The initial setup process consists of finding the stations in  
your area that carry the TV Guide On Screen® system data  
and tuning to those stations to receive the setup and  
listings data.  
c) The VCR record timer is on. Turn off the timer.  
d) The wired remote VCR is incompatible.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
126  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
TV Guide On Screen® FAQ (continued)  
20. Q: After some show titles, I have noticed from 1 to 4 stars  
CHANNEL LINEUPS & LISTINGS  
14. Q: Why arent all my channels initially displayed?  
(****). What does that mean?  
A: These stars are a broadcast-industry ratings system used to  
inform you of a show’s quality. The more stars, the better  
the rating.  
A: After initial setup, approximately 120 channels are  
automatically displayed. The user may use the “Change  
channel display” feature to turn additional channels ON  
or OFF.  
21. Q: What do the colors for shows in the Listings and Search  
Note: Even though you have the option of enabling many  
more channels, the system may not have the memory capacity  
to hold detailed program descriptions for all of them.  
screens indicate?  
A: Green = Sports; Dark Blue = Children’s; Purple = Movies;  
Teal = Other Show.  
15. Q: When I opened the TV Guide On Screen® system, I was  
asked to choose from more than one channel lineup.  
What should I do?  
22. Q: How do I add, delete, or change the assigned number of  
channels on the TV Guide On Screen® system?  
A: Select the lineup that most closely matches the one for your  
area. If after you choose the lineup, you want to make  
changes to it, highlight Setup in the Service Bar. Press z  
to select Change Channel Display. Follow the on-screen  
instructions.  
A: See “Change channel display” on page 70.  
23. Q: Why are some of my channels listed on the wrong  
number?  
A: There are several possibilities (see page 70 for details):  
16. Q: Why do all my channels display No Listing?”  
a) An incorrect channel lineup was selected. Access “Change  
system settings” and choose “Yes, but my channel lineup is  
incorrect,” and then reselect the correct lineup.  
A: The TV Guide On Screen® system has not yet received its  
data download. The phrase “No Listing” will be replaced  
with program information during the next download cycle,  
which will occur within the next 24-hour period.  
b) Channel lineup changes have not yet been processed. Use  
the “Change channel display” feature to make adjustments.  
17. Q: Why do some of my channels display No Listing?”  
c) An incorrect ZIP/postal code (or other incorrect data) was  
entered during initial setup. Redo the initial setup.  
A: There are several possibilities:  
a) The channels in question were recently turned ON (in  
the Change Channel Display feature; see page 70) but the  
TV Guide On Screen® system has not received its next  
data download.  
24. Q: Why doesnt the highlighted program match up with  
the video window on my TV screen?  
A: There are several possibilities (see page 70 for details):  
b) After completing the initial setup, the first data download  
of the day was interrupted by a VCR recording.  
c) The TV power cord was left unplugged for an extended  
period of time and the TV Guide On Screen® system was  
unable to receive program listings during the scheduled  
download cycle.  
d) Poor reception caused some of the data to be missed.  
e) The cable box was turned OFF. The TV power cord must  
be plugged in and the cable box must be ON.  
a) The station in question made a late change to its scheduled  
program listing and the TV Guide On Screen® system has  
not yet been updated.  
b) The TV is receiving broadcasts through a modified or  
boosted antenna system or a satellite dish (not supported  
by the TV Guide On Screen® system).  
c) An incorrect ZIP/postal code (or other incorrect data) was  
entered during initial setup. Redo the initial setup.  
d) An incorrect channel lineup was selected. Access “Change  
system settings” and choose “Yes, but my channel lineup  
is incorrect,” and then reselect the correct lineup (see page  
70 for details).  
g) A/V Cable: The VCR was turned OFF. If the connection  
includes stereo cables with cable box to VCR and stereo  
connection from VCR to television, the VCR must be ON.  
18. Q: A show entry in the TV Guide On Screen® system reads  
e) The video window may be locked. Press SPLIT to unlock.  
No Listing.What does that mean?  
25. Q: Can I move my favorite stations to the top of the  
A: Show information for that entry was not available during  
the last TV Guide On Screen® system data download.  
Show information is updated on a daily basis.  
TV Guide On Screen® display screen?  
A: Yes. Use the “Change channel display” feature to make  
adjustments (see page 70). Highlight the station call letters  
to be moved, then use the up/down arrows and/or Number  
buttons to reassign the position of the station.  
19. Q: I have seen the word downloadin reference to the TV  
Guide On Screen system. What does that mean?  
A: “Download” refers to the times throughout the day when  
the TV Guide On Screen® system in your TV is receiving  
channel and listings information from your Cable or over-  
the-air antenna transmission.  
(Continued on next page)  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
127  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 12: Troubleshooting  
TV Guide On Screen® FAQ (continued)  
32. Q: Is Help available in the TV Guide On Screen® system?  
OPERATIONS  
If so, how do I find it?  
26. Q: How can I look for a specific show in the TV Guide  
A: Yes. Highlight any of the five main Services (Listings,  
Schedule, Recordings, Setup, Search) and press the INFO  
key on the remote control. An expanded Info Box displays  
additional help information. Press INFO again to close  
the box.  
On Screen® system?  
A: SEARCH lets you find shows by keyword, alphabetically,  
or by category (HDTV, Movies, Sports, Children,  
Educational, News, Variety, Series).  
Help is also available in a panel menu. Press INFO to  
display an expanded Info Box. Press INFO again to close  
the box.  
27. Q: My cable box will not change channels with the  
TV Guide On Screen® system. Whats wrong?  
A: There are several possibilities:  
RECORD/REMIND  
33. Q: Can I tune to a different channel while recording a  
a) The incorrect cable box code was entered during TV Guide  
On Screen® initial setup. Redo initial setup.  
b) The G-LINK® (IR blaster) cable may not be connected  
properly (see page 28).  
program?  
A: No.  
c) The cable box has no remote capability and is  
incompatible.  
34. Q: How many programs can be scheduled for RECORD in  
the GUIDE?  
A: There is no limit to the number of shows that can be  
programmed into the schedule memory.  
28. Q: How do I resize or close the Info window?  
A: Press the INFO button on the remote control to resize the  
Info window. Press the INFO button again to close the  
Info window.  
35. Q: If a program is scheduled to RECORD on a Regular  
basis, does it count as five?  
A: No, whether a program is scheduled ONCE,  
REGULARLY, or WEEKLY, it only counts as one show in  
the RECORD stack memory.  
29. Q: Is there a way to go directly to the next days listings  
without scrolling through each time slot?  
A: Yes. In LISTINGS, highlight the station for which you  
want to look ahead and use the Channel Number buttons  
on the remote control to enter “24.” In the resulting menu,  
press z two times to scroll down to select the HOURS  
AHEAD option, and then press ENTER. You also can use  
the SKIP button on the remote control.  
36. Q: If I have a power failure, will I need to reset the  
recorded shows I have already programmed?  
A: The start times and channel numbers of shows that have  
been programmed will be retained in the memory of the  
TV Guide On Screen® system. Titles will appear once  
listings are restored.  
30. Q: Why cant I record a show? All I get is snow or a blue  
screen.  
37. Q: Can I set a Record or Remind event without  
highlighting a show title in the TV Guide On Screen®  
system?  
A: There are several possibilities (without a cable box):  
a) The recording unit was not connected or set up correctly.  
A: Yes. TV Guide On Screen® has a Manual Record and  
Remind feature. Highlight SCHEDULE in the Service Bar,  
and press MENU. Choose the event type, press ENTER,  
and then enter the date, start and stop time, channel  
number, and so forth.  
b) The incorrect channel lineup was selected. Press GUIDE  
and then to highlight SETUP. Press z to highlight  
“Change system settings,” and then press ENTER. Follow  
the on-screen prompts to select the correct channel lineup.  
31. Q: Why wont my VCR change channels and why does it  
38. Q: What do the frequencies for Record and Remind mean?  
change to the wrong channel?  
A: Once—records/reminds the show one time.  
A: There are two possibilities (with a cable box):  
Daily (manual only)—records the time, channel, input,  
recorder combination Monday through Friday.  
a) The VCR is not set on the correct output channel. Set the  
VCR to 03, 04, or whichever output channel is set by your  
cable system.  
Regularly— records/reminds the show every time the show  
airs on the same channel and starts at the same time.  
b) The VCR and/or cable box are hooked up incorrectly.  
Refer to your VCR owner’s manual or contact your Cable  
TV company for proper wiring procedures.  
Weekly— records/reminds the show each time the show  
airs on the same day of the week, on the same channel and  
starts at the same time.  
Off (not cancel)—keeps the show in the Schedule list but  
will not record/remind the show until the frequency is  
changed.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
128  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Appendix  
13  
Lamp unit replacement and care  
When to replace the lamp unit  
You should replace the lamp unit:  
Replacing the lamp unit  
(User-replaceable component)  
• if the picture darkens and/or colors fade;  
• if the screen (lamp) does not light (LED indication #3,  
page 125); or  
WARNING: RISK OF  
ELECTRIC SHOCK!  
• if you hear a loud noise and the picture goes black, which  
may indicate a lamp rupture (LED indication #3,  
page 125).  
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, NEVER  
REMOVE TV COVERS, EXCEPT AS SPECIFIED  
HEREIN. REFER ALL SERVICING NOT SPECIFIED IN  
THIS MANUAL TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.  
Failure to follow this WARNING may result in death  
or serious injury.  
To obtain a replacement lamp unit:  
In the U.S.  
The light source for this TV is a mercury lamp with internal  
atmospheric pressure that increases during use. The lamp has a  
limited service life that varies depending on product use and  
user settings.  
In warranty:  
Visit www.tacp.toshiba.com/service  
or call toll-free 1-800-631-3811.  
Out of warranty: Visit www.ceaccessories.toshiba.com  
or consult your consumer electronics dealer.  
As is generally the case with all projection TVs that use  
projection lamps as a light source, the brightness of the lamp in  
this TV may vary somewhat over the expected service life and  
will generally decrease over time. The average useful service life  
of the lamp is approximately 8,000 hours in Low Power mode  
and approximately 6,000 hours in High Bright mode. See  
“Selecting the Lamp mode” on page 80 for information on  
switching the lamp mode. Because these are averages, some  
lamps will require earlier replacement.  
Use only the replacement lamp unit model listed below.  
Using any other lamp may cause damage to the TV  
and/or lamp. SUCH DAMAGE IS NOT COVERED  
UNDER YOUR TOSHIBA WARRANTY.  
CAUTION: Always replace with same  
type lamp unit: Model No. D95-LMP  
(Stock no. 23311153)  
Note : The lamp is warranted only for the periods and to the  
extent set forth in the Limited Warranty applicable to this set,  
which is a substantially shorter period of time than the average  
useful service period. See “Limited United States Warranty” on  
page 133.  
If you use the lamp beyond its service life:  
• you may notice a reduction in the colors and/or brightness of  
the picture; and  
• the strength of the quartz glass in the lamp will be reduced  
and the lamp may rupture (often making a loud noise when  
this happens). If the lamp ruptures, the TV will not operate  
until the lamp unit is replaced.  
CAUTION: Always handle the lamp unit with care.  
The lamp unit in this TV was designed for safe replacement  
by consumers; however, if the lamp unit is subjected to intentional  
abuse (such as excessive mechanical abuse or handling by children  
or pets), the unit may break, exposing sharp edges or pinch points.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
129  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 13: Appendix  
Lamp unit replacement and care (continued)  
How to replace the lamp unit  
4. Using a manual Phillips screwdriver, loosen the two screws on  
the lamp unit.  
WARNING: RISK OF  
ELECTRIC SHOCK!  
TO REDUCE THE RISK OF ELECTRIC SHOCK, NEVER  
REMOVE TV COVERS, EXCEPT AS SPECIFIED  
HEREIN. REFER ALL SERVICING NOT SPECIFIED IN  
THIS MANUAL TO QUALIFIED SERVICE PERSONNEL.  
Failure to follow this WARNING may result in death  
or serious injury.  
Required tools:  
• Manual Phillips screwdriver  
• Soft, lint-free gloves  
Lamp unit screws  
Optional tool: 5/32" or 4mm Allen wrench  
WARNING: RISK OF  
ELECTRIC SHOCK!  
1. Turn off the TV and unplug the power cord.  
The lamp unit door is provided with an  
WARNING: Eye damage may result from  
directly viewing the light produced by this  
lamp. Always turn off the TV and unplug the  
interlock to reduce the risk of electric shock and excessive  
ultraviolet radiation. Never defeat its purpose or attempt  
to service without removing the lamp unit door  
completely. Failure to follow this WARNING may result in  
death or serious injury.  
power cord before opening the lamp unit door.  
2. STOP! Allow the lamp to cool for at least one (1) hour  
before replacing it.  
5. Grasp the lamp unit handle and gently pull the lamp unit  
straight out of the TV. Set the old lamp unit aside (see  
“Disposing of the used lamp unit” on page 124).  
CAUTION: HOT SURFACE!  
The temperature of the lamp  
immediately after use  
exceeds 392°F (200°C).  
Touching the lamp before it has cooled will result in  
severe burns. ALLOW THE LAMP TO COOL FOR AT  
LEAST ONE (1) HOUR BEFORE REPLACING IT.  
3. On the lamp unit door on the side of the TV, loosen the  
thumb screw by hand or by using a 5/32” or 4mm Allen  
wrench, and then remove the lamp unit door.  
TV back  
Note:Wear soft, lint-free  
gloves when replacing  
the lamp unit.  
Thumb  
screw  
(Continued on next page)  
Lamp unit door detail  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
130  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 13: Appendix  
Lamp unit replacement and care (continued)  
How to replace the lamp unit (continued)  
8. Reattach the lamp unit door, making sure to insert the hooks  
on the left side of the lamp unit door inside the opening in  
the TV cabinet.  
6. Carefully insert the new lamp unit straight into the TV until  
it is fully seated.  
Insert the hooks inside  
the TV cabinet opening.  
Lamp unit door  
9. Replace the thumb screw and hand-tighten.  
Note :  
• Never subject the lamp unit to excessive shock.  
• Never touch the lamp unit glass or otherwise get it dirty.  
Doing so may affect the image quality and reduce the service life of  
the lamp. See “Cleaning the lamp unit glass” below.  
Thumb screw  
(hand-tighten only)  
Lamp unit door  
NOTE : Make sure  
CLEANING THE LAMP UNIT GLASS  
the lamp unit door is  
installed securely; otherwise,  
the TV may not turn on.  
If you accidentally touch the lamp unit glass or otherwise  
get it dirty, wipe it with a lint-free lens cleaning cloth (such  
as a cloth for cleaning camera lenses or eyeglasses).  
10. Plug in the power cord and turn on the TV. After the initial  
warmup period (which may take several seconds for full  
picture brightness), the TV should operate normally. If any of  
the following conditions exist, turn off the TV, unplug the  
power cord, and repeat steps 1–9 to ensure that the lamp unit  
and lamp unit door are installed correctly:  
CAUTION: NEVER clean a hot lamp with  
any type of flammable liquid or aerosol  
cleaning agent. Many ordinary cleaning agents  
(such as glass cleaners) contain chemicals that may be  
flammable at certain temperatures. If the lamp unit is not allowed  
to cool for at least one (1) hour, such chemicals may ignite.  
• No picture • Dark picture • TV will not turn on  
If, after repeating steps 1–9, the problem still exists, call TACP  
Consumer Solutions at 1-800-631-3811.  
7. Using a manual Phillips screwdriver, tighten the two lamp  
unit screws.  
Note: Hand-tighten only. Do not use an electric screwdriver.  
Disposing of the used lamp unit  
• Place the used lamp unit in the empty box from the new unit.  
• Keep the lamp unit out of reach of children and pets.  
CAUTION: Always handle the lamp unit with care.  
The lamp unit in this TV was designed for safe replacement by  
consumers; however, if the lamp unit is subjected to intentional or  
accidental abuse (such as excessive mechanical abuse or handling by  
children or pets), the unit may break, exposing sharp edges or pinch points.  
• Dispose of the used lamp unit by the approved method for  
your area.  
Lamp unit screws  
(use manual Phillips screwdriver only)  
NOTE : The lamp unit contains mercury. Disposal of mercury may  
be regulated due to environmental considerations. For disposal or  
recycling information, contact your local authorities or the Electronic Industries  
Alliance (www.eiae.org).  
NOTE : Make sure the lamp unit and screws  
are installed securely; otherwise, the TV may not  
turn on and the lamp life may be shortened.  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
131  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 13: Appendix  
Specifications  
NOTE:  
• This model complies with the specifications listed below.  
• Designs and specifications are subject to change without notice.  
• This model may not be compatible with features and/or specifications that may be added in the future.  
Television System  
Video/Audio Terminals (continued)  
NTSC standard  
ATSC standard (8VSB)  
Digital Cable (64 QAM, 256 QAM; in-the-clear, unencrypted*)  
HDMIINPUT:  
HDMI compliant (type A connector)  
HDCP compliant  
E-EDID** compliant  
Suggested formats: 1080i, 480p, 480i, 720p  
HDMI Audio: 2-channel PCM; 32/44.1/48 kHz sampling  
frequency; 16/20/24 bits per sample  
*Encrypted channels can be viewed on this TV  
using a CableCARD.™ See page 14 for details.  
Channel Coverage  
VHF: 2 through 13  
VIDEO/AUDIO OUTPUT (also for recording):  
VIDEO: 1 V(p-p), 75 ohm, negative sync.  
AUDIO: 150 mV(rms) (30% modulation equivalent,  
2.2 k ohm or less)  
UHF: 14 through 69  
Cable TV: Mid band (A-8 through A-1, A through I)  
Super band (J through W)  
Hyper band (AA through ZZ, AAA, BBB)  
Ultra band (65 through 94, 100 through 135)  
VARIABLE AUDIO OUTPUT:  
0–300 mV(rms) (30% modulation equivalent,  
2.2 k ohm or less)  
Power Source  
120 V AC, 60 Hz  
G-LINK®:  
3 V(p-p), 3.5 mm mono socket (IR blaster cables supplied)  
Power Consumption  
IEEE1394 INPUT/OUTPUT:  
240 W (average)  
38 W in standby mode (using a CableCARD)  
IEEE1394 compliant 4-pin  
34 W in standby mode (without a CableCARD)  
DIGITAL AUDIO OUTPUT:  
Optical type  
PC VIDEO IN:  
Audio Power  
15 W + 15 W  
Mini D-sub 15-pin Analog RGB  
PC AUDIO IN: 150 mV(rms) 22 k ohm or greater  
TheaterNet:  
Speaker Type  
Main: Two 4 inch (10 cm) round  
OUTPUT: 3 V (p-p), 10 k ohm  
INPUT: 3 V (p-p) to 5 V (p-p), pulse code modulated  
(Toshiba TV code) over 38 kHz carrier  
Tweeter: Two 1-5/8 inch (4 cm) round  
Video/Audio Terminals  
RJ-45 port:  
S-VIDEO INPUT:  
Standard Ethernet (RJ-45)  
Y: 1 V(p-p), 75 ohm, negative sync.  
C: 0.286 V(p-p) (burst signal), 75 ohm  
Dimensions  
52HMX95: Width: 58-3/8 inches (1,483 mm)  
Height: 35-1/16 inches (891 mm)  
Depth: 15-5/16 inches (389 mm)  
62HMX95: Width: 67-1/16 inches (1,703 mm)  
Height: 40-15/16 inches (1,040 mm)  
Depth: 18-1/4 inches (464 mm)  
Weight  
VIDEO/AUDIO INPUT:  
VIDEO: 1 V(p-p), 75 ohm, negative sync.  
AUDIO: 150 mV(rms) (30% modulation equivalent,  
22 k ohm or greater)  
ColorStream® (component video) HD INPUT:  
VIDEO: Y: 1V(p-p), 75 ohm  
PR: 0.7 V(p-p), 75 ohm  
PB: 0.7 V(p-p), 75 ohm  
52HMX95: 87 lbs (39.5 kg)  
62HMX95: 103 lbs (46.7 kg)  
Suggested formats: 1080i, 480p, 480i, 720p  
AUDIO: 150 mV(rms), 22 k ohm or greater  
Supplied Accessories  
• Two dual-wand IR blaster cables  
• Remote control with two size “AA” alkaline batteries  
• Owner’s manual (this book)  
Optional Stands:  
_________  
** E-EDID = Enhanced-Extended Display Identification  
52HMX95: ST5275  
62HMX95: ST6275  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
132  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 13: Appendix  
Limited United States Warranty  
for DLPTelevision Models  
Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C. (“TACP”) makes the following  
limited warranties to original consumers in the United States.  
Your Responsibility  
THE ABOVE WARRANTIES ARE SUBJECT TO THE FOLLOWING  
CONDITIONS:  
(1) You must retain your original bill of sale or provide other proof of  
purchase.  
(2) All warranty servicing of this DLP™ Television must be performed by an  
Authorized TACP Service Station.  
THESE LIMITED WARRANTIES EXTEND TO THE ORIGINAL  
CONSUMER PURCHASER OR ANY PERSON RECEIVING THIS DLP  
TELEVISION AS A GIFT FROM THE ORIGINAL CONSUMER  
PURCHASER AND TO NO OTHER PURCHASER OR TRANSFEREE.  
(3) The warranties from TACP are effective only if this DLP™ Television is  
purchased and operated in the Continental U.S.A. or Puerto Rico.  
(4) Labor service charges for set installation, setup, adjustment of customer  
controls, and installation or repair of antenna systems are not covered  
by this warranty. Reception problems caused by inadequate antenna  
systems, misaligned satellite dishes, cable television distribution, VCRs,  
DVD players/recorders, personal computer level IEEE1394 devices, and  
any other connected signal source device are your responsibility..  
(5) Warranties extend only to defects in materials or workmanship as limited  
above, and do not extend to any DLP™ Television or parts that have  
been lost or discarded by you or to damage to the DLP™ Television or  
parts caused by fires, misuse, accident, Acts of God (such as lightning  
or fluctuations in electric power), improper installation, improper  
maintenance, or use in violation of instructions furnished by TACP; use  
or malfunction through simultaneous use of this DLP™ Television and  
connected equipment; or to units that have been modified or had the  
serial number removed, altered, defaced, or rendered illegible.  
DLPTELEVISIONS PURCHASED IN THE U.S.A. AND USED ANYWHERE  
OUTSIDE OF THE U.S.A., INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, CANADA  
AND MEXICO, ARE NOT COVERED BY THESE WARRANTIES.  
DLPTELEVISIONS PURCHASED ANYWHERE OUTSIDE OF THE U.S.A.,  
INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, CANADA AND MEXICO, AND USED  
IN THE U.S.A., ARE NOT COVERED BY THESE WARRANTIES.  
Limited One (1) Year Warranty on Parts and Labor  
TACP warrants this DLP™ Television and its parts against defects in materials  
or workmanship for a period of one (1) year after the date of original retail  
purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD, TACP WILL, AT TACPS OPTION,  
REPAIR OR REPLACE A DEFECTIVE PART WITH A NEW OR  
REFURBISHED PART WITHOUT CHARGE TO YOU FOR PARTS OR  
LABOR. During this period, TACP Authorized Service Station personnel will  
come to your home when warranty service is required. Depending on the  
type of repair required, the service will either be performed in your home or  
the DLP™ Television will be taken to a TACP Authorized Service Station for  
repair and returned to your home at no cost to you.  
How to Obtain Warranty Service  
If, after following all of the operating instructions in this manual and reviewing  
the section titled “Troubleshooting,” you find that service is needed:  
(1) Locate the nearest TACP Authorized Service Station by visiting the  
TACP website at www.tacp.toshiba.com/service or calling the  
TACP Consumer Solution Center toll free at 1-800-631-3811.  
(2) Present your original bill of sale or other proof of purchase to the TACP  
Authorized Service Station.  
Limited One (1) Year Warranty on Lamp Unit  
TACP warrants the original lamp unit contained in this DLP™ Television  
against defects in materials or workmanship for a period of one (1) year after  
the date of original retail purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD, TACP WILL,  
AT TACPS OPTION, EXCHANGE A DEFECTIVE LAMP UNIT WITH A  
NEW OR REFURBISHED LAMP UNIT WITHOUT CHARGE TO YOU.  
LABOR CHARGES FOR LAMP UNIT REPLACEMENT ARE YOUR  
RESPONSIBILITY AND ARE NOT COVERED UNDER THIS  
For additional information, visit TACPs web site:  
www.tacp.toshiba.com.  
ALL WARRANTIES IMPLIED BY THE LAW OF ANY STATE OF  
THE U.S.A., INCLUDING THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF  
WARRANTY. The lamp unit is a user-replaceable component.  
MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE,  
ARE EXPRESSLY LIMITED TO THE DURATION OF THE LIMITED  
WARRANTIES SET FORTH ABOVE. WITH THE EXCEPTION OF ANY  
WARRANTIES IMPLIED BY THE LAW OF ANY STATE OF THE U.S.A. AS  
HEREBY LIMITED, THE FOREGOING WARRANTY IS EXCLUSIVE AND  
IN LIEU OF ALL OTHER WARRANTIES, GUARANTEES, AGREEMENTS,  
AND SIMILAR OBLIGATIONS OF TACP WITH RESPECT TO THE  
REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT OF ANY PARTS. IN NO EVENT SHALL  
TACP BE LIABLE FOR CONSEQUENTIAL OR INCIDENTAL DAMAGES  
(INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, LOST PROFITS, BUSINESS  
INTERRUPTION, OR MODIFICATION OR ERASURE OF RECORDED  
DATA CAUSED BY USE, MISUSE, OR INABILITY TO USE THIS DLP™  
TELEVISION).  
No person, agent, distributor, dealer, or company is authorized to change,  
modify, or extend the terms of these warranties in any manner whatsoever.  
The time within which an action must be commenced to enforce any  
obligation of TACP arising under the warranty or under any statute or law of  
the United States or any state thereof is hereby limited to ninety (90) days  
from the date you discover, or should have discovered, the defect. This  
limitation does not apply to implied warranties arising under the law of any  
state of the U.S.A.  
Rental Units  
The warranty for DLP™ Television rental units begins on the date of the first  
rental or thirty (30) days after the date of shipment to the rental firm,  
whichever comes first.  
Limited Warranty for Commercial Units  
TACP warrants DLP™ Televisions, including the lamp units contained therein,  
that are sold and used for commercial purposes as follows: all parts are  
warranted against defects in materials or workmanship for a period of ninety  
(90) days after the date of original retail purchase. DURING THIS PERIOD,  
TACP WILL, AT TACPS OPTION, REPAIR OR REPLACE A DEFECTIVE  
PART WITH A NEW OR REFURBISHED PART WITHOUT CHARGE TO  
YOU.  
Owners Manual and Product Registration  
Read this owner’s manual thoroughly before operating this DLP™ Television.  
Complete and mail the enclosed product registration card or register your  
DLP™ Television online at www.tacp.toshiba.com/service as soon as  
possible. By registering your DLP™ Television you will enable TACP to bring  
you new products specifically designed to meet your needs and help us to  
contact you in the unlikely event a safety notification is required under the  
Consumer Product Safety Act. Failure to register your product does not  
diminish your warranty rights.  
THIS WARRANTY GIVES YOU SPECIFIC LEGAL RIGHTS AND YOU  
MAY ALSO HAVE OTHER RIGHTS, WHICH MAY VARY FROM STATE  
TO STATE IN THE U.S.A. SOME STATES OF THE U.S.A. DO NOT ALLOW  
LIMITATIONS ON THE DURATION OF AN IMPLIED WARRANTY,  
WHEN AN ACTION MAY BE BROUGHT, OR THE EXCLUSION OR  
LIMITATION OF INCIDENTAL OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES.  
THEREFORE, THE ABOVE PROVISIONS MAY NOT APPLY TO YOU  
UNDER SUCH CIRCUMSTANCES.  
05  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
133  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Chapter 13: Appendix  
A copy of the GPL source code in this product may be obtained by  
contacting Toshiba Consumer Solutions at (800) 631-3811. There will  
be a charge to cover the costs of providing the source code.  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE OpenSSL PROJECT AS ISAND  
ANY EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT  
LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND  
FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT  
SHALL THE OpenSSL PROJECT OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR  
ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR  
CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO,  
PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE,  
DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED  
AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT  
LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE)  
ARISING IN ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF  
ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. This product includes  
cryptographic software written by Eric Young ([email protected]). This  
product includes software written by Tim Hudson ([email protected]).  
A copy of the LGPL source code in this product may be obtained by  
contacting Toshiba Consumer Solutions at (800) 631-3811. There will  
be a charge to cover the costs of providing the source code.  
USB Protocol Copyright © 2005 The NetBSD Foundation, Inc. All rights  
reserved.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without  
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions  
are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation  
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. Neither the name of The NetBSD Foundation nor the names of its  
contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived  
from this software without specified prior written permission.  
Copyright © 1995-1998 Eric Young ([email protected]). All Rights  
Reserved. This package is an SSL implementation written by Eric Young  
([email protected]). The implementation was written so as to conform with  
Netscapes SSL. This library is free for commercial and non-commercial use  
so long as the following conditions are adhered to. The following conditions  
apply to all code found in this distribution, be it the RC4, RSA, Ihash, DES,  
etc., code; not just the SSL code. The SSL documentation included with this  
distribution is covered by the same copyright terms except that the holder  
is Tim Hudson ([email protected]).  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE NETBSD FOUNDATION, INC.  
AND CONTRIBUTORS AS ISAND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED  
WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A  
PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL  
THE FOUNDATION OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,  
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF  
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;  
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY  
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY,  
OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN  
ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED  
OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.  
Copyright remains Eric Youngs, and as such any Copyright notices in  
the code are not to be removed. If this package is used in a product, Eric  
Young should be given attribution as the author of the parts of the library  
used. This can be in the form of a textual message at program startup or  
in documentation (online or textual) provided with the package.  
Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without  
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the copyright notice, this list  
of conditions, and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions, and the following disclaimer in the documentation  
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must  
display the following acknowledgement: “This product includes  
cryptographic software written by Eric Young ([email protected]).” The  
word ‘cryptographic’ can be left out if the routines from the library being  
used are not cryptographic related.  
This product includes software developed by the OpenSSL Project for  
use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org).  
This product includes cryptographic software written by Eric Young  
OpenSSL 0.9.7d Copyright © 1998-2000 the OpenSSL Project. All Rights  
reserved. Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without  
modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions are met:  
1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.  
2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright notice,  
this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the documentation  
and/or other materials provided with the distribution.  
3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software must  
display the following acknowledgement: This product includes software  
developed by the OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit  
(http://openssl.org).  
4. The names “OpenSSL Toolkit” and “Open SSL Project” must not be  
used to endorse or promote products derived from this software  
without prior written permission. For written permission, please contact  
5. Products derived from this software may not be called “OpenSSLnor  
may “Open SSLappear in their names without prior written permission  
of the OpenSSL Project.  
6. Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following  
acknowledgement: “This product includes software developed by the  
OpenSSL Project for use in the OpenSSL Toolkit (http://www.openssl.org).”  
4. If you include any Windows specific code (or derivative thereof) from the  
apps directory (application code) you must include an acknowledgement:  
“This product includes software written by Tim Hudson  
THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY ERIC YOUNG AS ISAND ANY  
EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED  
TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS  
FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL  
THE AUTHOR OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT,  
INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL  
DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF  
SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS;  
OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY  
THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT LIABILITY, OR  
TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY  
WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE  
POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE. The license and distribution terms for  
any publicly available version or derivative of this code cannot be changed,  
i.e. this code cannot simply be copied and put under another distribution  
license (including the GNU Public License).  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
134  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
Index  
A
M N  
DSL modem 30  
S
Account 108  
Antenna cables 13  
Memory cards 102–106  
DVI connection 21  
Dynamic Contrast 87  
Safety, care, installation, and  
service 2–5  
Memory Stick™ memory cards  
101, 102  
SAP sound 90  
Antenna input configuration  
46  
E F G  
Menu system 40, 41  
Satellite receiver connection 17  
Sub-bass (SBS) 91  
Scrolling the TheaterWide®  
picture 79  
E-mail account setup 108  
E-mail recording 113  
E-mail 113  
MMC memory cards 101, 102  
MP3 101, 102, 104, 105  
Audio player 102  
Audio quality adjustments 91  
Audio system connection 24  
Auto aspect 79  
MPEG-2 digital video signals  
25  
EIA-775 25  
SD (Secure Digital™) memory  
cards 101, 102  
MTS feature 90  
FAV SCAN button 49, 83  
Favorite channels 49, 83  
Features, TV 8  
Auto power off 96  
MUTE button 90  
Network addres 106  
Service 4  
AVHD 26, 55  
Setup, TV 41, 46  
Setup, TV Guide On Screen®  
system 42  
B
Focus 92  
O P Q  
On/Off timer 94  
Back of the TV 11  
Banner, Channel Browser™ 74  
Blocking channels 99  
Front of the TV 10  
Front panel lock 100  
Front panel touchpad 10, 41  
GameTimer™ 100  
G-LINK® connection 28  
Sleep timer 94  
Optical audio cable 13  
Optical audio output format 93  
Panel lock 100  
Speakers ON/OFF 93  
Specifications 125  
SRS 3D 92  
C
Cable box connection 16, 18  
CableCARD™ 14  
Password 108  
SRS TruSurround 92  
SRS WOW™ 92  
StableSound® 91  
Stereo sound 90  
S-video cables 13  
SurfLock™ 76  
PC connection 29  
PC setting 95  
H I J  
CableCARD™ connection 14  
CableClear® DNR 86  
Cables 13  
HDMI audio mode 55  
HDMI™ connection 21  
Home File server setup 112  
Home network connection 30  
ID 113  
Picture adjustments:  
CableClear®/DNR (digital  
noise reduction) 86  
Cable modem 30  
Color Management 85  
Color temperature 86  
Dynamic Contrast 87  
MPEG noise reduction 87  
Picture mode 84  
Camcorder connection 15  
CH yz buttons 47, 72  
Channel Browser™ 74  
CH RTN button 76  
Symbio™ AVHD recorder 26, 55  
System status 57  
IEEE1394 25  
INPUT button 72  
Input lock 99  
T
Channel Number buttons 47,  
49, 72  
Telephone cable 30  
Installation, care, and service 3,  
4
Picture quality 84  
TheaterNet™ DEVICE and  
CONTROL buttons 51  
Picture-out-picture (POP):  
FAV SCAN button 83  
SPLIT button 81  
Channel programming:  
Installation, setup 9  
Integrated digital tuning 8  
IR blaster 22  
Automatic programming 47  
TheaterNet™ control 25  
Manually adding and  
deleting 48  
TheaterNet IR device codes  
52-54  
Picture scroll 79  
ISP (Internet Service Provider)  
105  
TheaterWide® picture size 78  
TheaterNet™ setup 50  
THINC™ system 12, 107  
Time and date setting 55  
Troubleshooting 120-128  
TruBass 92  
Cinema mode 80  
Picture size selection 77  
Picture viewer 102  
Closed captions 88  
Color temperature 86  
ColorStream® 19  
JPEG 101–104  
POWER button 10, 31, 36  
Quick Restart™ 56  
L
Connecting devices 15–30  
CompactFlash® memory cards  
101, 102  
Labeling video inputs 73  
Lamp mode 80  
R
RECALL button 96  
Remote control:  
Lamp unit replacement 129–131  
Language selection 46  
Last mode memory feature 96  
LED indications 10, 125  
Locking video inputs 99  
LOCKS menu 97  
TruSurround 92  
TV Guide On Screen® 9, 42, 58  
Component video cables 13  
Battery installation 33  
Device code table 38, 39  
Effective range 32  
Functional key chart 34, 35  
Component video  
(ColorStream®) 19  
TV/VIDEO button 72, 73  
V
D
V-Chip blocking (Locks menu)  
97–100  
Defaults, restore TV factory 57  
Digital Audio Out 24  
Digital signal meter 57  
Learning about the buttons  
31  
Channels, blocking 99  
Enable rating blocking 98  
Front Panel lock 100  
GameTimer™ 100  
VCR connection 15–20  
Video cables 13  
Operational feature reset 37  
Programming 36  
DNR (Digital Noise Reduction)  
86  
Video input labels 73  
Video input lock 99  
VOLUME button 10, 37, 90  
Searching and sampling the  
code 36  
Dolby Digital 24  
New PIN code 97  
Dolby Virtual with SRS  
TruSurround 92  
Volume lock feature 37  
Restore TV factory defaults 57  
RJ-45 (LAN) cable 30  
RJ-45 (THINC™) connection 30  
Router 30  
Unlocking programs  
temporarily 99  
W, X  
Double-window POP feature 81  
DVD player connection 18, 19  
D-VHS 25, 55  
Video inputs, locking 99  
Warranty 133  
WOW™, SRS® 92  
xD-Picture Card™ 101, 102  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
135  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
(E) 52/62HMX95  
TOSHIBA AMERICA CONSUMER PRODUCTS, L.L.C.  
HEAD OFFICE: 82 TOTOWA ROAD, WAYNE, NJ 07470, U.S.A.  
NATIONAL SERVICE DIVISION:1420-B TOSHIBA DRIVE, LEBANON, TN 37087, U.S.A.  
MANUFACTURED BY  
TOSHIBA AMERICA CONSUMER PRODUCTS, L.L.C.  
CableClear, Cinema Series, ColorStream, StableSound, and TheaterWide are registered trademarks of Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C.  
Channel Browser, GameTimer, SurfLock, Symbio, Quick Restart, TheaterNet, and THINC are trademarks of Toshiba America Consumer Products, L.L.C.  
Digital Light Processing, DLP and the DLP medallion are trademarks of Texas Instruments.  
PRINTED IN USA  
(05-11)A  
Copyright © 2005 TOSHIBA CORPORATION. All rights reserved.  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Tektronix TV Converter Box P6701B User Manual
Teledyne Oxygen Equipment LXT 220 User Manual
Tiger Games 6247160200 User Manual
Toshiba Flat Panel Television 15DL75 User Manual
Triarch Indoor Furnishings 33124 User Manual
Triarch Indoor Furnishings 33212 User Manual
Tripp Lite Network Cables A050 006 User Manual
Tripp Lite Network Cables N002 010 RD User Manual
Vulcan Hart Cooktop VE30 ML 126849 User Manual
VXI Headphones 10G User Manual